POLYMER REACTIVITY: ASPECTS OF ORDER AND DISORDER No part of this digital document may be reproduced, stored in a retri...
132 downloads
2110 Views
4MB Size
Report
This content was uploaded by our users and we assume good faith they have the permission to share this book. If you own the copyright to this book and it is wrongfully on our website, we offer a simple DMCA procedure to remove your content from our site. Start by pressing the button below!
Report copyright / DMCA form
POLYMER REACTIVITY: ASPECTS OF ORDER AND DISORDER No part of this digital document may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or transmitted in any form or by any means. The publisher has taken reasonable care in the preparation of this digital document, but makes no expressed or implied warranty of any kind and assumes no responsibility for any errors or omissions. No liability is assumed for incidental or consequential damages in connection with or arising out of information contained herein. This digital document is sold with the clear understanding that the publisher is not engaged in rendering legal, medical or any other professional services.
POLYMER REACTIVITY: ASPECTS OF ORDER AND DISORDER
G.E. ZAIKOV AND
B.A. HOWELL EDITORS
Nova Science Publishers, Inc. New York
Copyright © 2006 by Nova Science Publishers, Inc. All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or transmitted in any form or by any means: electronic, electrostatic, magnetic, tape, mechanical photocopying, recording or otherwise without the written permission of the Publisher. For permission to use material from this book please contact us: Telephone 631-231-7269; Fax 631-231-8175 Web Site: http://www.novapublishers.com NOTICE TO THE READER The Publisher has taken reasonable care in the preparation of this book, but makes no expressed or implied warranty of any kind and assumes no responsibility for any errors or omissions. No liability is assumed for incidental or consequential damages in connection with or arising out of information contained in this book. The Publisher shall not be liable for any special, consequential, or exemplary damages resulting, in whole or in part, from the readers’ use of, or reliance upon, this material. This publication is designed to provide accurate and authoritative information with regard to the subject matter covered herein. It is sold with the clear understanding that the Publisher is not engaged in rendering legal or any other professional services. If legal or any other expert assistance is required, the services of a competent person should be sought. FROM A DECLARATION OF PARTICIPANTS JOINTLY ADOPTED BY A COMMITTEE OF THE AMERICAN BAR ASSOCIATION AND A COMMITTEE OF PUBLISHERS. LIBRARY OF CONGRESS CATALOGING-IN-PUBLICATION DATA Available upon request.
ISBN 978-1-61668-127-2 (E-Book)
Published by Nova Science Publishers, Inc. New York
CONTENTS Preface
vii
Chapter 1
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
Chapter 2
Fundamental Regularities of Thermal Oxidation of Heat-Resistant Heterochain Polymers E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
Chapter 3
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
Chapter 4
Heterophase Supramolecular Model of Photochemical Transformation of Naphthalene in Cellulose Triacetate Yu. A. Mikheev and V. G. Zaikov
Index
1
103 117
173 185
PREFACE “He knew little, but did much.” The opinion of Americans on Ronald Reagan
These are well-liked and respectful words of American citizens about their president. Clearly, there are several alternatives of this expression: 1. Knew much and did much, 2. Knew much, but did little, 3. Knew little and did little. Generally, the second or third expression describes people. Let it be so that criticism and self-criticism are shown. Anton Chekhov − the famous Russian writer, once said that “a man is a fraction, where the denominator shows his personal estimation and the numerator shows his estimation by other people”. Of course, if your personal estimation is low, the fraction will not be very small, even if a person has done little. However, let us find out the readers’ opinion about the authors of this collection and then deduce the fractions for different scientists. Some part of this collection is devoted to an important topic: the order and disorder in polymers. This is a very important factor because it defines diffusion properties (molecule motion speed in polymeric matrix) and solubility of low molecular substances in polymers. Recall that the diffusion coefficient in a glass of water equals 10−4 − 10−5 cm2/s, in melted polymer − 10−10, in a solid amorphous polymer − 10−15, and in crystalline polymer − 10-21-1027 cm2/s. Thus the molecule’s motion and speed at transition from liquid low molecular compound to solid crystalline polymer may vary by 20 orders of magnitude or higher. Hence, a transition from kinetic area (when the reaction rate is defined by reactivities of the substances) to diffusion area (when the situation is completely defined by reagent delivery to the interaction site and the Frank-Rabinovich cage effect) may occur.
viii
B. A. Howell and G. E. Zaikov
The rate of chemical processes in polymers strictly depends on the order degree in the polymer matrix. In its turn, this will affect the operation properties of polymeric materials and their storage life and reliable operation. The authors would be grateful for positive comments on the materials of the current collection, which will be taken into consideration in our future work.
Prof. Bob A. Howell Central Michigan University Mount Pleasant, Michigan, USA Prof. Gennady E. Zaikov N. M. Emanuel Institute of Biochemical Physics Moscow, Russia
In: Polymer Reactivity Editors: G. E. Zaikov and B. A. Howell, pp. 1-101
ISBN 1-60021-263-8 © 2006 Nova Science Publishers, Inc.
Chapter 1
POLYMERIC MEDIA WITH THE GRADIENT OF THE OPTICAL PROPERTIES N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov1 Javakhishvili Tbilisi State University, 3, Chavchavadze Ave.,Tbilisi, 0128, Georgia 1 N.M.Emanuel Institute of Biochemical Physics, Russian Academy of Sciences, 4, Kosygin St., Moscow, 119991, Russia
Formation of a refractive surface is not the only way of obtaining an optical image. Media with inhomogeneous distribution of the refractive index can be used for the same purpose. Such media with assigned gradient of the refractive index are named briefly as selfocs or GRIN-elements (GRIN – gradient refractive index). Some information about the possibility of image formation with the help of media possessing inhomogeneous, and in particular, radial-symmetric distribution of the refractive index, was first obtained at end of the 19th century. However, intensive development of gradient optics began three decades ago and, by now, it has become an independent direction of research in optics [1 - 7]. Achievements in gradient optics have proved quite valuable. Selfocs are widely applied in many spheres of science and technology, such as fiber-optical connection lines, fax technology, medical devices, small-scale copying machines, focusing elements of laser systems for video recording, etc. In contrast with traditional optics, in which a change of direction of a light beam occurs by refraction at the surface of the optical element, in a gradient medium the trajectory of the beam along the free path length is continuously curvilinear: this produces beam deviation and, under conditions of appropriate profile of refractive index, distribution focusing of beams, as well. GRIN-optics offers strong possibilities from the point of view of modernization of existing optical devices and of creation of fundamentally new apparatuses. Development of the gradient optics has made polymeric materials competitive with traditional optical materials (inorganic glasses) and, in some cases, even exceed them in some characteristics. Polymeric materials in gradient optics and in the fiber optics have the potential for much wider application than inorganic glasses: primarily, it is the marked high
2
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
variation of the refractive index observed in polymeric selfocs (∆n may reach 0.1, which significantly exceeds ∆n for quartz glasses) and the possibility of producing elements with different diameters. The following properties are also to be noted: low density, flexibility, ease of contacting and production, and low power consumption in the synthesis of the polymers (polymeric selfocs are prepared under softer conditions and over a shorter time). Owing to the variety of basic raw materials (monomers, oligomers), the application of polymers as materials for gradient media significantly widens the functional potential of gradient optics. The following principles should be noted for development of polymeric GRIN-optics: there is a need for improvement of optical characteristics of polymeric materials by modernization of preparation methods and selection of the most valuable components of the gradient composition; development of new methods for preparation of polymeric GRINelements for special devices; and application of other materials that so far have proved recalcitrant. This requires close cooperation of specialists in calculations of optical systems and polymer chemists developing processes of creation and methods for control of the properties of GRIN-elements [7].
1. CLASSIFICATION OF THE REFRACTIVE INDEX GRADIENT It is common practice to consider three main types of light behavior with respect to trajectory in media with a refractive index gradient: a. Spherical gradient; b. Axial gradient; c. Radial gradient. In selfocs with spherical gradient, the refractive index changes with radius in such a way that surfaces with identical values of n represent concentric spheres. Classic examples of systems with spherical gradient are: so-called Maxwell’s ‘fish eye’ [8] possessing the following distribution of the refractive index (RID):
n( r ) =
n0 1 + (ra ) 2
,
(1)
i.e. spherical gradient allows creation of an optical system with extremely wide viewing angle. The Luneburg lens [9, 10], in which the refractive index distribution is described by the formula:
n(r ) = n0 2 − (r / r0 ) .
(2)
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
3
However, practical aspects of realization of these ideas in the optical diapason are not solved yet. In an optical material with axial gradient, the refractive index changes along the optical axis. A spherical lens with refractive index gradient is equivalent to a spherical lens with aberrations – a specific gradient of the refractive index can eliminate some geometrical aberrations [11, 12]. The same effect is achieved when a plate with axial gradient of the refractive index is used as a separate element [11]. In optical materials with radial gradient, the refractive index changes along the radius of the optical element. When the gradient changes in proportion to the square of the radius (∆n ~ r2), the light beam in such an element is spread sinusoidally, and the optical material as a plane-parallel plate or a cylinder without any additional fitting possesses the property of a focusing lens. This type of the gradient is the best studied, and the gradient elements discussed in this book generally relate to this type (radial RID). If the period of the sinusoid is a multiple of the length of the optical element (selfoc), then the image is transmitted from one end to the other at a one-fold enlargement; otherwise, the selfoc possesses the properties of a positive or negative lens. At the same time, the focal length may be changed within any range. A selfoc displays ideal focusing properties when the refractive index distribution follows a hyperbolic secant law [13, 14]: n(r) = n0sech(αr) or
n 2 (r ) = n02 sec h 2 (αr ) = n02 (1 − α 2 r 2 ) ,
(3)
where n(r) is the refractive index at distance r from the axis; n0 is the refractive index on the axis in the center of the selfoc distribution; α is a constant (the distribution constant); ∆n = n0 – n(r) is the gradient of the refractive index from periphery to center, and the distribution constant α in expression (3) is expressed by the formula
α=
1 ∆n 2 , R n0
where R is the selfoc radius, rmax = R.
(4)
4
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
2. MEASUREMENTS OF THE MAIN PARAMETERS OF SELFOCS (METROLOGY OF SELFOCS). MEASUREMENTS OF DISTRIBUTION OF THE REFRACTIVE INDEX PROFILE AND THE ABSOLUTE VALUE OF THE REFRACTIVE INDEX BY SELFOC RADIUS One of the main optical characteristics of real selfocs is distribution of the refractive index profile (RID) [15 - 26]. Described in the literature are measurement methods of both relative and absolute distribution of the refractive index profile [18, 27, 28]. These methods are subdivided into two main groups: 1. Interference; 2. Non-interference. Among these methods, the most applicable is the method 1, because of its accuracy, universality, obviousness, ease of mathematical processing of experimental data obtained, and ability for reproduction. Most often applied to measurements is the method of a fine slice using the Mach–Zender mirror (double-beam) interferometer (Figure 1) [14, 27].
3
6
5
3
2
7 2 1 2
Figure 1. Scheme of experimental set-up for studying distribution of the refractive index profile by the interference method. 1 – He-Ne laser; 2 – reflecting mirrors; 3 – semitransparent mirrors; 4 – collimating system; 5 – objective; 6 – photo camera; 7 – cuvettes with the sample studied.
On this device, measurements are performed in two regimes: a.
In the regime of formation of the refractive index distribution by radius of the prepared gradient element during regulated diffusion (kinetics of diffusion process); b. In the regime of settled RID in the sample under investigation. Samples of interference measurements represent plane-parallel cross-section slices from polymeric light focusing elements with varying profile of the refractive index from the sample center to periphery. The thickness of these slices is limited by the maximum number
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
5
of rings that can be resolved by photo film at appropriate enlargement of the control system and is 100–300 µm depending upon the system studied. The refractive index is measured with an accuracy of 10–5 [14]. A typical interferogram is shown in Figure 2.
Figure 2. Interferogram of selfoc based on DAIF–4FMA.
According to the data from an interference picture, determination of the refractive index profile by cross-section of the gradient element consists of calculation of the function ∆n = f(r) by the formula:
∆n =
∆a λ ⋅ , a d
(5)
where ∆a/a is the relative value of displacement of interference bands; d is the thickness of the sample measured. Accuracy of measurement is ∆a/a = 0.05 of the band, which corresponds to the relative error ∂n/∆n = (6–10)%. In practice, the formula
∆n =
N ⋅λ , d
is most often used, where N is the number of circle on the interferogram [29]. Distance r from the center of the interference image to the circle Nr is calculated by the expression [26]:
r=
d ⋅L, D
(6)
where d is the diameter of the cross-section slice of the gradient element; D is the diameter of the interference image of the slice on film; L is the distance from the interference image center to a circle.
6
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
After exposition of the interference image observed on the slice of light focusing polymeric element, a functional dependence ∆n = f(r) or ∆n = f(r2) appropriate to the RID of the selfoc studied is derived from the experimental points. Investigation of RID formation and performance of some practical calculations require data on absolute values of nD with respect to the selfoc radius [30]. In the literature, particular methods of measurement of these values are described in detail [24, 27]. Among them, let us describe a modified variant of the method using a fine slice [30 - 32]. According to this method, a plane-parallel glass plate with known value of nD with accuracy up to 10–5 (standard) is placed simultaneously with the sample studied in a cuvette filled with an immersion liquid. The standard and the sample are turned to each other by finely polished edges. The path of interference bands on the interferometer output is recorded, and the difference between the refractive index of a selected point of the sample and the standard is determined by displacement of these bands on the standard–immersion liquid and the sample–standard borders. Then the value of the refractive index at any point of the sample is determined [30]. Other methods of determination of absolute nD values by the selfoc radius have also been described (for example, the method of ‘saturated’ beam, the method of interferometry of the sample in the direction perpendicular to its optical axis [30], etc.). In the view of the authors of ref. [30], the methods described above (first of all, the modified variant of the fine slice method) are quite suitable and provide accuracy of the measurement (at a definite slice thickness) of 1–2⋅10–4. It should be noted that accuracy of measurement of the refractive index distribution in a selfoc is influenced by such factors as focusing of beams permeating though the selfoc slice, and the sphericity and non-plane-parallelism of the sample. Analysis performed by the authors of ref. [30] indicates that the relative error of measurements produced by focusing of the beams is below 0.5%, and deviation from the plane-parallel shape of the slice by 10 µm at its thickness of 500 µm indicates the relative error of about 4% at ∆n = 0.04 with accurate selection of immersion. It has been mentioned [30] that accuracy of RID change by the method of interferometry of fine slices may be increased by photoelectric registration of interferograms of polished plane-parallel slices and computerization of the calculation.
3. METHODS OF PREPARING GRIN-ELEMENTS There are various methods of obtaining light focusing polymeric gradient elements (LFPGE) or selfocs [33 - 60]. They may be conditionally subdivided into two main groups. The first group comprise traditional methods: the two-stage method of diffusion exchange; copolymerization (photocopolymerization) of double or triple composites of monomers (or oligomers) differing by relative activity and refractive index. The second group comprise: separation in a gravitational field [52]; gradient modification of polymeric transparent material from the surface to a definite depth by physical and chemical methods (swelling or dissolving in an organic solvent, halogenation, etc.) [40, 51, 61, 62], dipolephoresis [63, 64].
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
7
Obtaining LFPGE with some specific gradient of the refractive index is based on proper selection of initial monomers and polymers and their transformation under such conditions that provide the required distribution of the refractive index gradient in the final material. Factors that promote creation of a gradient distribution nD of copolymeric compositions include temperature, concentration, gravitation and electric field, the field of initiation, etc. Of great importance also is the search for technological regimes of formation and fixing (if necessary) of the profile of refractive index distribution obtained, which would provide materials with close to the ideal focusing distribution.
3.1. Method of Diffusion Exchange In practice, among the methods mentioned above, the most applicable one is the method of diffusion exchange [33] or its modified variants. The process of creation of a gradient distribution of the refractive index by the diffusion method consists of the following stages [33, 65]: obtaining of a for-polymeric matrix with high value of the refractive index (such as nD ≥ 1.5) and molecular exchange of residual monomer of the matrix and monomer-diffusate possessing a refractive index lower than the matrix component of LFPGE. As a result of the exchange, a definite distribution of monomer concentration and, consequently, appropriate distribution of the refractive index (RID) is formed in LFPGE after a definite time. Using this method, it is necessary to fix the RID formed in the sample by thermal and photo-copolymerization. To obtain high-quality selfocs by the method of diffusion exchange, it is necessary to select monomers that fulfill the following requirements [29]: -
-
-
To prepare the matrix, the initial monomer must be, at least, bifunctional and give a transparent polymer network on polymerization, which at relatively low degrees of conversions (≤ 30%) is able to keep the assigned shape, for example, cylinder, planar or spherical shape; To provide high (maximum) gradient of the refractive index ∆n over the selfoc crosssection, the monomer–diffusate and the matrix must possess possibly great difference in refractive indices; To reach high transparency of the selfoc, the monomer–diffusate and the matrix must be miscible, able to form (after exchange diffusion) a homophase random copolymer.
Because any dielectric medium (including selfocs) possesses dispersion of the refractive index, it is necessary to strive for gradient elements that produce low chromatic aberration. It is found that chromatic aberration depends on the relative optical characteristics of polymers of the matrix and diffusate separately and, consequently, proper selection of a pair of copolymers is the main factor determining low chromatic aberration [26]. Selecting a pair of monomers, M1 and M2, for preparation of selfocs possessing low chromatic aberration, it is necessary to take into account the following conditions [14, 29, 59]:
8
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov a.
Difference between [(nF – nC)/nD]1 (matrix) and [(nF – nC)/nD]2 (diffusate) must be low; b. Correlation [(nF – nC)/nD] of both monomers must be low; c. Difference between (nD)1 and (nD)2 must be high. Problems of decrease of the chromatic aberration, increase of ∆n, length and diameter of LFPGE have been topics demanding the constant attention of investigators. They solved the problems complexly, by searching for the most opportune pairs of monomers for obtaining selfocs with assigned optical, physicomechanical and other characteristics with simultaneous modernization of technology for obtaining gradient media [29, 66]. Initial information on obtaining polymeric selfocs appeared in the early 1970s [33]. In spite of a number of valuable properties (primarily, high input aperture angle and, secondly, low chromatic aberration), classic polymeric gradient (GRIN) elements based on accessible 1 2 monomers, such as DAIP -MMA, DEGBAC (CR-39)-4FMA [67], possessed limited lengths (L ≤ 150 nm) and diameters (d ≈ 1–3 mm) which, in turn, limited the sphere of their application. To reach high values of the gradient of the refractive index (∆n > 0.05) and increase of LFPTE diameter (d ≥ 10 mm) while preserving good opto-mechanical indices, investigations were generally performed in two directions: 1. Obtaining new copolymeric matrices from comonomers with high values of nD; 2. Selection of monomer–diffusates with minimal values of the refractive index and good optical miscibility with widely used matrix components (monomers for matrices – DAIP, DEGBAC, DMEG3, etc.). As an example of the first approach may be considered creation of a selfoc based on copolymeric matrix from DAIP-a and maleic anhydride (MA) [67, 68] with conversion of monomers of 30–60%. The polymeric matrix obtained is more plastic than the matrix from homopolymer DAIP with analogous conversion of the monomer, which allowed production of selfoc samples with relatively large diameter (d ≈ 6–8 mm) with the refractive index gradient ∆n = 0.035. Therewith, definite difficulties are encountered at fixing the created RID, associated with the reverse diffusion and partial evaporation of the monomer–diffusate that penetrated into the matrix [67, 68]. Increase of ∆n with simultaneous reduction of chromatic aberration and improvement of a series of physicochemical, mechanical and exploitation properties of selfocs were achieved by application of chlorine-containing (meth)acrylates as monomers (diffusate) with low refractive index [69]. Y. Ohtsuka et al. [59] have indicated the possibility of obtaining gradient elements with low chromatic aberration by appropriate selection of monomeric pairs – DEGBAC (CR-39) and 1,1,3-trihydrofluoropropyl methacrylate or DEGBAC and 1,1,5-trihydroperfluoropentyl methacrylate. Selfocs possessing chromatic aberration of about 8⋅10–3 were obtained.
1
DAIP – diallyl ether of isophthalic acid DEGBAC – diethyleneglycol bis(allyl carbonate) 3 DMEG – ethyleneglycol dimethacrylate 2
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
9
Based on perfluoroalkyl methacrylates and various matrices, selfocs with ∆n ≥ 0.06–0.08 and high thermal and humidity resistance have been created, which also display excellent optical and mechanical properties that they retain for a long time [46]. In the search for ways of broadening the functional abilities and to increase radiation and thermal resistance of selfocs, methods of obtaining them from organoboron and organosilicon dimethacrylate monomers [70] and their copolymers [61] have been developed. Investigations have indicated [26, 71] that not only relatively expensive bifunctional network-forming monomers, but also quite accessible monomers (styrene, for example) which give a linear polymer with high value of nD may be used as a matrix, if a network structure is formed in it by the use of cross-linking agents [26, 72]. A method of preparation of selfocs based on styrene and cross-linking agent, dimethacrylate ethyleneglycol (DMEG, Table 1) is suggested [72]. Among the advantages of gradient elements produced by this method are such characteristics as high light transmission, refractive index distribution close to the ideally focusing one, etc. However, the value of refractive index gradient ∆n of these elements does not exceed 0.04 [72]. Oligocarbonate dimethacrylates (OCM-2, Table 2) and organosilicon dimethacrylates [55, 61] have also been used as cross-linking agents for polystyrene. They simultaneously played the role of modifiers of the mechanical properties of rigid-chain polystyrene. From this viewpoint, optimal results are obtained, when these compounds are used in copolymerization with styrene in amount not more than 20% [55]. There is no point in increasing the proportion of dimethacrylates, because, first of all, the refractive index of the appropriate polymeric matrix decreases and, secondly, the rate of copolymerization autoacceleration at comparatively low conversion of the monomer increases, which makes production of a shapestable gel-matrix with required fraction composition less regulated. Table 1. [72] Influence of change of DMEG concentration in the initial matrix on optical properties of gradient elements, Tpolym = 75°C, [PB] = 0.75 mass. % DMEG, mass. % 10 30 50 70
Conversion, mass. % 14.8 15.0 11.5 11.5
Gel-fraction, mass. % 90 92 98 99
Tc, °C 85 75 65 65
NA 0.317 0.358 0.3105 0.286
N 0.0324 0.0405 0.0314 0.0267
F (NA = 0.1) 15.0 91.4 97.5 403
To solve some technical problems, it is necessary to use flexible rod-like selfocs. Described in the literature are two types of such flexible selfocs: 1 – flexible at bending [73, 74]; 2 – selfocs with variable focal length [75]. In this case, on the molecular level, GRINmaterials represent a cross-linked macromolecular three-dimensional network that differs from others in that, in order to be able to regulate the focal length of LFPGE by an external mechanical influence, macromolecules between network cross-linked points contain flexible fragments from different units in a definite molar ratio that exist in a partially entangled state. This enables intercross-linked point chains of macromolecules to be partially compressed or more elongated on subjecting LFPGE to a compressive or elongating force and, therewith, the
10
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
value of the focal length may be changed accordingly. This property is achieved without distortion of the overall LFPGE shape or changing curvature of its surface [75]. Table 2. Compositions of mixtures and conditions of OCM-2 copolymerization with styrene
No. 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6.
nD of monomers mixture 1.5403 1.5336 1.5260 1.5120 1.5120 1.4960
Matrix copolymers Styrene, OCM-2, mol % mol % 98.7 1.3 95.9 4.1 89.0 11.0 80.0 20.0 80.0 20.0 63.8 36.2
T, K 353 353 353 353 333 343
Gel-fraction concentration in copolymer, % 11.0 16.8 18.0 23.9 22.1 24.1
τ, min 50 35 20 15 40 26
Generally, selfocs flexible at bending are produced by two methods: selection of appropriate initial components [73, 74] which provide for formation of a flexible copolymeric network material with gradient nD or development of a specific technological regime [33] which allows regulation of the process of matrix monomer copolymerization and afterdiffusion fixing of the RID obtained in such a way that network structures with low crosslinking degree would be formed. For example, a copolymeric rod with refractive index gradient of half-period length 63 mm, possessing a bending modulus E ≤ 5.7⋅103 kg/cm2, was successfully obtained by thermal copolymerization of DAIP-MMA, performed under relatively mild conditions (60°C, 18–20 hours), after the stage of diffusion exchange (prepolymerization). Investigations on creation of flexible rod-like selfocs performed so far have indicated [73, 74] that, among existing monomers for matrix formation, those with greatest potential are bifunctional monomers or oligomers of polyethyleneglycol dimethacrylates of the following general structure:
CH2
C
C(O)O
(CH2
CH3
CH2O)l
(O)C C
CH2
CH3
where l = 1, 2, 3, …, 13. The value of l determines the rigidity of the polymeric matrix obtained. In this case, good results were also obtained at application of triallylcyanurate and 13-ethyleneglycol dimethacrylate (l = 13) as matrix comonomers. These compounds cause formation of a flexible random copolymer network with reduced frequency of cross-linking. Another way of obtaining a flexible selfoc concludes in application as a diffusate of a vinyl monomer (butyl methacrylate, for example), the polymer of which possesses low glass 0 transition temperature Tg < Troom [59].
(
)
There are data in the literature on synthesis of relatively flexible gradient mutually penetrating network polymers (MPNP) based on the pair DAIP and diallylsebacinate [14].
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
11
MPNP is usually synthesized by polymerization of a polymer–monomer system obtained by swelling of a polymer network in the mixture of another monomer with a cross-linking agent. The essence of this work is in the fact that the network of three-dimensional bonds is formed in a single polymer-matrix, and the second monomer (with lower nD) without a cross-linking agent is injected into the network polymer by exchange diffusion with unreacted matrix monomer. In this manner, a gradient of the refractive index may be created in the polymer. Mutually penetrating networks with gradient based on oligoetheracrylates [76], etc. are also described. Discussed above were focusing gradient elements, but many gradient polymeric elements are defocusing selfocs. The method of preparation of samples is the same as for focusing polymeric rods. The effect of defocusing is achieved when the value of the refractive index of the matrix monomer (DEGBAC, for example) is lower than that for the diffusate (vinylbenzoate or styrene, for example) [77]. However, new applications of defocusing selfocs are still being explored. The need for a variety of gradient compositions is dictated by the range of technological tasks of modern GRIN-optics, in particular, by the necessity of broadening functional and technical abilities of light focusing gradient elements. However, it should be noted that despite the existence of polymeric selfocs with a refractive index gradient ∆n ≥ 0.1 and d ≈ 20 mm, they are still less important than selfocs based on inorganic glasses with respect to resolution (~ 100 and 300 mm-1 per 1 mm, respectively) [29]. Reproduction of optical characteristics, as well as creation of GRINelements of unlimited length and possibly larger radii (for example, in the case of plate thin GRIN-elements), etc. may also be explored. Further developments are required in diffusion technology to obtain gradient elements with the required performance, and better systematic studies of synthesis of the matrix, formation and fixing of gradient medium RID, and determining the precise interconnection between RID formed and the initial gradient composition, experimental conditions, physicochemical and optical characteristics of gradient elements obtained. One of the main stages of obtaining selfocs according to the diffusion technology is preparation of a fore-polymeric gel-matrix. Generally, bifunctional vinyl monomers – dimethacrylate and diallyl ethers – are used as the matrix monomers. Among them, ethyleneglycol dimethacrylates (DMEG) [72], diallylisophthalate (DAIP) [14,28, 33, 55, 59, 67], diallylitaconate (DIT) and diallylsebacinate (DAS) [14], diallylmaleinate (DAM), diethyleneglycol bis-allylcarbonate (DEGBAC) [14, 28, 55, 67], and their copolymers find greatest application [2, 14]. Besides the requirements mentioned above, various properties of materials obtained, in particular, thermal and heat resistance, resistance to radiation, resistance to humidity, flexibility, mechanical strength, and technological effectiveness of their formation must also be taken into account in selection of the matrix monomers. It should be noted that, to obtain a shape-forming material that is able to keep the assigned form, very specific concentration of the gel-fraction of the polymer network must be achieved in the synthesis of the matrix. On the other hand, the higher is concentration of unreacted (residual) monomer in the matrix which may be exchanged by diffusate molecules, the greater is the gradient ∆n between the axis and the selfoc surface that may be obtained [29].
12
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
In accordance with the task set, block radical initiated polymerization (copolymerization) would be appropriate for use as a method for the matrix synthesis. A spatially cross-linked structure, swelled in its own monomer, is typical of the gel-matrix, which is the intermediate product for obtaining a selfoc. The presence of a three-dimensional structure is necessary not only to confer and preserve the given shape in the target optical element, but also for creation of definite conditions for the diffusion exchange of penetrating agent by a unreacted monomer of the matrix and formation of a specific RID. The monomers mentioned above are able, at rather low degrees of conversion (20–30%), to form shape-stable spatially crosslinked structures containing residual functional groups capable of entering the copolymerization reaction with the diffusate monomer after formation of the given distribution of the refractive index by the exchange diffusion with the residual matrix monomer. Investigations have shown that conditions of homopolymerization of bifunctional monomers generally depend on the type of monomer, i.e. on the class of compounds, dimethacrylate or diallyl, to which the given monomer relates. In practice, this factor may determine selection of an initiator and its amount. Kinetics and mechanism of polymerization of allyl monomers are extremely complicated. Besides reactions general for radical polymerization of vinyl monomers – initiation, propagation and termination of the chain, and chain transmission to monomer, polymer and admixtures – the following specific reactions are typical of allyl monomers, in particular, di(poly)functional allyl ethers: degenerate chain transmission [78], rupture of ester bond [79], cyclopolymerization [80]. A proposal has been made that the above-mentioned reactions are complicated by cross-linking reactions of macromolecules and diffusion control of the process at greater degrees of transformation. However, unfortunately, accurate methods of quantitative description of the given transformation of these complex systems have not yet been reported in the literature. This definitely restricts statement of a clear interconnection between the optimal technological regime of gel-matrix production and assigned characteristics and fractional composition, and kinetic parameters of homopolymerization of diallyl monomers. Numerous works [80 - 85] are devoted to the study of kinetics and mechanism of radical polymerization of divinyl monomers. That is why in this book, we have limited ourselves to consideration of the main regularities only, associated with formation of a gel-polymeric matrix up to the required degree of conversion (10–50%). When these regularities are considered, we base practical methods on the ideas discussed in refs. [72, 81 - 84], supporting them by data of kinetic investigations [84 - 86]. Study of homopolymerization (of DAIP, for example) by DSC4 and SPR-spectroscopy methods has shown [81] that the process is separated into two stages: quasi-linear polymerization and structuring. Monomer consumption proceeds with formation of primary polymeric chains, whereas structuring is characterized by formation of secondary polymeric chains by double bond. An important feature of divinyl monomers of the methacrylate ether (OEA) type is that, during formation of a spatially cross-linked structure, the microgel is already formed at low transformation degrees (< 1%) of the monomer, i.e. since the very beginning, the process of radical polymerization of these monomers proceeds under the conditions of 4
DSC – differential scanning calorimetry
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
13
microheterogeneity [72, 82, 87, 88]. In connection with specificity of the process itself, the reaction can proceed at high rates, which frequently makes the process of obtaining a gelmatrix with the required properties poorly regulated. The ratio of outputs of gel-fractions and β-polymer (zole-fraction) at the initial stages is determined by the conditions that affect the degree of aggregation of macrochains that are formed up to that time [88]. Therewith, it has been proved that processes of chemical and physical structure formation (engagement of propagating intermediate macrochains) are simultaneous (identical), and polymerization is performed by permolecular particles [72, 89]. It is stated that (in the case of OEA) [72, 87], already at low transformation depth, accumulation of new ‘isolated’ particles and further polymerization proceeds without a significant change in the number of particles due to their expansion. Therewith, the number of primary polymeric chains is limited rapidly due to competitive reactions of addition of these newly formed chains to macrochains that have accumulated in the reaction mixture up to that point [72, 90]. At the same time, formation of soluble β-polymer (zole-fraction) is highly complicated due to its low stationary concentration [88]. It has been shown [91, 92] that possible intramolecular cross-linking reactions in early stages of polymerization causes a displacement of the so-called gel formation point (the moment of gel-fraction formation) to the side of higher transformation degrees and leads to increase of the amount of β-polymer (zole-fraction) [72]. Based on the differences in mechanisms of homopolymerization of dimethacrylate and diallyl ethers mentioned above, differences in the processes of gel-matrix formation based on them are quite understandable. It is also noted [72, 84, 85] that, depending on the nature of applied allyl monomers (for example, DAIP, DAP5, DAC6, etc.), a microgel at higher degrees of transformation may be formed due to selection of conditions of homopolymerization performance (the presence of inhibitors, chain transmitters, etc.). Therewith, the proportion of soluble linear and branched products (zole-fraction) increases significantly. It was also found that the zole-fraction output up to high conversion degrees of these monomers is lower than of insoluble polymer. According to the authors of the work [72], in the pre-gel period, the reaction system represents a colloid dispersion (size of gels are quite low) in which the role of the dispersion phase is played by microgels with high transformation degrees, and the role of dispersion medium by unreacted initial oligomer (monomer). In the view of these authors, diffusion transparency of such a system will be high, and strength is very low, because the system properties in this state are generally determined by the property of the continuous phase. Proceeding of the process without diffusion limitations is typical of the gel-polymerization on this stage. Therewith, probability of defect formation during this period is minimal due to localization of homopolymerization in the liquid phase, in which the possibility to form defects of the ‘freezing’ type of internal stresses is minimal [89]. Appearance of this type of defect as, for example, defects of macromolecules formed of free ends and cyclic structure type [93], may affect some physicochemical characteristics of the network formed. It should be noted that the most significant contribution to formation of spatially cross-linked structure with definite physicomechanical properties is made by so-called morphological (permolecular) defects [72], the formation and degree of which are determined by natural and technological factors of performance of the polymerization itself. To put it differently, 5 6
DAP – diallylphthalate DAC – Diallyl ether of µ1-carboranedicarboxylic acid [55]
14
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
formation of defects in the structure may be minimized by a selection of appropriate favorable conditions of polymerization. During transformation of bi(poly)functional monomers, one more feature of threedimensional polymerization is displayed [87] – appearance of auto-acceleration (gel-effect) during accumulation of a polymer network at rather low transformation degrees. This may be the consequence of deterioration of chain termination conditions limited by diffusion which, in its turn, will change the ratio Kp/Kter during polymerization [72]. In contrast with usual linear polymerization (for example, monofunctional vinyl(monomethacrylate) monomers), in which the main reason for auto-acceleration is the occurrence of the so-called engagement network, in the case of bifunctional monomers, the probability of auto-acceleration increases with increase of concentration of network crosslinked points [86]. This concept may be confirmed by occurrence of auto-acceleration (geleffect) even in the case of copolymerization with participation of monomers (styrene, for example), in which the gel-effect is not typical [72, 94, 95]. This suggests that (at good optical miscibility) the gel-effect, with styrene applied as a comonomer in the mixture with vinyl monomers (to obtain the matrix), may be displaced to the side of higher transformation degree [72]. In the literature, there are various methods for analysis and control of homopolymerization processes (and hence, of the composition of the polymer obtained): refractometric [86], kinetic [85, 86], and spectroscopic [81]. Data on NMR-spectra recorded during homopolymerization of bifunctional (diallyl) monomers (for example, DIAP, DEGBAC) have been published. It is found [26] that the 1HNMR-spectrum of the system (in the case of DAIP homopolymerization, initiator [BP] = 3.81%, Treact = 80°C) is bimodal, in which the presence of a wide component in the spectrum is confirmed by formation of a network fraction, and a narrow component is confirmed by a quasi-linear structure. Intensity of the narrow component decreases during polymerization, but that of the wide one increases. Comparison of the correlation of wide and narrow components at different stages of polymerization allows determination of the ratio of fractions in samples. Based on these studies, it has been stated that copolymerization of this type of monomers proceeds up to a definite conversion degree (for example, for DAIP, S ≈ 13.5%, and for DEGBAC – S ≈ 9.5%) with formation of a soluble β-polymer as the result of splitting of a double bond in one of two allyl groups of the monomer. Above these conversion degrees, a gel-fraction (spatially cross-linked structure) is formed, which is intensified due to involvement of the second double bond of the allyl group into polymerization. Such a mechanism has also been confirmed by 13C-NMR-spectroscopy (on the example of DEGBAC polymerization) [55]. It is found that, in the second stage of the reaction (S>16–17%), comparatively fast decrease of relaxation times of the system is observed which, apparently, is due to a decrease of mobility of intercross-linked fragments which results from appearance of a spatially crosslinked structure. At the same time, new signals (33.0 m.p.) appear, typical of so-called ‘ruptured’ allyl groups [55]. Therewith, there arises the possibility of controlling the processes by obtaining a shape-stable gel with specified degree of conversion (specific concentration of the gel-fraction).
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
15
Refractometric control of the gel-forming process (in the case of DEGBAC polymerization) is based on determination of dependencies of conversion and nD of the reaction product on the reaction duration, as well as dependence of transformation degree on the difference in refractive indices of polymerizate and monomer [86]. Kinetic curves obtained by the refractometric method (at homopolymerization of DEGBAC) are characterized by the presence of a bending in the range of the transformation degree of ~10%, corresponded to the onset of the gel formation [86]. The above-suggested mechanism of the homopolymerization process of DMEG, DAIP, DEGBAC, etc. type monomers is also confirmed by the study of kinetics of homopolymerization at initial and high degrees of transformation with simultaneous measurement of the parameter η⋅d [84] in the polymerization product as a function of the stage of the process (Figure 3). It is indicated that at conversion of 9.2%, the character of increase of the system viscosity (η) and polymer density (d) changes. This fact may be explained only by a supposition that formation of polymer at the stage before 9.2% conversion proceeds preferentially with participation of a single double bond. Experimental determination of the residual unsaturation of polymerizate as the function on time indicates that, indeed, when 9.2% conversion is reached, consumption of double bonds increases sharply.
η d lg ⋅ − 1 η0 d 0
1.0 0.6 0.2 4
8
12
16
20
S, %
-0.2 Figure 3. Dependence of system viscosity multiplied by polymer density on transformation degree S at DEGBAC polymerization, [BP] = 1.5 mass%; T = 338 K
Branched and linear structures may be differentiated by value of the branching factor [96], as well as by spectroscopic studies [81]. Change in structure of polymers based on divinyl (diallyl) monomers during polymerization is also confirmed using the thermomechanical method [81]. From thermomechanical curves indicated in refs. [81], it is obvious that Tg of a product of quasilinear structure is sharply different from Tg of polymeric cross-linked structures. Therewith, softened (Tg ≈ 27°C) and non-softened spatially cross-linked polymers with significantly
16
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
different parts of network cross-linked points are formed [81]. Temperature increase promotes an increase in the proportion of cross-links (the proportion of chains with two open double bonds) of polymerizate with appropriate decrease of the proportion of chains possessing only one double bond (pendant double bonds), which affects the shape of the thermomechanical curves. Regulation of the temperature regime of homopolymerization allows control of crosslink rate and degree [81]. It should be noted that complexity of the investigation methods indicated in ref. [81] (DSC, ESR, thermomechanics) allows determination of not only the monomer consumption and conversion of double bonds during the process of polymerization, but also structuralmorphological characteristics which, obviously, must affect the resulting characteristics of optical materials. Besides the temperature regime [55], one of the ways of regulating gel formation and cross-linking frequency of the gel-matrix obtained is appropriate selection of the type and amount of initiator. Increase of the initiator amount over a definite value (which is, for example, 2.80–2.90% for DEGBAC, 3.80–3.85% for DAIP, 3.0–3.5% for DAC, 1.00–1.50% for DMEG, etc.), often presents difficulties in regulation of the gel-forming process, which complicates obtaining a matrix with assigned concentration of the gel fraction, required frequency of cross-links in the spatial structure and mechanical properties of optical materials based on them [55]; and vice versa, a significant decrease of the initiator amount practically in all cases of polymerization of applied diallyl monomers abruptly decreases the rate of gel formation (the fore-polymeric matrix is formed as a result of durable heating up of the reaction mass), which often causes a negative effect on optical properties of selfocs obtained (yellowing of the samples takes place, etc.). Beside the process of fixing RID, of importance for the given RID formation is the stage of molecular exchange of matrix monomers and diffusate. Experimental study of RID formation at molecular exchange of the residual monomer of a gel-polymeric matrix with a monomer-penetrant [24] has shown that, in the first approximation, mutual diffusion of monomers (in gel) can be described by the known Fick equations [24]. In the case of rod-like cylinder samples (if it is assumed that the molecular exchange proceeds in an infinite vat, and the sample volume remains unchanged), an expression describing functional dependence of concentration (C) of one of the components (diffusate) as the function of coordinates and time is presented [24]:
C ( r / R, Dt / R 2 ) = f (r / R, Dt / R 2 ) , C0
(7)
where C0 is the concentration of one of the components (for example, the penetrating agent) on the sample surface. To move from distribution of the component composition to RID, the known Gladstone–Dale equation should be used. Then: n(r/R, Dt/R2) = nM – f(r/R, Dt/R2)(nM – ndif),
(8)
where nM is the refractive index of the initial matrix; ndif is the refractive index of the matrix with completely substituted matrix monomer by the monomer–penetrating agent [24].
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
17
1
30 ∆P/P0⋅100%
2 3 4 5
10
5 4 3 2 1, 6
6 100
200 Time, min
24 Time, h
Figure 4. Kinetic curves of swelling of gel-polymer DAIP samples. The mixture composition (vol.%): MMA:DAIP = 100:0 (1); 87.5:12.5 (2); 75:25 (3); 62.5:37.5 (4); 37.5:62.5 (5); 0:100 (6); T = 20°C.
100
DAIP, mol%
90
1
80 70 60 50
4 2
40
3
5
30 20 10
6 10
20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 t, min
Figure 5. Kinetic curves representing diffusion of fluoroalkyl methacrylales into the DAIP matrix at 50°C: 1 7 – 4FMA; 2 – 8FA; 3 – MAMC [394] ; 4 – 8FMA; 5 – 12FA; 6 – 12FMA.
With regard to these theoretical dependencies, as well as to the fact that the time of formation of assigned RID is proportional to the square of the radius of the cylinder (at constancy of all other factors – temperature, T, pressure, P, volume, V) for the DAIP–MMA system, the authors have obtained experimentally diffusion anomalies that result in acceleration of diffusion compared with the Fick one at an increase of diameter of cylinder samples. The phenomena observed are explained by the ideas of a concentration jump of the diffusion coefficient (plasticization of the matrix by a monomer – penetrating agent), which is explained in the framework of the modified model [24]. These very authors have also found [97] anomalous sorption at molecular diffusion exchange of DAIP and MMA monomers in partially polymerized DAIP matrix, which represents a gel polymer (fore-polymer network impregnated by the non-reacted self monomer). The anomaly results in the extreme character of the kinetic sorption curves (Figure 4), which approach the normal shape at swelling in the mixture of diallylphthalate and MMA as concentration of the latter increases. Gel samples impregnated by MMA up to the equilibrium state, when submersed in DAIP, first, reduce their weight and then restore it up to the initial value. Other authors [98] explain the sorption 7
CH2=C(CH3)COOCH2Si(CH3)3
18
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
DEGBAC, mol%
anomaly by collapse of network polymers (abrupt decrease of their volume), which is interpreted as appearance of the coil–globule transition in subchains composing the network.
Figure 6. Kinetic curves of fluoroalkyl methacrylate diffusion into DEGBAC matrix at different temperatures: 1 – 60°C; 2 – 40°C; 3 – 20°C.
Figure 7. Distribution of the refractive index in the model of DAIP-4FMA gradient element of 5 mm diameter for different temperatures at different moments of time [14, 99]: a) Tdif = 30°C: 1 – 7 min, 2 – 20 min, 3 – 30 min, 4 – 40 min; 5 – 50 min, 6 – 70 min, 7 – 110 min; b) Tdif = 60°C: 1 – 3 min, 2 – 8 min, 3 – 12 min, 4 – 17 min; 5 – 25 min, 6 – 60 min, 7 – 90 min.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
19
Numerous investigations [14, 25, 26, 29, 33, 55 – 57, 61, 65, 66, 96 - 99] of kinetics of the diffusion exchange (Figures 5 and 6, Table 3) and regularities of the diffusion formation of the RID profile in model systems have been performed. Based on the analysis of curves n = f(r) (Figure 6 and 7) and n = f(r2) recorded under different conditions for various systems [24, 25, 26, 33, 37, 55, 99, 100], the general character of RID formation in a selfoc, which is practically identical to that in unitypical monomers, has been stated. Therewith, quantitative indices of the process significantly depend on the molar volume of monomer-diffusates, structure, the boiling point and molecular mobility of the diffusate and the matrix monomer, their relative activity at copolymerization, cross-linking degree of the polymeric matrix, time and temperature of diffusion, etc. [29, 33, 57, 65, 99 - 101]. The role of the ‘reverse’ diffusion at fixing of the RID formed is estimated [29, 56]. It is also indicated that the resulting RID profile is also significantly affected by the initiator concentration and experimental conditions of fixing the distribution of the refractive index obtained [29, 55, 57]. Special attention of investigators dealing with gradient elements is paid to the study of interconnection of RID with their optical and other properties. It is shown that optical characteristics of selfocs are also definitely influenced by factors such as fractional composition of the reaction mixture after obtaining the gel-polymeric matrix, conversion degree, nature of diffusate, the ratio of monomer diffusion rate and the rate of its copolymerization in partially polymerized matrix, etc. [2, 14, 29, 33, 56, 57]. Table 3. Values of activation energy and interdiffusion coefficients for DAIP – MMA, DEGBAC – FMA, DEGBAC – FMA, DAIP – FA, DEGBAC – MAMS systems System studied Diffusate Tetrafluoropropyl methacrylate (4FMA) Octafluoropentyl methacrylate (8FMA) Dodecafluorohexyl methacrylate (12FMA) Octafluoropentyl acrylate (8FA) Dodecafluorohexyl acrylate (12FA) Tetrafluoropropyl methacrylate (4FMA) Octafluoropentyl methacrylate (8FMA) Dodecafluorohexyl methacrylate (12FMA) Octafluoropentyl acrylate (8FA) Dodecafluorohexyl acrylate (12FA) Methacryloyloxymethyltrimethylsilane (MAMC)
E, kJ/mol
Diallylisophthalate (DIAP)
D⋅10–6, cm/s2 at 50°C 10.00
Diallylisophthalate (DIAP)
4.18
21.36
Diallylisophthalate (DIAP)
1.50
34.90
Diallylisophthalate (DIAP) Diallylisophthalate (DIAP)
3.20 1.60
20.01 30.20
Diethyleneglycol-bisallylcarbonate (DEGBAC) Diethyleneglycol-bisallylcarbonate (DEGBAC) Diethyleneglycol-bisallylcarbonate (DEGBAC) Diethyleneglycol-bisallylcarbonate (DEGBAC) Diethyleneglycol-bisallylcarbonate (DEGBAC) Diethyleneglycol-bisallylcarbonate (DEGBAC)
12.00
13.20
6.50
19.26
2.80
23.90
5.90
3.60
4.80
Matrix
15.10
20
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
Physical and mathematical models of RID formation, combined with investigation of optical characteristics of real gradient elements have been suggested [29, 66]. The physical model for studying formation of the refractive index distribution of selfocs may be described in the following manner. In the initial stage, in order to obtain a gel-matrix, polymerization is performed not in a tube, but between two glass plates with a thin (100 – 200 µm) polyethylene layering between them. A round hole is cut off in the layer, in which the component A is installed. When the initial stage is finished, the polyethylene layer is removed, and the plate together with clamped gel-polymeric tablet is placed in a cuvette with the component B. The whole system is thermostatically controlled and placed into one of the shoulders of the Mach – Zender laser interferometer [27]. The process of interdiffusion of A and B components, as well as polymerization during diffusion leads to a constant change of the refractive index distribution in the cross-section of the tablet and, further on, to a change of the interference image. Processing of interferograms recorded by a photocamera is performed by formula (5). Analysis of the results obtained according to this method enables formation and fixation of the refractive index to be studied directly during preparation of polymeric selfocs. The mathematical model of this process is presented as a totality of the following equations [57]:
1.
f1 df1 = ∇[D( f1 + f 3 )]∇ − K1 f1 ; dt f1 + f 3
(9)
2.
df 2 = K1 f1 ; dt
(10)
3.
df 4 = K2 f2 ; dt
(11)
4.
∑ fi = 1 ;
4
(12)
i =1
5. n =
∑ n1 f1 ,
(13)
i =1
where {fi = fi(r, I); I = 1 – 4} are volumetric parts of components A and B and their contributions to polymer, k1 and k2 are rate constants of the polymerization reaction; {ni} are values of partial refractive indices; D is the diffusion coefficient. Each equation has some definite physical meaning. The first equation is deduced from the equation of the Fick diffusion with regard to the fact that diffusion proceeds in an inhomogeneous medium, when the diffusion flow is determined by the relative concentration of diffusing components and their mean free path. Moreover, decrease of the concentration of diffusing particles due to polymerization is also taken into account.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
21
The second and third equations describe the accumulation of immovable polymer at the sacrifice of polymerization of the components A and B, respectively. The fourth equation expresses the assumption that concentration does not influence the diffusion. The fifth equation of the model forms the basis for transition from the concentration distribution to the refractive index distribution. The model equations are solved numerically by a computer. The work indicates the detailed description of functioning of the model, but it does require the participation of an expert operator [57]. Comparing the above-described experimental data and results of theoretical calculations, values of parameters of the model may be determined and the physical image of the process of RID formation may be refined [57]. The method suggested also attracts the attention of investigators, because it enables the possibility of appearance of various RID to be estimated during a relatively short time and the optimal regime to be selected [57]. Based on mathematical modeling, ref. [66] studies the technology of preparation of ‘ideal’ non-aberration spherical lenses with axial gradient of the refractive index. Firstly, the performance is modeled of the exchange diffusion of monomers with various molecular refractions through a plane surface into a semi-infinite formed medium with further polymerization. If a spherical lens is cut off from the sample obtained, then refractive index will change on the segment surface. The problem is raised to clarify such RID profile, when all beams parallel to the optical axis falling on the lens at different heights of the plane surface are focused to a single point. Application of mathematical calculations (RID demanded for preparation of non-aberrational spherical lens and a sequence of Fick’s RID profiles, i.e. the ones occurring due to diffusion, for various moments of time) to a particular DAIP-MMA polymeric system indicated that by cutting off a spherical lens with radius R from a semi-infinite sample in such a manner that the sphere center was located at a distance of 0.95R (R is the sphere radius) from the plane surface border, the optical characteristics of the gradient lens can be improved compared with a homogeneous lens with the same geometrical dimensions. Modeling the ray path in such an inhomogeneous medium shows that longitudinal spherical aberration in the gradient lens will be by some 7.6 times lower than that of an analogous homogeneous lens from PMMA [87]. The method of refractometric control of the diffusate gradient in a cylinder selfoc has been worked out [102]. For the matrix (M), organosilicon dimethacrylate or DEGBAC is taken, and 4FMA is used as diffusate (D) (Table 3). Calculation of n and spatial distribution of the diffusate concentration with respect to the selfoc radius is based on the supposition that the selfoc consists of a copolymer network of substances M and D only. Such a network consisting of monomeric units M and D can be represented (in the calculated model system) by a random alternation of dimers M-M and M-D as repeated units of copolymers. For such polymer network:
(1 − mM-D )A + mM-D RM-D 3 R n = 1 + ⋅ M -M , 2 (1 − mM-D )VM-M + mM-DVM-D
(14a)
22
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
where R and V are refraction and van der Waals volumes of dimers; mM-M and mM-D are their molar proportions, with mM-M = 1 – mM-D. From (14a), it follows that:
mM - D =
3( RM-M
3RM-M − 2(n − 1)VM-M , − RM-D ) − 2(n − 1)(VM-M − VM-D )
(14b)
and the diffusate concentration MD(ini) (mol%) can be calculated by the formula: MD = 100mM-D/2 – 50mM-D at any point of radius (r) of the selfoc, if the value of n(r) at this point is known (in the case of a cylinder selfoc, n(r) is determined by the interference method: see Section 2). It is shown that dependencies of mD and nD can be represented graphically and are of the symbath type (Figure 8) [102].
1.51
70 2
1.50 1
1.49 nD
60 50
1.48
40
1.47
30
1.46
20
1.45
10
1.44
0
0.4
0.8
r
1.2
1.6
mD
0 2.0 mm 2.4
Figure 8. Dependence of the refractive index nD (1) and the molar proportion of diffusate 4FMA (2) on radius of selfoc based on the matrix from DEGBAC.
Creation of estimation criteria of optical quality of selfocs is quite important for production of polymeric gradient elements. The fullest information on optical quality of gradient elements can be obtained if certain of their characteristics are known, such as numerical aperture, NA, the focal length, f ( −
1 = n0α sin αL , where n0 is the refractive f
index on the axis; α is the distribution constant; L is the selfoc length), losses for aberration, focusing focal spot, etc. However, for preliminary estimation of optical properties of selfocs in the first approximation, determination of the RID type with respect to the sample radius is quite sufficient. Several approaches to this problem have been considered. One of them [56] suggests selecting a suitable target function for optimization of the technological process.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
23
This function can be, for example, the mean square deviation of the real or theoretical diffusion curve of distribution from the perfectly focusing function: n −1
σ=
∑ [n0Sech (αr1 ) − n(ri )]
2
i =0
N
,
(15)
where n(ri) are values of the refractive index at the radius point ri obtained from measurements or by solving the Fick diffusion equation for a definite moment of time; N is the number of partition points on the distribution curve (the number of experimental points). It is the authors’ point of view [29, 56] that this approach allows a successful study of the influence of various factors, including conditions of copolymerization diffusion, change of limiting conditions, etc., on the degree to which the perfectly focusing distribution of the refractive index can be approached. It is proved that this method enables optimization of conditions to obtain selfocs designed for any particular application. However, it may be that focusing properties of real gradient elements are different at the same values of σ. That is why the authors assume, as the most correct criterion of estimation of their optical quality, the method of numerical calculation of the ray path in the selfoc according to the Euler equation at the given distribution of the refractive index:
1 n = n0 1 − α 2 r 2 2
(16)
In n = f(r2) coordinates, the dependence is linear. Distortion of the linear dependence in various points of the selfoc radius corresponds to a deviation nD of distribution from the perfectly focusing one, which is observed in real selfocs (Figure 9). This method of RID estimation [72] does not differ significantly from the aboveconsidered method of determination of the mean square deviation (σ) of the refractive index distribution from the parabolic law and is characterized by almost the same drawbacks. In practice, with regard to the above-said, the focal length, focal spot of focusing, numerical aperture, efficiency of radiation input into the guide with the help of selfoc, etc. are assumed [29, 72] as more accurate criteria for estimating optical properties of selfocs. These criteria are also the target functions in calculations of σ. There are other approaches to estimation of optical properties of selfocs, in particular, determination of size of the focusing focal spot and the value of longitudinal spherical aberration [72]. It is proved experimentally and by calculations that minimal values of the focusing focal spot and longitudinal spherical aberration correspond to parabolic (ideally focusing) distribution of the refractive index [72]. The reason for RID deviation from the ideally focusing one in real selfocs (in prepared samples) may be the occurrence of a series of technological difficulties in the production process, for example [29]: decreased diffusion rate of the penetrating agent into gel-polymeric matrix compared with the rate of homopolymerization, with respect to which this process achieves diffusion, and the glass transition of the sample appears prematurely without reaching the parabolic RID; bad miscibility of monomers; improper selection or conduction
24
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
of fixing during diffusion exchange of RID; distortion of the technological process of exchange diffusion; deterioration of the geometric shape of the samples during diffusion or at fixing of the RID formed (for example, bending of the sample or formation of spiral-like ‘cracks’ on their surfaces; etc [29]. 1.57
nD
1.55
1.53 3
1.51 1
1.49
2
1.47 1.45 1.43
0
1
2
3
4
2
5
r , mm
2
6
Figure 9. Dependence of the refractive index on the square of the radius of a selfoc: 1 – the ideal profile; 2, 3 – real profiles.
Based on the analysis of the known works by G.O. Karapetyan and V.I. Kosyakov, valuable conclusions [29, 30] on modernization of processes of preparation of high quality selfocs were made: 1. Processes of diffusion formation of the refractive index profile and its fixing by consequent copolymerization, with continuation of diffusion during fixing of the RID, but at already changed limiting conditions need not always be separated. This, with possible diffusate evaporation from the selfoc surface, will inevitably cause a transformation of the RID formed during diffusion. 2. The process of RID fixing should be performed during a shorter time than is required for a noticeable change of the distribution reached (for example, decreasing the fixing temperature of RID and, consequently, decelerating diffusion, or performing prepolymerization by radiation initiation); 3. The RID profile can be controlled by conduction of simultaneous diffusion of several monomers copolymerized with the matrix, which possess different atomic refractions and molecular masses; 4. To increase stability of optical characteristics of selfocs, it is necessary to select conditions that would provide possibly high conversion of comonomers of the stage of fixing of the RID formed in order to eliminate its change with time due to elimination of a residual (unreacted) monomer – diffusate from the matrix.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
25
Elaboration of theoretical grounds of selection of the gradient composition and criteria of estimation of optical properties of selfocs, as well as the inclusion of results of physicochemical investigations of the diffusion formation of RID performed, allowed transition from relatively empirical approaches to creation of GRIN-elements to more scientifically established ones. This provided refinement of the diffusion technology and techniques of selfoc preparation with the required excellent properties [103 - 107]. This provided the possibility for creation of optical systems of the modern generation, in particular, those used in computing and copying devices, as well as fast-operating hardware for information processing and transmission, etc. Examples of technologies used to obtain GRIN-elements can be found in refs. [41, 103 – 108]. Among these works, special mention should be made of refs. [41, 105, 108]. Reference [105] describes the closed extrusive technology (see Section 6) for obtaining polymeric gradient materials possessing square distribution of the refractive index. It is indicated that geometry of the master form (matrix) and length of the diffusion zone affect significantly the type of refractive index distribution in the gradient material (fiber). The key parameters controlling the RID formed during this process are composition of the reaction mixture, length and temperature of the diffusion zone, etc. Mutual diffusion in a closed system of monomers with different refractive indices (for example, MMA and benzyl methacrylate (BzMA)) is strengthened due to elongation of the diffusion zone that leads to a growth of homogeneous distribution of monomers in PGs. Obtaining PGs (gradient elements) with high values of ∆n allows their application to modern facsimile (fax) equipment [105]. A method has been described to obtain polymeric rod lenses with a gradient of refractive index (Figure 10) [41] without bubbles and voids using copolymerization (swollen-gel polymerization) of methyl methacrylate (MMA, nD = 1.490) with benzyl methacrylate (BzMA, nD = 1.1570) in a polymethacrylate pipe, where diffusion of the monomer with higher refractive index into swollen PMMA-MMA gel takes place.
∆n
0.01
0.005
0.000
0.0
3.5 r, mm 7.0
Figure 10. Profile of refractive index for polymeric rod lens based on MMA-BzMA (4:1)
26
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
The diameter of the polymeric rod obtained is from 14.5 to 15 mm (diameter of PMMA pipe) after copolymerization. Concentration of MMA increases from the pipe wall to its center, and a gradient of refraction index is formed. In this case, defocusing selfocs are obtained. By the same methods, focusing selfocs can also be obtained [41]. Very large radial graded-index polymer materials were first prepared by two methods [106]: 1. The so-called ‘curved mold method’; 2. The method of diffusional copolymerization. These methods allowed production of GRIN-materials with a diameter of 70 mm and a difference of refractive index ∆ ≥ 0.02 [106]. The first method enables us to prepare large GRIN-materials with various values of the difference in refractive index and RID profile. Larger GRIN-materials may possibly be obtained by the same diffusional method, by modernization of the existing method of preparing polymeric materials with a gradient of refractive index. The authors suggest that GRIN-materials produced according to their method can be successfully applied to production of thin ophthalmic lenses without specific aberrations or multifocusing characteristics [106]. Y. Koike et al. [107, 108] obtained commercial high-bandwidth graded-index polymer optical fiber with quadratic RID profile and capable of transmitting optical signals at a high rate in short-wave multimedia (multimodal, multichannel) translation networks by the method of interphase gel-polymerization [109], which could not be performed using polymer optical fibers possessing a stepwise RID profile [108]. It is common knowledge that the refractive index (RI) in cylinder-shaped gradient elements does not change in the axial direction. At the same time, of special interest are gradient lenses possessing a RI gradient, in both the radial and axial directions [60]. Such lenses can be obtained by substance diffusion into the plate covered by a mask impermeable for diffusate [65]. The method seems to have potential for successful development of the planar technology in the microelectronics industry [107]. An analytical expression describing the ideally focusing RID in such lenses has not yet been derived. That is why deduction of regularities of RID profile formation control is possible on the basis of experimental data only [110]. Reference [60] describes the influence of various factors on RID formation in polymeric planar structures (forepolymeric matrix from DAIP – maneic anhydride (MA) – penetrant – MMA; MA is injected into the matrix composition for decreasing cross-link frequency, which reduces mechanical stresses occurring at diffusion). It is found by studying thin slices on the Mach-Zender interferometer by the method from ref. [30] that providing for high jump of RI and elimination of RID profile deformation demand combination of profile diffusional formation with its fixing. At short diffusion duration and low temperature, at which polymerization rate is low, deep permeation of the penetrating agent into the matrix and decrease of RI at the mask surface and the area below it are observed. The authors associate this fact with an increase of the diffusion coefficient with temperature up to the fixing point. As a result, the penetrating agent does not actively diffuse deep into the matrix until the sample is polymerized completely.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
27
Reduction of the diffusion temperature from 80°C to 60°C decreases RI difference at the same level of penetrating agent permeation. Further on, as expected, it is shown that the increase of the diffusion tank volume leads to a decrease of the absolute RI value in the area bordering the diffusion tank. The relation of the initiator concentration (benzoyl peroxide – BP) in the matrix and penetrating agent defines the moment of diffusion stage transition into the stage of diffusion profile fixing and, finally, causes a significant influence on the RID type as a result. At low concentration of initiator in the matrix, the absolute RI value of the matrix – diffusion tank interface decreases in the border area due to penetrating of greater amount of MMA monomer into it, whereas in the presence of the initiator in the diffusion tank polymerization of the whole volume of the tank is accelerated, the amount of MMA molecules capable of diffusing deep into the matrix decreases, and the absolute RI value increases in the whole gradient layer [60]. Planar lenses obtained by the method described are of long focal length. Despite the large jump of RI (∆n ≈ 0.03), the numerical aperture NA ≤ 0.01 due to a short ray path in the gradient layer, and diameter of the focal spot (df ≈ 80 µm) are close to the theoretical diffraction limit for the given numerical aperture [60]. Micro-lenses are widely used in electro-optical and information transmitting systems [111 - 117]. To create lenses of this type, diffusion of a monomer is performed to a forepolymeric plane support through a mask. Therewith, the refractive index gradient is formed in both radial and axial directions. The mask shape is determined by the difference of the support refractive index – a sequence of disks is used as mask, around which diffusion of the monomer proceeds. By this method, a system of plane microlenses was prepared, in which DAIP monomer was used as the support, with MMA as the diffusate. (The focal point of the microlenses was 27 µm, the focal length was 25 mm) [113]. Attention is drawn to planar polymer lenses with diameter d ≥ 3 – 6 mm, obtained by diffusion exchange. The expediency of combining diffusion and depolymerization stages for the purpose of approximation of the RID obtained to the ideally focusing one is shown [117].
3.2. Copolymerization Method One of the traditional methods of obtaining GRIN-elements is the method of copolymerization of monomers [11, 42, 43, 118 - 123]. During usual radical-initiated copolymerization of a mixture of two or three monomers, distribution of the composition of the copolymers obtained is dependent upon the temperature gradient and different reactivity of monomers with different refractive indices. Polymeric material with a gradient of refractive index along the axis (for preparing lenses with a spherical entering surface and planar exit surface) is prepared [11] by the copolymerization method, based first on the difference in reactivity of monomers. The method of gel-copolymerization on the interface for obtaining gradient elements (polymeric media) of various geometrical forms has been described [43]: radical-symmetric, axial-symmetric, spherical gradient polymeric media, as well as gradient wavebeam guide (PG).
28
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
Samples obtained by copolymerization of monomer mixtures photoinitiates by UVradiation and, to fulfill certain requirements (for example, n1 ≠ n2), are also characterized by gradient distribution of the component composition. Gradient-forming factors are different activities of monomers and gradient of the initiation field [11]. References [119, 120, 122, 123] give details of a method of preparing light- focusing polymeric elements by photopolymerization of monomers possessing different relative activities and different refractive indices. The mixture of monomers existing in a soldered glassy pipe is radiated by UV-light and rotated simultaneously. A couple of monomers M1 and M2, selected for creation of selfocs by copolymerization, must fit the following conditions: in the refractive index n1 of the homopolymer M1 is smaller than the refractive index n2 of the homopolymer M2, then relative activity r1 of the monomer M1 must be greater than 1, and relative activity r2 of the monomer M2 must be smaller than 1. In this case, the copolymer formed initially at the pipe surface is more saturated by the component with higher relative activity. Concentration of molecules with lower relative activity grows in moving towards the rod axis. As a result, the rod obtained possesses a radial distribution of the polymer composition and, consequently, of the refractive index. Preparations can be obtained by copolymerization of two monomers, such as methyl methacrylate – vinylbenzoate, for which r1 > r2 and nD1 < nD2. Unfortunately, such a binary system does not produce the desired distribution of the refractive index, especially near the preparation center [121]. To obtain a selfoc possessing a radial jump of the refractive index, copolymerization is performed in a quartz ampoule with d = 112 ± 3 mm rotating around its axis in the presence 20
of a photoinitiator. Selfocs based on N-vinylphthalimide (VPI, nD = 1.62) and methacrylic 20
acid (MAC) ethers ( nD = 1.48 – 1.49) copolymers have been obtained [121]. It has been found that the refractive index jump increases with exposure time and molar proportion of Nvinylphthalimide. Dependence of ∆n on r with increase of the initiator concentration and VPI content in the initial mixture of monomers was also found [43, 121]. In the case of three monomers, they must satisfy the following conditions: {r12(M1/M2)m + 1}/{(M1/M2)m + r21} > 1.1; {r13(M1/M3)m + 1}/{(M1/M3)m + r31} > 1.1; {r23(M2/M3)m + 1}/{(M2/M3)m + r32} > 1.1,
(17)
where (M1/M2)m, (M1/M3)m, and (M2/M3)m are molar concentrations, and r12, r13, r21, r23, r31, r32 are constants of copolymerization characterizing their relative activities. Due to difference in reactivities of the monomers in the three-component system, for example, methyl methacrylate – acrylonitrile – vinylbenzoate [11, 19], at the initial stage of polymerization, the polymerizate contains a greater amount of PMMA chains (nD = 1.49), then PAN (polyacrylonitrile) concentration increases (nD = 1.52), and at the end of copolymerization vinylbenzoate homopolymer (PVB) is mostly formed (nD = 1.58). Polymerization begins on the walls of a cylinder vessel rotated around its axis and UV-radiated, and propagates to the center of the reactor. A similar result is obtained for the triple methyl methacrylate – vinyl acetate – N-vinylcarbazole system [11, 43].
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
29
Selfocs of various shapes – cylinder, branched, spherical – can be obtained by varying the form of the polymeric support. If several holes are made in the polymeric form, a series of samples can be prepared simultaneously [11, 19]. The advantage of the copolymerization method is that it provides the possibility of drawing gradient fibers directly from the rod, because substances forming linear thermoplastic copolymer can be used as initial monomers; so RID in PG differs insignificantly from RID in the initial preparation. The drawback of this method is the difficulty of controlling thedistribution of the refractive index in the optical element. However, in most cases, distribution of the refractive index in samples obtained by photocopolymerization of monomers is rather far from the ideally focusing one, and optical characteristics of such selfocs only poorly fit the demands imposed. The method of photocopolymerization for preparation of GRIN-elements does not produce stable characteristics due to a significant amount of residual monomer present in these elements as the result of copolymerization by UV-radiation.
3.3. Method of Gravitational Separation An original method of obtaining a gradient guide with the help of centrifugation has been suggested [52]. Monomers are selected such that the monomer M1, initially at polymerization, gives a homopolymer with low refractive index. Subsequently, the second monomer M2 gives a homopolymer with high refractive index. Placed into the centrifuge together with the initiator, the monomer and the polymer formed distribute under the influence of the centrifugal force as follows: most of the polymer moves to the periphery, whereas the monomer locates in the center of the volume. This gives the distribution of the future composite. At the centrifuge output nozzle, the temperature is kept at the level of 80°C, and then the monomer is polymerized in a special reactor. In another case, a mixture of the monomer and the polymer is centrifuged and cured up completely at the output of the centrifuge. Unfortunately, this method has not yet been widely applied.
3.4. Method of Dipolephoresis The process of natural diffusion of the cover monomer into the core polymer may be intensified by dipolephoresis (Figure 11), which is the induced diffusion of polymer molecules possessing a dipole moment under the effect of a significantly inhomogeneous electrostatic field of required configuration (dipoles in electrostatic field do not only orient, but also move in the direction opposite to the field gradient). If the direction of motion of polar molecules of the monomer under influence of the inducing field coincides with the diffusion direction proceeding under the effect of concentration forces, then velocities of motion of polar molecules are additive, diffusion is intensified, and the diffusion coefficient in this case depends not only on temperature and viscosity of the material, in which diffusion is performed, but also on the dipole momentum value of the diffusate molecules.
30
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
References [63, 64] indicate the principle of estimation of diffusion of polar particles under the influence of an inducing force of inhomogeneous electric field using a mathematical estimation of the type for diffusion waves of dipole particle flow in an axially symmetric field. Distribution of the molecules of diffusers in the polymeric cylinder may be described as follows [63]: C(t, r) ≈ const⋅r2.
(18)
Using the formula by Ber–Gladstone–Dale for the refractive index
n = 1 + const ⋅ N ,
(19)
where N is the density of particles of the substance studied. For the refractive index of a polymeric cylinder (with radius R) the following expressions are obtained: before diffusion:
n0 = 1 + (const)0N,
and during diffusion:
n1 = 1 + (const)1C(r1t).
(20)
Using the Landolf principle of refraction additivity, the equation for refractive index of a cylinder rod after dipolephoresis, reaching the core, was obtained [63]: n(r, t) ≈ n0 + (n1 – n0)ξ(t1)r2, where
ξ (t1 ) =
(21)
C0 ϕ (t , r ) . NR 2
Figure 11. Interferogram of fine cross-sections of a cylinder sample of polymer after introduction of a diffusate under the effect of inhomogeneous electrostatic field [63]
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
31
This equation indicates that the refractive index, obtained after dipolephoresis of the cylinder, grows or decreases towards the center depending on relative values of the refractive index of matrix and diffusate as the square of the radius. It should also be noted that dipolephoresis may be used as the basis for elaboration of a method of analysis and separation of a substance from mixtures (if the substances comprising the mixture components differ by values of dipole moments like the difference in diffusion velocity of molecules possessing different dipolar moments in a medium of the gel type in a significantly inhomogeneous electrostatic field).
3.5. Method of Gradient Modification of Polymeric Materials A light conducting polymeric material with ∆nD = 11% may be obtained by impregnation of the polymer with ‘microcavities’ by a resin (the refractive index of which is much higher than that of the matrix polymer) [44], and with further thermal curing. The initial polymer with ‘microcavities’ is obtained by UV-radiation of a mixture of the polymer and the monomer (for example, PMMA-MMA, i.e. components identical in chemical structure) through a hollow gage. It has been shown that repeated distillation heating of a gel-polymer based on vinyl monomers (for example, vinyl acetate–vinylidene cyanide) at 160–180°C alternating with rapid cooling down leads to an increase of the refractive index by 0.33–0.70% [45]. A gradient polymeric material may also be obtained by a specific treatment of a polymeric beam waveguide surface. Thus, for example, processing of an optical fiber consisting of the core and the cover (PMMA), by a low-molecular alcohol leads to a decrease of refractive index by diffusion of the low-molecular compound and breach of the cover structure [2]. Fluorination of surfaces of various polymeric materials by gaseous fluorine was shown to produce a significant increase of their permeability, for example, in the case of polyvinylchloride, polypropylene, polyethylene, and polyacrylonitrile in the range of 0.3 – 2.6 µm by 4% [51]. Variations of the present method are discussed below in Sect. 4.
4. CONTROLLED GRADIENT FORMATION 4.1. Main Principles of Formation of Macrosurface GRIN-Elements [124] As mentioned above, the most widespread methods of evaluation of the refractive index gradient – the two-stage (diffusion, gradual) copolymerization [33, 34, 55] and photopolymerization [119, 120], during which the gradient is formed due to the diffusion laws – produce material with parabolic change of the refractive index profile only. Moreover, diffusion, being a limiting process, limits the diameter of the objects produced up to ~20 mm. Methods are known, however, in which these restrictions are eliminated, for example, methods of obtaining of a planar lens [106, 125] and a long process for forming optical fibers [124, 126], in which the refractive index over the object radius (not limited by diffusion, in
32
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
this case) may be changed according to the previously given parabolic law, but not only limited to this case. The general significant drawback of all the above methods is their limiting of the selection of applied polymers, because they cannot produce selfocs from polycondensed polymers, or polymerizational monomers, synthesized from gaseous ones. Let us note some further restrictions of the traditional preparation methods. Figure 12 shows a block-scheme to obtain a gradient polymeric lens by the method of vapor/liquidphase diffusion [11]. According to this method, in order to decrease spherical aberrations, the whole spherical surface of the gel-polymeric object with a planar output surface (Figure 12) is processed simultaneously by a monomer–diffusate. As a result, a homogeneous diffusion layer is formed (Figure 12). Hence, the approach to solution of correction of such optical distortions is restricted from the point of view of the need to regulate the thickness of the gradient layer with respect to the lens radius.
Figure 12. Block-scheme of the diffusion technique method.
The technique of creation of a diffusion surface, i.e. surfaces with the given spherical gradient of the diffusion layer, includes additional operations. Such an approach was created for optical inorganic glasses [12]. First, the whole surface of the object (Figure 13, a) is processed simultaneously by a diffusate (by melting of a mixture of metals). Alkaline metals from the glass are exchanged with metal ions from the melt forming a homogeneous diffusion layer with gradual growth of n on the surface of the glassy body (Figure 13, b, c). Further on in the process, a layer of required thickness is partially removed (polished off) from the diffusion surface, and an optical element with non-homogeneous refracting surface is obtained (Figure 13, d). This widens significantly the ability to correct optical distortions and provides the possibility of producing planar lenses as well (Figure 13, e).
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
33
In this connection, it has been suggested that non-traditional solution of creation of gradient optical media – the method of controlled gradient formation – may provide the possibility of obtaining thin-layer materials based on polymerization and polycondensation polymers with great surface area and preliminarily given radial (axial) distribution of the refractive index, with no dependence on the aggregate state and chemical nature of appropriate monomers that determine the specificity of the polymer synthesis [61, 127 - 133].
b
a
c
d
e
Figure 13. Obtaining gradient optical elements by the exchange diffusion method: initial gelpolymeric/glassy lens (a), gel-polymeric (b) and glassy (c) lenses with homogeneous gradient layer; glassy lens with inhomogeneous gradient layer (d); planar glassy lens of positive spherical type (e).
The controlled gradient formation, realized in various technological solutions, is based on the controlled gradient chemical modification, in particular, the controlled gradient heterogeneous (solid-phase) polymer-analogous transformation and the already mentioned two-stage (gradual) copolymerization [33, 38, 55]. The main principles of the controlled gradient formation concludes in an optically transparent polymeric or gel-polymeric film/plate that serves as a matrix–carrier of the refractive index gradient. Selection of a gradient carrier is not limited by the conditions of its synthesis which, in turn, are determined by the aggregate state and chemical nature of the appropriate monomers. That is why the gradient carrier may be a polymerization or polycondensation polymer, produced by any method. The gradient carrier must possess the property that it can be subjected to a polymeranalogous transformation or two-stage (gradual) copolymerization, which results in formation of an optically transparent polymer with another (greater or lower) value of the refractive index. Therewith, the initial and newly formed polymers must not dissolve under conditions of polymer-analogous transformation. Moreover, the gradient carrier must be stable in retaining the shape of the initial sample (films, plates) and physicomechanical properties, as well as providing stable new properties. Chemical modification of the gradient carrier by polymer-analogous transformation/twostage copolymerization is performed by its interaction with the gradient former, the chemically active medium/monomer–diffusant, which may be an individual liquid substance or liquid solution of a gas, liquid or solid. In some cases, the gradient former may exist in the
34
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
gaseous state [134]. A liquid, inert in relation to the chemically active medium, as well as to the initial and newly formed polymer is applied in solving some specific problems. To resolve the onset problem, the inert liquid must possess higher or lower density than that of the gradient former. A constructive scheme for performing controlled gradient formation is known (see below), the application of which makes unnecessary the selection of a definite ratio of the gradient former density and inert liquid [135]. A magnetic liquid may be used as the inert liquid [129, 130]. In this case, its density is of no concern. Of special importance for realization of the controlled gradient formation is an understanding of the reaction mechanism (polymer-analogous transformation /diffusion copolymerization) so that the duration of the process can be determined in order to control the reaction product. Specifically, the refractive index change with time is investigated, i.e. the function n = f(τ) is determined, where n is the refractive index, τ is the duration of chemical reaction/diffusion. Moreover, reaction parameters must be selected that will produce more or less complete transformations within the technologically available time, i.e. when the maximal value of τ in the function n = f(τ), necessary for finishing the process, does not exceed a limit, set by technological, economic or any other reasons. At the same time, the minimal value of τ, at which transformation of the refractive index may be detected (i.e. the induction period of the transformation), is several minutes long. The starting quantitative characteristics for determining the regime of polymeranalogous/diffusion copolymerization are: -
-
Values of refractive indices n of the initial polymer (in polymer-analogous transformation) or homopolymer (the product of prepolymerization of a gelpolymer); Value of the refractive index of the process product (polymer-analogous transformation/diffusion copolymerization); Previously given profile of the radial (axial) distribution of the refractive index n, i.e the function n = f(R), where R is the radius (length) of the sample; Dependence of change of the refractive index n on the process duration, determined experimentally, i.e. the function n = f(τ) with the help of which the given dependence n = f(R) transforms to the form of n = f(R).
From the algorithm formulated, polymeric systems of given size and with given profile of distribution of the refractive index may be created. Actually, different contact duration of the gradient former (chemically active liquid/monomer-diffusate) and gradient carrier in the points of some line, for example, the straight one on the surface of the latter, will provide for an adequate change of the refractive index due to structural changes, the depth of which depends on the process duration. Interpolation of values of the refractive index, stated for discrete periods of time, produces a continuous sequence of these changes in the continuum scale. Hence, in the method of controlled gradient formation, formation of the given distribution of the refractive index is produced by gradient of the process duration on the surface of the gradient carrier. That is why, accurate regulation of this parameter in the given directions on the sample surface represents an important technical requirement in the method discussed.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
35
Creation of the radial distribution of the refractive index is achieved by controlled change of the diaphragm mask size in the chemical reaction/diffusion zone on the surface of polymeric/gel-polymeric film (plate). It should be specially noted that when radial distribution of the refractive index is formed from one and the same process (polymer-analogous transformation /diffusion copolymerization), two principally different results may be achieved – obtaining of a polymeric medium with the properties of a convex or concave plate lens. Actually, if n1 (the initial polymer/homopolymer – the product of prepolymerization of gel-polymer) is greater than n2 (the product of polymer-analogous transformation/diffusion copolymerization), then decrease of the process duration with the radius of the polymeric/gelpolymeric film/plate from its periphery to center gives a medium with properties of a convex lens and, vice versa, at the increase of the process duration with sample radius from periphery to center, a medium possessing properties of a concave lens may be obtained. The opposite results are obtained, when polymer-analogous transformation /diffusion copolymerization is accompanied by an increase of refractive index, i.e. when n1 > n2. In this case, decrease of the process duration by the sample radius from the periphery to the center produces a medium with properties of a concave lens, and increase gives a medium with properties of a convex lens. In this process, the results mentioned are achieved under conditions of injection of an active medium/diffusate and an inert liquid into the reactor under different regimens.
4.2. Equipment To set the required duration of the process (polymer-analogous transformation/ diffusion copolymerization) in given directions on the surface of the gradient carrier a device is used that allows use of a diaphragm mask in the contact zone of the gradient former with the gradient carrier. Several technical solutions of application of such devices have been suggested. a) Use of the diaphragm mask in the centrifugal field [127, 128, 131] The contact zone between the gradient former and the gradient carrier may be variably masked using a diaphragm in the centrifugal field, created in the cylinder reactor rotating vertically around its axis. The main features of such a device (diametrical cross-section) are shown in Figure 14, a. The device consists of the cylinder reactor (4) possessing a round groove (11). A polymeric sample (18) (film/plate) is located in the reactor (4) between clips (3, 20). Round clips (3, 20) possess holes (2, 10, 14, 21). The face of the reactor (4) and the lid (19) possess juts–rolls (11, 16), in which pipes (6, 15) for input/output of liquid (a gradient former or an inert liquid) are located. Ends of the pipes (6, 15) in the reactor (4) are curved perpendicularly, and the external circles are connected to the pipe (12), which is connected, in its turn, with the gradient former/inter liquid tank. Introduced into the pipes (6, 15) are pipes (5, 17) for input/output of the gradient former/inert liquid. External ends of the pipes (5, 17) are connected with the pipe (1) which, in turn, is connected with the gradient former/inert liquid tank. If required, the pipes (5, 17) may serve as air eliminators. The reactor (4) possesses a hole with a plug (13) for liquid output. The rod (7) is connected with an electric motor (9) by a V-belt (8).
36
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov 2
21 20
1
3 4 5 6
4
19 18 17
7 8
22 27 23 26 24 25
16 15
9 13 14
10 11 12
b
a
Figure 14. The device for controlled radial-gradient polymer-analogous transfor-mation and exchange diffusion in the centrifugal field (diametrical cross-section). See text for details.
In some cases, especially at the application of gel-polymeric matrix as the gradient carrier, tight fixing of the latter in the rotating reactor must be provided. For this purpose, the gel-polymeric sample (23) (Figure 14, b) is placed in a circle framework (26) which, in turn, is fixed to immovable details (22, 24, 25, 27) in the reactor (4).
1 15
2
14 13 12
3 4 5 6 7
S
N
11 10 9 N
S
8 ~U Figure 15. The device for controlled radial-gradient polymer-analogous transfor-mation and exchange diffusion in magnetic field (diametrical cross-section). See text for details.
b) Use of the diaphragm mask in a magnetic field [129, 130] The contact zone between the gradient former and the gradient carrier may be gradually increased by use of a diaphragm mask in a device, the main features of which (the diametrical cross-section) are shown in Figure 15. The operation principle of the device is based on simultaneous application of magnetic field and ferromagnetic liquid as the inert one. The
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
37
device consists of a cylinder reactor (12), prepared from non-magnetic material. A round polymeric/gel-polymeric sample (11) (film, plate) is located between round clips (7, 9). The reactor (12) possesses a round groove (14) and a cover (4). Round clips possess holes (3, 6, 10, 13). Pipes (1, 2, 8) for input/output of the gradient former/ ferromagnetic liquid are connected to the reactor. If required, the same pipes may serve as air supplies. The reactor (12) is located in the circle electromagnet (5) or between poles of a horseshoe magnet (5). c) Use of the diaphragm mask between horizontal surfaces [135] In the solution suggested, the possibility of regulating the contact zone between the gradient former and the gradient carrier is based on the effect of the surface tension, under the effect of which the “inert medium/gradient former concluded in the inert medium” system not wetting the gradient carrier obtains the shape of a flattened globe – a circle, thus providing for a vertical contact between the gradient former and the inert medium. The main features of the device (diametrical cross-section) are shown in Figure 16. It consists of two parallel plates (2, 5), between which, in parallel, a polymeric/gel-polymeric sample (film/plate) (3) is placed, fixed by the circle clip (4). The plates (2, 5) and the clip (4) are connected with the control clip (6), by which they are set parallel. The distance between the sample (3) and the plates (2, 5) is selected so that if the gradient former and the inert liquid locate between them simultaneously, they contact each other in the vertical plane only. A pipe (8), connected with the curved pipe (15), is introduced to the center of the plate (5). In its turn, the pipe (15) is connected to the pipe (17) through a rubber pipe (16). Another end of the pipe (17) is introduced into the center of the plate (2). The pipe (8), through the pipe (14) introduced to the glass (7) bottom and the rubber pipe (13) is connected with the T-joint (12) connected, in turn, with tanks for gradient former/inert liquid (10, 11). The device possesses the cover (1) and branch/inlet pipes (9, 18). Plates (2, 5) and the sample (3) are disposed horizontally.
1
18
2 17
3 4 5 6 7 8
16 15 14 13
9
12 10
11
Figure 16. The device for controlled radial-gradient polymer-analogous transfor-mation and horizontal exchange diffusion (diametrical cross-section). See text for details.
38
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
4.3. Theoretical Requirements for Controlled Gradient Formation [127 – 131, 133 - 135] The theoretical principles underlying the controlled gradient formation are clear and independent of the diaphragm mask used in the contact zone between the gradient former and the gradient carrier. First, these reasons will be discussed in relation to use of a diaphragm mask in the centrifugal field (Figure 14, a, b). In the reactor, diaphragm masking the transformation zone may be performed by using a gradient former only or a gradient former and an inert liquid simultaneously. In the second case, the sequence of their introduction into the apparatus is determined by the nature of the problem, namely, which polymeric medium, possessing properties of a convex or concave lens, is required. When a particular problem is to be solved, the relation of densities of the gradient former and the inert liquid, the relation of values of refractive indices of the initial polymer/prepolymerized gel-polymer and the product of polymer-analogous/diffusion copolymerization should be taken into account, and the character of variation (increase or reduction) of the gradient formation duration with respect to sample radius from its periphery to center should be determined. The reactor (4) (Figure 14, a) may be filled first both by the gradient former and the inert liquid. The first liquid, with no regard to its relative density, is always injected at the periphery of the rotating reactor (4) (via pipes (12, 6,15)). That is why, an air supply is always situated in the center of the reactor (pipes (5, 17, 1)). The second liquid, if it is heavier than the first, is injected into the periphery pipes (12, 6, 15)). In this case, the first liquid is pressed off through the center (pipes (5, 17, 1)). If the second liquid is lighter that the first one, it is injected through the center, and the first liquid is ejected from the reactor periphery. The character of the duration of the change of the gradient formation over the sample radius from periphery to center is determined from the ratio of densities of the gradient former and the inert liquid. When the density of the gradient former is higher (lower) than that of the inert liquid, despite the sequence of their inlet, duration of the gradient formation decreases (increases) from periphery to center. Analogous general rules may also be formulated for processes of the gradient formation in a magnetic field. The reactor (12) (Figure 15) is first filled by a gradient former or a ferromagnetic liquid. Whatever the inlet order of liquids to the reactor when a horseshoeshaped magnet is used, the duration of the gradient formation decreases with sample radius from periphery to center; in the case of a circular magnet, it increases. When the reactor is located in the circular magnet, the ferromagnetic liquid is injected into and ejected from the peripheral (pipe (2)). If the reactor is placed between the poles of the horseshoe-shaped magnet, the ferromagnetic liquid is injected into and ejected from the center (pipe (1)). In this connection, in the case of the circular magnet, the gradient former is ejected from the center (pipe (1)), and in the case of the horseshoe-shaped magnet, it is from the peripheral pipe (pipe (2)). The reactor is always preliminarily filled by the gradient former from the periphery (pipe 8). When the ferromagnetic liquid must be pressed off by the gradient former, in the case of a horseshoe-shaped magnet, the latter is injected into the periphery (pipe 8), and in the case of a circular one, into the center (pipe 1). Table 4 shows all the above-discussed variants of controlled gradient formation, conditions of their performance, and optical properties of plane-parallel optical systems obtained.
Table 4. Creation of polymeric media with given profile of radial distribution of the refractive index, by methods of controlled heterogeneous polymer-analogous transformation and controlled two-stage exchange diffusion, in centrifugal and magnetic fields Density, ρ
Change of the process duration (polymeranalogous transformation/exc hange diffusion by radius of polymeric/ gel-polymeric sample from periphery to center
Decreases
ρ (GF) > ρ(IL)
No.
1 2 3 4
5 Increases
ρ (GF) < ρ(IL)
6
7 8 9
Field
Centrifugal (sample rotates) Centrifugal (sample is immovable) Centrifugal (sample is immovable) Magnetic (horseshoeshape magnet)
Preliminary filling
IL
Sequence of inlet of gradient former (GF)/inert liquid (IL) Regime of dosed Change of GF/IL inlet refractive index with sample radius from periphery to center On periphery To center Increases Decreases GF n(initial)> n(initial)< VGF(τ) = πhx(τ)[2R – x(τ)] GF n(product) n(product) Dozed inlet
GF
IL
GF
IL (ferromagn.)
Magnetic (horseshoeshape magnet) Centrifugal (sample rotates/immovable)
IL(ferromagn.) GF
Centrifugal (sample rotates/immovable) Magnetic (circular magnet) Magnetic (circular magnet)
IL GF IL(ferromagn.)
VIL(τ) = πhx[R – x(τ)]2
GF IL
n(initial)< n(product)
n(initial)> n(product)
VGF(τ) = πhx(τ)[2R – x(τ)] VIL(τ) = πhx[R2 – x2(τ)]
GF
VGF(τ) = πhx2(τ)
GF
VIL(τ) = πhx[R2 – x2(τ)] VGF(τ) = πhx2(τ)
IL(ferro magnetic)
40
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
In technical solutions of the controlled gradient formation considered, the possibility of using gaseous substances as gradient former/inert medium is somewhat restricted. These restrictions are eliminated when the process is performed in the horizontal plane between two surfaces (Figure 16). In this case, there is no need to take account of values of densities of the gradient former and the inert medium. The identity of results obtained by the latter and former methods (Table 4) will be indicated below in the discussion. a) Gradient formation with respect to sample radius from periphery to center at decrease of the process duration [127, 129]. To simplify calculations, radius of the sample (polymeric/gel-polymeric film/plate) is made equal to the internal radius of the reactor (4) (Figure 14, a). The internal volume of the reactor V0 = πR2h, where h is the internal height of the cylinder reactor. A gradient former (chemically active liquid/monomer-diffusate), injected via pipes (12, 6, 15) into the reactor rotating around the axis (Table 4, variant N1) under the effect of a centrifugal field is pressed off to the reactor wall and obtains the shape of a hollow cylinder with wall thickness x. Hence, the part of the sample radius R contacting the gradient former is also equal to x. As the gradient former is injected into the reactor, the value of x increases from 0 to R. Dependence of volume of the gradient former on x is represented by the following relations: V(x) = π(R – x)2h,
(22)
V(x) = πx(2R – x)h.
(23)
To write down the dependence of the gradient former volume, injected into the reactor, on the transformation duration τ at the given τ(x), determined by the function τ = f(R), the reverse function x(τ) is derived and then substituted into equation: V(τ) = πhx(τ)[2R – x(τ)].
(24)
This equation expresses the dynamics of the gradient former introduction into the reactor, which provides the regime of formation of the transformation product with the given radial distribution of the refractive index under conditions of spreading of the gradient formation front with decrease of its duration with respect to the radius from periphery to center. As mentioned above, the algorithm of the controlled gradient formation suggested includes two principally different (from the point of view of the process mechanism) approaches to the problem of creation of gradient systems – controlled polymeranalogous transformation and controlled exchange diffusion with consequent copolymerization. However, in the latter case, some preventive measures may become necessary. A labile gel-polymeric sample is deformed in the centrifugal field – the sample material is shifted from its center to the periphery, and at high frequencies of reactor rotation, which is necessary for providing strictly round front of the exchange diffusion, the overall shape of the sample may be distorted. This may be easily eliminated if the gelpolymeric sample is encased in a round holder, fastened to immovable parts inside the rotating reactor (4) (Figure 14, c). Moreover, before the onset of the dosed inlet of the monomer-diffusate according to equation (24), the reactor must be filled by an inert liquid, the density of which is lower than that of the monomer-diffusate (Table 4, variant N2). This will prevent the possibility of uncontrolled impact of monomer-diffusate drops
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
41
on the surface of the immovable gel-polymeric sample, and thereby excludes the possibility of distortion of the given profile of the radial distribution of refractive index. Further injected monomer-diffusate possessing higher density than the inert liquid is moved to the reactor wall, pressing out the inert liquid trough pipes (5, 17, 1) (Figure 14, a). When the exchange diffusion is ended, the composition gradient is fixed as usual, by completing the gel-polymeric matrix polymerization. It is desirable that the completion of the polymerization, as well as obtaining the gelpolymeric matrix, should be performed in a device in which one of two plane-parallel surfaces is moved as the gel-polymeric sample shrinks during copolymerization, providing equal decrease of the volume and plane-parallelism of the copolymerized sample [133]. Let us consider setting of conditions of the gradient formation front change with decrease of its duration by radius from periphery to center of the sample under the influence of a magnetic field, created by a horseshoe-shaped magnet, and ferromagnetic liquid as the inert medium. The reactor (12) with the gradient former (11) is placed between the poles of the horseshoe-shaped magnet (5) in the plane transverse to spreading of magnetic force lines. The reactor is first filled by a ferromagnetic liquid (Table 4, variant N5), and then the gradient former is injected, which gradually presses out the ferromagnetic liquid. The ferromagnetic liquid that remains in the reactor occupies the space where magnetic force lines are most closely packed, i.e. between the poles of the magnet, and, consequently, possesses the form of a cylinder, and the gradient former occupying the rest of the space possesses the form of a hollow cylinder. As the gradient former is injected, the thickness of the hollow cylinder increases from 0 to R, i.e. the gradient formation zone increases, and the radius of the cylinder of ferromagnetic liquid decreases from R to 0. In this variant, preliminary calculations are the same as at application of equation (24). Let us consider one more variant of performance of the gradient formation with decrease of its duration by the sample radius from its periphery to center. In some cases, introduction of the ferromagnetic liquid and the gradient former into the reactor according to the sequence mentioned may cause pollution of the gradient former surface by the ferromagnetic liquid that will lead to distortion of the given duration of the gradient former contact by radius of the gradient carrier and, consequently, to distortion of the given radial distribution of the refractive index. This also concerns the above-described case of obtaining selfocs (gradient elements) (Table 4, variant N2), when the reactor with fixed gel-polymeric matrix, placed in the centrifugal field, is filled by an inert liquid, and then the monomer-diffusate possessing higher density is injected. In both cases, the possible complications mentioned may be easily eliminated (Table 4, variants N3 and N4), if the reactor is first completely filled by the gradient former (chemically active liquid/monomer-diffusate), and then an inert (ferromagnetic) liquid with lower density is introduced, which gradually presses out the gradient former. The inert liquid is first of a cylinder shape (x = R), then it attains the shape of hollow cylinder (x < R) and, finally, is pressed out completely (x = 0). Consequently, the inlet inert ferromagnetic liquid will occupy the space in the center of the reactor and will possess the cylindrical shape with radius y = (R – x), which will be gradually increased up to R. The volume of the gradient former is given by V(x) = πR2h – π(R – x)2h = πh(2Rx – x2).
(25)
42
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov The volume of the inert/ferromagnetic liquid is
V(y) = πR2h – πh(2Rx – x2) = π(R – x)2h.
(26)
To record dependence of the volume of inert/ferromagnetic liquid injected into the reactor on the transformation duration τ at the given τ(x), determined by the function τ = f(R), the reverse function x(τ) is derived and substituted into equation (26): V(τ) = πh[R – x(τ)]2.
(27)
Equation (27) expresses the dynamics of inert/ferromagnetic liquid introduction into the reactor (which is preliminarily filled by the gradient former; the gradient former is fixed in the centrifugal field or the reactor is placed between poles of the horseshoeshaped magnet) providing formation of the transformation product with the given radial distribution of the refractive index under conditions of the gradient formation front spreading as its duration decreases by radius from periphery to center of the sample. b) Gradient formation at the increase of process duration by the sample radius from periphery to center [61, 128, 130] Here several variants should be also considered. Let us begin with the variant N6 (Table 4). The reactor (4) (Figure 14) is first completely and rapidly filled by the gradient former, and then dosed introduction of the inert liquid, the density of which is higher than that of the gradient former, is started. Under the influence of the centrifugal field, the inert liquid is reflected to the reactor wall and attains a hollow cylinder shape with the wall thickness of y. As the inert liquid is injected, y increases from 0 to R. The gradient former present in the central part of the reactor assumes the form of a cylinder with radius x = R – y (analogous to the variants considered above and, in this case, x is equal to the part of radius R in contact with the gradient former), gradually decreasing from R to 0. Dependence of the inert liquid volume on the radius x of the cylinder gradient former is expressed by the following equation: V(y) = πh(R2 – x2).
(28)
To record dependence of the inert liquid volume, injected into the reactor, on the transformation duration τ at given τ(x), determined by the function τ = f(R), the reverse function x(τ) is derived and substituted into equation (28): V(τ) = πh[R2 – x2(τ)].
(29)
The equation expresses the dynamics of the inert liquid introduction into the reactor, which provides the regime of transformation product formation under conditions of spreading of the gradient formation front with increase of its duration from periphery to center of the sample. The algorithm suggested is also applicable to the variant N8 (Table 3), when the magnetic field created by the circular electromagnet is used instead of the centrifugal one (Figure 15), and a magnetic liquid is used as the inert medium. The reactor (12) is placed in the circular electromagnet (15) in the plane transverse to the plane of spreading of magnetic force lines. First, the reactor is rapidly filled with the gradient former and dosed delivery of a ferromagnetic liquid is begun immediately, which occupies the volume in
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
43
the reactor, where magnetic force lines are most closely packed, i.e. near the internal wall of the circular magnet and, consequently, forms a cylinder-shaped ring, inside which the gradient former having the form of a cylindrical body is located. As ferromagnetic liquid is poured in, the thickness of the hollow cylinder wall increases from 0 to R, and the radius of the cylinder from the gradient former, which is gradually pressed off from the reactor, decreases, respectively. As the process ends, the electromagnet is switched off and the valve (8) is opened. Hence, the zone of gradient formation in this variant decreases gradually, while the process duration along the sample radius from periphery to the center increases. That is why preliminary calculations necessary for creation of the given radial distribution of the refractive index are the same as at application of equation (30). Let us discuss two possible variants of increase of the gradient formation duration along the sample radius from its periphery to the center that can be performed both in centrifugal (the sample rotates or is fixed) and in magnetic (circular electromagnet) fields (Table 4, variants N1 and N9). Initially, the reactor is filled with an inert/ferromagnetic liquid, and then gradient former is injected possessing lower density, which occupies the space in the reactor center and assumes a cylindrical shape. As the gradient former is injected, the cylinder radius increases from 0 to R and gradually presses off the inert/ferromagnetic liquid. The volume of the gradient former is V(x) = πx2h.
(30)
To write down the dependence of the gradient former volume injected into the reactor on duration of transformation, τ, at given τ(x) determined by function τ = f(R), the reverse function x(τ) is derived and substituted into equation (30): V(τ) = πx2(τ)h.
(31)
Equation (31) indicates the dynamics of the gradient former delivery to the reactor, which provides the regime of transformation product formation with the given radial distribution of the refractive index under conditions of the gradient formation spreading with growth of its duration by sample radius from the periphery to the center.
4.4. Particular Examples of Realization of Controlled Heterogeneous Gradient Formation The method of controlled gradient formation is illustrated below using the example of 20
the following initial polymers: poly(vinyl acetate) (PVA, nD = 1.4655, film thickness is 20
0.015 mm), poly(vinyl alcohol) (PVAl, nD
= 1.530, film thickness is 0.015 mm),
20
isotactic polypropylene (PP, nD = 1.495, film thickness is 0.015 mm), gel-polymeric matrix based on diallylisophthalate (DAIP,
nD20 = 1.5254), diethylene-glycol-
20
bisallylcarbonate (DEGBAC, nD = 1.4570). Refractive indices of initial polymers were measured according to ref. [136]. Variation of the refractive index was measured on the Mach-Zender interferometer with
44
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
He-Ne laser (LG-201, Russian trademark) as the light source with the active wavelength λ = 0.6328 µm. The value of ∆n was calculated by formula (5). Chlorine content was determined gravimetrically (by weighing films before and after reaction), and by chemical analysis as well [137]. a) Creation of gradient systems by polymer-analogous PVA → PVAl transformation [61, 127, 128, 133] This transformation can be performed by alcoholysis of PVA films by sodium hydroxide solution in ethanol with [NaOH] = 10 wt% at 60°C. Hence, in the present process, PVA is the gradient carrier, and sodium hydroxide solution is the gradient former:
(
CH2
)n + nNaOH O COCH3 CH
C2H5OH
(
O CH2
CH OH
)n + nCH3
C ONa
Experiments are performed in order to study function n = f(τ) – determination of influence of PVA → PVAl transformation duration on variation of the refractive index of the gradient-carrier. These data are shown in Figure 17 indicating that maximal growth of the refractive index in the gradient-carrier, reached after 4 hours, is ∆ = 0.025.
n 1.4950
1.4850 1.4750 1.4650 1
2
3
4 τ, h
Figure 17. Dependence of the refractive index of the gradient-carrier (n) on duration (τ) of polymeranalogous PVA → PVAl transformation
The function n = f(R), the radial distribution profile of the refractive index, is given. Figure 18a expresses the given profile of radial distribution of the refractive index in the PVA → PVAl transformation product of 40 mm in radius. Hence, a system possessing properties of a defocusing lens (the refractive index decreases from periphery to center) must be obtained. Based on Figures 17 and 18 (curve “a”) the function τ = f(R) is graphally depicted, representing the dependence of PVA → PVAl polymer-analogous transformation duration (τ) on radius (R) of the gradient former. This graph is shown in Figure 19 (curve “a”), according to which the transformation duration must decrease from gradient-carrier periphery to the center. Consequently, five variants of technical solution are applicable to realization of the transformation regime required (Table 4, variants N1, 2, 3, 4, 5) using equations (23) or (26). In variants N4, 5, 8, 9, a colloid solution of
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
45
Fe(OH)3 in isooctane (2,2,3-trimethylpentane) is used as the ferromagnetic liquid. Illustrated below is the example using variant N1.
n 1.4950
a
1.4850 b
1.4750
1.4650 10
20
30
40 R, mm
Figure 18. Given dependence of the refractive index (n) on radius (R) of the gradient-carrier at PVA → PVAl transformation: “a” and “b” are products with properties of biconcave and biconvex lenses, respectively.
τ, h 4
b
a
3 2 1 10
20
30 40 R, mm
Figure 19. Dependence of duration (τ) of polymer-analogous PVA → PVAl transformation on radius (R) of the gradient-carrier: “a” and “b” are regimes of obtaining products with properties of defocusing and focusing lenses, respectively
Table 5. V (0.5 hour) = 3.14⋅120 mm⋅1 mm (2⋅40 mm – 1 mm) = 29767.22 mm3; V (1 hour) = 3.14⋅120⋅3 (2⋅40 – 3) = 87040.8 mm3; V (1.5 hours) = 3.14⋅120⋅10 (2⋅40 – 10) = 263760 mm3; V (2 hours) = 3.14⋅120⋅17.5 (2⋅40 – 17.5) = 412125 mm3; V (2.5 hours) = 3.14⋅120⋅25 (2⋅40 – 25) = 518100 mm3; V (3 hours) = 3.14⋅120⋅30 (2⋅40 – 30) = 565200 mm3; V (3.5 hours) = 3.14⋅120⋅35 (2⋅40 – 35) = 593460 mm3; V (4 hours) = 3.14⋅120⋅40 (2⋅40 – 40) = 602880 mm3.
For reactor (4) (Figure 14), the following sizes are selected: height h = 120 mm, internal radius R = 40 mm. Further on, based on Figure 19 and equation (23), the volumes of sodium hydroxide solution, which will be delivered to reactor (4) rotating around the axis at time moments, are given in Table 5.
46
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
The required volumes of sodium hydroxide (Table 5) are delivered with the help of a batcher attached to pipe (12) (Figure 14). Figure 20 shows the scheme of one of the types of liquid batcher with a cam. For completeness in presentation, all calculations associated with usage of such a batcher are given below.
A 1 1
2
2
3
3
A Figure 20. Batcher with a cam for controlled delivery of gradient former/inert (ferromagnetic) liquid. See text for details.
A cylinder vessel (3) (Figure 20) is used, with internal diameter of 40 mm and height of 120 mm. Plunger (2) transposition in vessel (3) up to time τ is calculated by the equation:
H (τ ) =
V (τ ) . 3.14 ⋅ 40 2
(32)
Substituting values of V(τ) from Table 5 into equation (32), we get: Table 6. H(0.5 hour) = 5.96 mm; H(1 hour) = 17.325 mm; H(1.5 hours) = 52.5 mm; H(2 hours) = 82 mm; H(2.5 hours) = 103.1 mm; H(3 hours) = 112.5 mm; H(3.5 hours) = 118.1 mm; H(4 hours) = 120 mm.
The cam (1) profile is calculated in the usual way [138]: a circle of an arbitrary diameter is selected, a half of the circle is divided into eight parts, and radii are depicted. The following distances are laid on the radius extensions:
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
47
on the extension of the Ist radius – 20 mm; on the extension of the IInd radius – (20 + 6) mm; on the extension of the IIIrd radius – (20 + 17) mm; on the extension of the IVth radius – (20 + 52.5) mm; on the extension of the Vth radius – (20 + 82) mm; on the extension of the VIth radius – (20 + 103) mm; on the extension of the VIIth radius – (20 + 112.5) mm; on the extension of the VIIth radius – (20 + 112.5) mm; on the extension of the IXth radius – (20 + 120) mm. Connecting the ends of rays, we obtain the cam (1) profile (Figure 20). The cam is made from a hard metal. Further on, gradient-carrier (18) (Figure 14), i.e. the PVA film, is dipped into reactor (4). Vessel (3) (Figure 20) is filled with the sodium hydroxide solution. The plunger (2) contacts the cam (1) at the point on the extension of the radius I. The batcher (Figure 20) is attached to the pipe (12) (Figure 14). As the demanded temperature is reached (60°C), the electric engine (9) is switched on (Figure 14), the valve (4) is opened, and the electric engine (6) (Figure 20) is switched on. The cam (1), rotating by the arrow (see the Figure), presses on the plunger (2) pressing off the gradient former delivered by pipes (6, 12, 15) to the periphery of the reactor (4). After full rotation of cam (1), electric engines (9) (Figure 14) and (6) (Figure 20) are switched off, plug (13) is removed, and the product of polymer-analogous PVA → PVAl transformation is removed, washed and dried. The same polymer-analogous PVA → PVAl transformation under the conditions when duration of the chemical reaction by the gradient-carrier radius increases from periphery to the center gives the possibility of creating a medium with properties of a focusing lens (the refractive index increases from periphery to the center). Curve “b” in Figure 18 expresses the given profile of refractive index distribution in the product of gradient polymer-analogous PVA → PVAl transformation 40 mm in radius and with properties of the focusing lens. Based on Figures 17 and 18 (curve “b”), a graph of function τ = f(R) – the dependence of PVA → PVAl transformation duration (τ) on radius (R) of the gradient-carrier – is plotted. This graph is shown in Figure 19 (curve “b”). For practical realization of the demanded regime of gradient transformation, four variants of technical solution are basically applicable (Table 4, variants N6, 7, 8, 9) using appropriate equations shown in Table 6. Calculations of gradient-carrier volumes delivered up to the moment τ and cam (1) profile (Figure 20) are performed in accordance with the directions above. Mercury can be used as the inert liquid fitting the condition ρ(gradient-carrier) < ρ(inert liquid). b) Creation of gradient systems by polymer-analogous PVA → Poly(vinylbutyrate) transformation [61] In the above-considered examples, the refractive index of the gradient-carrier was lower than that of the product of polymer-analogous transformation. It is clear that with the reverse relation of refractive indices, as for example, with PVA (n = 1.53) → Poly(binylbutyrale) (n = 1.485) transformation:
48
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
reaction products possessing properties of defocusing and focusing lenses are formed under conditions of the opposite (comparing with the above-considered PVA → PVAl transformation) spreading of the chemical reaction front (see Table 5). The gradient former (n-butyric aldehyde) is used as a water solution [n-C4H8O] = 5 wt%. The reaction proceeds at 40°C in the presence of ~0.5% of concentrated sulfuric acid as the catalyst. During the 5 hours of the reaction process, the lowest reduction of the refractive index in the gradient former is ∆n = 0.02, which indicated incomplete acetylation of the initial PVA. This agrees with the literature data [139]. Moreover, it should be taken into account that the heterogeneous nature of the process almost excludes spreading of the polymeranalogous transformation deep into the sample, which affects the transformation of the refractive index. This judgement is true for all heterogneous polymer-analogous transformations described in the present monograph. That is why determination of the type of profile of radial distribution to be set must be based on practically realized limiting values of refractive indices. N-Hexane (ρ20 = 0.6594) and mercury, respectively, can be used as inert liquids possessing lower and higher density comparing with the gradient former. Here ferromagnetic liquid is the same (Fe(OH)3 solution in isooctane). c) Creation of gradient systems by diffusion polymerization [61, 127, 133] Gel-polymeric matrices (~2 mm thick) from diallylisophthalate (DAIP) can be used as gradient formers:
CH2
CH CH2
O C O
20
C O CH2
CH CH2
O 20
(For DAIP, nD = 1.5254; for poly(DAIP), nD = 1.569; conversion is ~35%), or diethyleneglycolbisallylcarbonate (DEGBAC):
CH2
CH CH2
O C O
(OCH2
CH2)2
C O CH2 O
CH CH2
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties 20
49
20
(For DEGBAC, nD = 1.4503; for poly(DEGBAC), nD = 1.50; conversion is 20
~40%). The monomer-diffusate can be methyl methacrylate (for MMA, ρ20 = 0.943, nD 20
= 1.4146; for PMMA, nD = 1.492), or fluoroalkyl methacrylates, for example: 1,1,3-trihydrotetrafluoropropyl methacrylate (F4MA)
CH2
C C OCH2 H3C
20
(CF2)2 H
O 20
(For F4MA, ρ20 = 1.239, nD = 1.375; for poly(F4MA), nD = 1.420). These gradient formers reduce refractive index in the gradient-carrier. Poly(methylsiloxane) (PMS-100, ρ20 = 0.97) is the inert liquid for both gel-polymers and F4MA, and Fe(OH)3 solution in isooctane is the ferromagnetic liquid. d) Study of solid-phase chlorination of isotactic polypropylene(PP) and creation of poly(chloropropylene) GRIN-elements [134] It seems desirable to consider this approach of creation of gradient elements in more detail, because the chemical processes on which it is based are rather ordinary and quite well studied, especially for homogeneous polymer-analogous transformations, and this is not usually the case in producing materials for gradient optics. The principles of solid chlorination of PP-films that should be used for creation of thin-layer selfocs with the given profile of refractive index distribution are discussed below. PP films were chlorinated by UV-radiation at 90°C. Figure 21 shows curves of the dependence of the wt% of chlorine that participates in the reaction on the process duration: [Cl] = f(τ). Theoretically, the proportion of chlorine in completely monochlorinated PP is 46.4 wt% Cl, and in completely dichlorinated product is [Cl] = 64 wt%. If chlorinated in solution or suspension, up to 70 wt% Cl can be introduced into PP [140], which corresponds to the presence N (Cl) = 2.6 in every structural unit. The type of change of molar parts of structural units of various chemical structure is clearly observed from comparison of ω(Cl) ordinates and A, B, and C in Figure 21 with increase in the molar proportion of chlorine. Hence, if ω(Cl)<46.4%, two types of structural units exist, both non-chlorinated and monochlorinated; but if 46.4% < ω(Cl) < 64%, then both mono- and dichlorinated products are formed. In the present case (Figure 60), ω(Cl) = 54.6% can be introduced into PP film during 4 hours of continuous chlorination, which corresponds to N (Cl) = 1.376 per structural unit, supposing that chlorination proceeds uniformly in the whole volume of PP film. Despite small film thickness, this is not completely true (as well as all above-described heterogeneous transformations); however, it is warranted by the fact that the refractive index change is measured interferometrically along the whole optical thickness of the film. Real saturation at ω(Cl) = 54.6% (instead of ω(Cl) = 70% according to [140]) is explained by the weakly developed surface of film PP samples. An attempt was made to compare the character of experimentally found change in the refractive index during PP chlorination with theoretical calculations based on simultaneous existence of the two types of structural chains mentioned above. For this purpose, the Lorentz–Lorenz theoretically derived formula and Gladstone–Dale and Fogel
50
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
empirical formulae were chosen [141]. To calculate the refractive index, the molar refraction was taken with regard to atomic contributions, chemical bonds and special increments suggested by Godhard for each of the above-mentioned formulae separately [141]. ω(Cl),% 60 50
N (Cl) 2.00 1.75 1.50 1.25 1.00
40
0.75
30
0.50
20
0.25
10
0
2
1
3
t, h
4
Figure 21. Dependence of chlorine mass part ω(Cl) substituted in PP film and the average number of chlorine atoms N (Cl) in the structural unit of PP on chlorination duration (τ) at 90°C. Additional ordinates express changes of molar parts of structural units possessing different chemical structure: A – non-chlorinated; B – monochlorinated; and C – dichlorinated.
nD 1.520
1
1.510
2
1.500 1.490 1.480 1.470 0
10
20
30 40 50 ω(Cl), %
60
Figure 22. Dependence of the refractive index (n) on the wt% chlorine ω(Cl) in PP film: 1 – experiment; 2 – calculation performed according to a modified Fogel formula
It is found that a significant difference between the experiment and theoretical calculations occurs. Refractive indices for the initial (non-chlorinated) PP film calculated by Lorentz–Lorenz and Gladstone–Dale equations equal n = 1.5200 and n = 1.5126, respectively. In accord with the experiment (Figure 22, curve 1), this corresponds to ω(Cl) = 54.6% and ω(Cl) = 43%, respectively. According to Fogel also, an underestimated refractive index is obtained for the initial film, with approximately the
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
51
same deviation in values from experiment. The Fogel formula (R = nMr, where R is the molar refraction, n is the refractive index, Mr is the relative molecular mass of a substance or a structural unit of polymer) cannot be basically applied to crystalline polymers, which are initial and weakly chlorinated PP films, because it neglects the polymer density. However, the validity of application of the Fogel formula rises with the degree of chlorination, when the degree of crystallinity (polymer amorphization) is abruptly reduced. Table 7. Polymer type Structural formula
Initial PP (no-chlorinated)
(
CH2
CH
)n
Monochlorinated PP
(
CH2
CH3 Refractive index
1.4710
CCl
Dichlorinated PP
)n
( CHCl CCl )n CH3
CH3 1.5087
1.5224
Table 7 shows values of the refractive index for three types of polymers calculated by the Fogel formula using the data obtained by Godhard. To calculate changes of the refractive index during chlorination, contribution of two types of structural units to the average refractive index value, nav, should be taken into account. In this case, the Fogel formula is reduced to the following form:
nav = x
R1 R2 + (1 − x) = xn1 + (1 − x)n2 , M r (2) M r (1)
(33)
where R1 and R2 are molar refractions for two types of structural units – non-chlorinated and monochlorinated or monochlorinated and dichlorinated ones; Mr(1) and Mr(2) are relative molecular masses of two types of structural units – non-chlorinated and monochlorinated or monochlorinated and dichlorinated ones; x is the molar part of the structural unit of type 1; n1 and n2 are refractive indices corresponding to the two types of structural units (see Table 7). Curve 2 in Figure 22 expresses dependence of refractive index on the mass part of chlorine, ntheor = f[ω(Cl)], calculated by the reduced Fogel formula. The calculation was made under the supposition that, in completely monochlorinated PP, hydrogen atoms are substituted by chlorine at tertiary carbon atoms only, and the second hydrogen atom is substituted by chlorine at secondary carbon atoms. Theoretical curve 2 gradually approaches the experimental one. At ω(Cl) = 46.4%, a break in the curve is observed corresponding to the onset of the second hydrogen atom substitution by chlorine. Obviously, the absence of such a feature on experimental curve 1 is brought about by the fact that substitution of hydrogen atoms during chlorination proceeds simultaneously at tertiary and secondary carbon atoms. Such a conclusion is consistent with ref. [240], in which is noted that on early stages of PP chlorination, chlorine atoms distribute along the macromolecular chain statistically, mostly substituting hydrogen atoms at tertiary carbon atoms. At further chlorination, hydrogen atoms at secondary carbon atoms are substituted. Based on the data obtained, polymeric media with given size and profile of refractive index distribution can be formed. For this purpose, a graph n = f(τ) is composed from experimentally found dependencies ω(Cl) = f(τ) and n = f[ω(Cl)] (Figures 60 and 61). According to the algorithm suggested, the given dependence n = f(R) is transformed to the form of τ = f(R) with the help of this graph.
52
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
To manipulate with gaseous gradient former, it is more suitable to use a device, the scheme of which is shown in Figure 23, although centrifugal and magnetic fields are basically suitable for this purpose.
6 1
Cl2 2 3 4
5 Cl2
Figure 23. The set-up for controlled axial gradient chlorination of film materials (principal scheme). See text for details.
As amply illustrated above, the algorithm of controlled gradient formation suggested allows formation of a medium with properties of a focusing or defocusing lens on the basis of the same process: this is achieved by changing the character of the process duration from periphery to the center by the gradient-carrier radius. Let us consider a case analogous to variants N3 and 4 (Table 4) utilizing this effect. PP-film is fixed in a circular clamp (4) (Figure 16). A distance of 3 mm is set between the film and plates (2) and (5). Adjusting clamp (6) provides for horizontal position of plates (2, 5) and sample (3). The gradient former (gaseous chlorine) is delivered by pipe (9) and, penetrating into the space between plates (2) and (5), interacts with the gradient-carrier – the PP film. Chlorine excess is eliminated via pipe (18). Dosed delivery of an inert liquid (water solution of NaCl, ω(NaCl) = 22.5%, [144]) is commenced from vessel (10) according to equation (26). Due to surface tension, the inert liquid forms a circle. Circular ‘plates’ of the inert liquid above and beneath sample (3) spread from the film center to periphery, increasing their diameters and gradually limiting the square of gradient former contact with the gradient-carrier. As chlorine is the gradient former increasing the refractive index, a medium with properties of a defocusing lens is obtained in this case. Chlorine solution, for example, in CCl4, can also be used as the gradient former. Clearly, in this case, correction of n = f(τ) dependence is required. If the gradient former (gaseous chlorine or its solution in CCl4) is applied to the center of the PP film (via pipes (8) and (15)), and then glass (7) filled with an inert liquid first (water solution of NaCl), then pipe (18) is closed and dosed delivery of it begins according to equation (28), the effect produced corresponds to variants N6 and 8 (Table 4), i.e. a medium with focusing lens properties is formed.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
53
An axial selfoc based on poly(chloropropylene) can be prepared using the information contained in Figures 21 and 22. Axial gradient chlorination is performed in a titanium camera with two windows from melted quartz for UV-radiation. The device scheme is shown in Figure 23. A sealed film advance mechanism (1) equipped with a block (6) (reducer-motor with a cam mechanism) provides for PP film (2) delivery to the chlorination chamber (3) for the reaction governed by the relation τ = f(r). Emitters (4, 5) located inside the chamber (3) allow the process to proceed at increased temperature. Figure 24 shows an example of the axial profile of refractive index distribution in axial poly(chloropropylene) selfoc. nD
τ, h 4 3
1.520
2
1.510
1 1.500 0 1.490 0
1
2
3
4
5 R, cm
Figure 24. Dependence of the refractive index (n) on r (distance from the film edge present in the chlorination chamber): - parabolic curve given; x – experimental points; additional ordinate is chlorination duration (τ).
In this Figure, the continuous curve represents a parabola branch normalized for the given “n” and “r”. Crosses mark experimental points obtained by adding the measured value of refractive index change ∆n to the initial value n = 1.495 for the part of the PP film present. On the graph, the first ordinate shows the duration of exposure of that part of the PP film in the chlorination chamber. If a folded PP film is placed in the chamber, a profile of refractive index in the form of a parabola with both branches can be obtained. e) Control of gradient formation on the surface of spherical lenses It is common knowledge that image defects are inherent to a single spherical lens – geometric and chromatic aberrations, which are eliminated by combining several spherical lenses with given curvature, refractive index and dispersion of refractive index, which makes modern optical devices highly complex in structure. Most geometric aberrations can be eliminated by a single lens, if its surface is not spherically shaped, but is an asymmetric rotation surface. However, preparation of such surfaces is a rather complicated technical problem that makes difficulties for wide diameter aspherical lenses. Discussed above are some ways of eliminating optical distortions by forming a homogeneous composition gradient and, consequently, a refractive index gradient in the subsurface layer of a spherical lens, for example, by exchange diffusion into gelpolymeric matrix and further copolymerization [11, 33]. With inorganic glasses, this
54
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
process is represented by the technology of preparing an aspherical and, at the same time, inhomogeneous refracting surface [142]. The present Section discusses modified variants of the approach suggested by us to formation of the given radial composition gradient, based on consideration of curvature of lens sample surfaces processed, which can be used for the controlled spreading of the radial front of gradient formation on a spherical surface. This is of special interest in relation to the problem of eliminating geometric aberrations. Therewith, as may be seen below, the optical feature of the method considered is the possibility of controlling the inhomogeneity of the gradient layer in spherical lenses. Formation of the given radial gradient of the process proceeding on the surface of the lens sample is discussed using the example of diaphragming the gradient formation zone in a centrifugal field. Figure 25 shows the main features of such a device. It consists of cylinder reactor (1) rotating around its axis (5) in the vertical plane. A convex (A) or a concave (B) lens sample (7) is fixed in the rotation plane. Reactor (1) is equipped by fixed pipes (4) and (6) intended for input and output of active and inert liquids. Recall that duration of the process along the radius from the sample periphery to its center can be increased or decreased by varying relative planes of active and inert liquids. Thus, the first liquid (active – inert) is always delivered to the periphery of reactor (1) via pipe (6). That is why an air eliminating pipe is always located in the center of reactor (1) (pipe (4)). The second liquid (active – inert), when its density is higher than that of the first liquid, is injected at the periphery (pipe 6), and the first liquid is pressed off through the center (pipe 4); vice versa, when the second liquid is lighter than the first one, it is injected through the center (pipe 4), and the first one is injected from the periphery of the reactor (1) (pipe (6)). Let us discuss the case of shortening the process duration on the lens sample surface by radius from periphery to its center. Such distribution of the process duration can be obtained by two methods: by gradual increase of active liquid volume on the periphery of rotating reactor (1) or by pressing off the active liquid (initially gradually filling reactor (1)) from the periphery of reactor (1) through pipe (6) as the result of delivery of the inert liquid with lower density to the center of reactor (1) (pipe (4)). The active liquid delivered to the rotating reactor (1) is removed to the internal wall of the reactor (zone 1, Figure 25) by the centrifugal field and attains the shape of a cylindrical pipe. The base of the cylinder pipe bordering the internal convex-concave surface of the lens sample (7) represents a ball layer of height “K”. Wall thickness of the cylinder pipe is x = a. As active liquid is delivered, x increases from 0 to R, and K grows from 0 to H. To determine the dependence of the active liquid volume on x, K must be found. It can be shown that, when x = a:
K = ( H − r ) ± r 2 − [R − x(τ )]2 ,
(34)
where τ is the process duration. Clearly, only positive values of the root have physical meaning. With regard to equation (34), the regularity of active liquid delivery providing for the given (experimentally determined) regime of the radical distribution of process duration decrease on the surface of the convex–concave lens sample from the periphery to the center is expressed by the following equation: Vact(τ) = 1/6π{6hx(τ)[2R – x(τ)] ± K(τ)[6hx(τ) – 3x2(τ) + K2(τ)]},
(35)
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
55
where Vact(τ) is the volume of active liquid at the moment of time τ; x(τ) is the reverse function of selected, experimentally found dependence τ(x); K(τ) is the height of the ball layer – the base of the cylinder pipe of the active liquid at the moment of time τ. Thus, for convex lenses, the second term in the equation is negative, while for concave lenses it is positive. The second method for decreasing the process duration from the periphery to the center is used in the cases when a labile (gel-polymeric) sample is fixed immovably in the rotating reactor. Primarily, reactor (1) is filled completely with the active liquid, and then the inert liquid of lower density is injected through the pipe (4). In the zone II (Figure 25), the inert liquid attains a cylindrical form, the base of which, adjacent to the convex– concave lens sample (7), represents a ball segment. The cylinder “b” radius increases from 0 to R. Consequently, the active liquid initially possessing the cylindrical shape with the ball segment base transforming to the shape of a cylindrical pipe K after injection of the inert liquid. Wall thickness of the cylinder pipe x = a decreases from R to 0, and “K” decreases from H to 0. With regard to equation (35), regularities of the inert liquid delivery, that provide for the regime of the given (experimentally found) radial distribution of the process duration decrease from the periphery to the center on the surface of convex-concave lens sample, are expressed by the equation: Vinert(τ) = 1/6π{3[R – x(τ)]2[2h ± K(τ) ± H] ± [H –K(τ)]3},
(36a)
where Vinert(τ) is the volume of the inert liquid at the moment of time τ. Here, signs plus and minus correspond to convex and concave lens samples, respectively. Let us consider the case of increasing the process duration on the surface of lens samples from the periphery to the center. In this case, growth of the process duration can also be performed by two methods: initially, the reactor is filled completely with the active liquid, which is then pressed off from the reactor center (pipe (4)) as the result of delivery of the inert liquid with higher density at the reactor periphery (pipe (6)). The active liquid (zone II, Figure 25) is of cylinder shape with the base of the ball segment with height H. The cylinder radius of the active liquid x = b decreases from R to 0, and height of the ball layer K’ in the zone I (the base of the cylinder tube of the inert liquid) grows (in the zone I) from 0 to H. It can be shown that when x = b,
K ′ = ( H − r ) ± r 2 − x 2 (τ ) . In this case also, only positive values of the root are physically sensible. Regularity of the inert liquid delivery, which provides for the given (experimentally found) radial distribution of the process duration increase on the surface of the convex–concave lens sample from its periphery to the center, is expressed by the following equation: Vinert(τ) = 1/6π{[6h ± 3K’(τ)] [R2 – x2(τ)]2 ± K’(τ)3},
(36b)
where K’ is the height of the ball layer – the base of the cylinder pipe of the inert liquid at the moment of time τ. According to the second approach, growth of the process duration from the periphery to the center is reached by delivery of the active liquid possessing lower density to the reactor center (pipe (4)) previously filled with the inert liquid.
56
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
In this case, the radius of the active liquid x = b in the zone II (Figure 25) grows from 0 to R, and height of the ball layer K’ in the zone of the cylinder pipe base decreases from H to 0. The inert liquid is pressed off from the reactor periphery through pipe (6). Delivery of the active liquid with the regularity, which would provide for the given (experimentally found) radial distribution of the process duration increase on the surface of the convex–concave lens sample, is expressed by the following equation: Vact(τ) = 1/6π{3x2(τ)[2h ± 3K’(τ) ± H] ± [H –K’(τ)]3}.
(36c)
Here, again, minus and plus signs correspond to convex and concave lenses, respectively.
Figure 25. Main features of the device for formation of radial gradient of process duration in the centrifugal field (chemical reaction/exchange diffusion) on the lens surface (diametrical cross-section): 1 – cylinder reactor; 2 – lid; 3 – gasket; 4 – immovable pipe/air eliminator for injection/elimination of active/inert liquids; 5 – reactor rotation axis; 6 – immovable pipe for injection/elimination of active/inert liquids; 7 – lens sample (A – convex, B – concave); a – cylinder pipe thickness of active liquid; b – radius of the active liquid cylinder; h – height of the internal space of the reactor (1) – cylinder on periphery; K – height of the spherical base layer of the cylinder pipe (x = a) of the active liquid; K’ – height of the spherical layer – base of the cylinder pipe (x = a) of the inert liquid; H – height of the spherical segment; R – radius of the lens sample; r – radius of the sphere, to which the lens sample surface corresponds.
Table 8 sums up all the above-considered variants of creation of the given radial distribution of gradient formation duration change (in the polymer-matrix) on the surface of lens samples, providing for the given radial distribution of the refractive index in subsurface layers; conditions for their realization and tendencies of refractive index change are shown. Algorithms of formation of the given radial distribution of the refractive index in the surface layer of the lens are as follows: experiments are performed (polymer-analogous transformation – exchange diffusion in gel-polymeric matrix with further copolymerization) in samples with various plane-parallel surfaces for determining the dependence t,a(τ); then, a three-dimensional graph of dependence n = ϕ(τ, m), where m is the sample thickness, is constructed. With the help of this graph, the given dependence n = ϕ(R) is transformed into the form τ = F(R). Technical aspects of realizing the given distribution of gradient formation duration by radius were described in [128 – 130, 134].
Table 8. Creation of the given radial distribution of gradient formation duration (polymer-analogous transformation/exchange diffusion) on the surface of lens samples in the centrifugal field Sequence of active/inert liquids delivery Controlled delivery Change of the process duration on the sample surface from periphery to center Decreases
K = (H − r) +
Relative density of active and inert liquid, ρ ρ(act) > ρ(inert)
+ r 2 − [ R − x(τ )]2
K = (H − r) + Increases
+ r 2 − x 2 (τ )
ρ(act) < ρ(inert)
Preliminary filling of the reactor
On periphery Act.
In center
Act.
Inert
Inert
Act.
Act.
Inert
Change of the refractive index in modified polymer layer from periphery to center of the sample Increases n(init.) > n(product)
Decreases n(init.) < n(product)
n(init.) < n(product)
n(init.) > n(product)
Regime of active/inert liquids delivery (sign “minus” corresponds to convex lens samples, sign “plus” – to concave ones) Vact(τ) = 1/6π{6hx(τ)[2R – x(τ)] ± K(τ)[6hx(τ) – 3x2(τ) + K2(τ)]} Vinert(τ) = 1/6π{3[R – x(τ)]2[2h ± K(τ) ± H] ± [H –K(τ)]3} Vinert(τ) = 1/6π{[6h ± 3K’(τ)] [R2 – x2(τ)] ± K’3(τ)} Vact(τ) = 1/6π{3x2(τ)[2h ± K’(τ) ± H] ± [H – K’(τ)]3}
58
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
4.5. Method of Obtaining Cylindrical (Disk-Like) Polymeric Objects with a Given Radial Gradient of the Refractive Index [124] The methods of creating gradient systems considered in the previous Section are based on the solid-phase chemical modification of a polymer or gel-polymer, which, on the one hand, gives the possibility of obtaining macrosurface GRIN-elements, but on the other hand, limits their thickness, especially at polymer-analogous gradient formation. The present Section describes devices and methods for obtaining cylindrical polymeric objects with given radial composition gradient providing a given profile of refractive index distribution. The principal features of the device are shown in Figure 26. The device contains two vessels (1) and (2), intended for liquid substances with different values of the refractive index. Rotating in a definite direction, cams (3) and (4) move plungers (5) and (6). Liquids flowing from vessels (1) and (2) are mixed by warm mixer (7). The mixture is delivered to vessel (8) rotating around its axis. The volumetric proportion of every component in the mixture is regulated and determined by the profile of cams (3) and (4). The profile of cam (3) provides for a gradual increase of the rate of plunger (5) transposition, while the profile of cam (4) provides a gradual decrease of plunger (6) transposition rate. In this way, the mixture of components, in which relative volumetric content of one of them is reduced continuously, and that of the second one is increased, is delivered to the mixer (7) and then to the vessel (8). B
A A
B
43
3
4
6 2
6 2
5
5
1
1 B
A 7 8
Figure 26. Principal components of the device for obtaining objects with radial composition (refractive index) gradient. See text for details.
As a drop of the mixture enters rotating vessel (8), it spreads as a thin layer over its vertical wall under the effect of centrifugal forces. Additional portions form further layers, and so on. The filled vessel is placed into a thermostat for polymerization. In the material obtained, due to azeotropic copolymerization, the radial gradient of structural units is preserved and, consequently, the appropriate refractive index gradient.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
59
This approach is analogous in many points to that given in ref. [143]. However, as description of the calculations necessary to form the given refractive index gradient is absent in ref. [143], an adequate algorithm is discussed below. Shrinkage of the material due to polymerization can be neglected in the first approximation, and volumes of the vessel (8) and the resulting cylindrical object can both be assumed equal to W = πR1 h , where R1 is the radius of vessel (1), and h is its height. 2
Assume that such polymers are used that separate polymerization would give homopolymers with refractive indices n1 and n2, and that n1 < n2. Let us denote these monomers as Mmin and Mmax. The maximal difference in refraction that can be realized over the radius of the cylindrical object is ∆nmax = n2 – n1. Assume that an object needed with the refractive index gradient profile shown in Figure 66, where the abscissa axis represents the distance from the cylinder side to its center, and the ordinate axis is the difference in the refractive index. Obviously, the increase of n from the periphery to the center of the cylinder must be caused by an increase in the volumetric proportion of the component with higher refractive index, ϕ(Mmax), in the mixture with the component possessing lower refractive index, Mmin, from 0 up to 100%. That is why the curve shown in Figure 27 does not change if the volumetric proportion ϕ(Mmax) is displayed on the ordinate axis instead of n, and the nmax point is combined with the point of 100% content ϕ(Mmax), and the point nmin with the point of zero content (Figure 27). Filling of the vessel (8) (Figure 26) of radius R1 by the mixture of Mmax and Mmin proceeds during time τ. That is why the curve run in Figure 66 will not change, if R is substituted by τ on the abscissa axis (Figure 27).
V(Mmax) ϕ(Mmax) %
n
100
max
0
min
0
R1
τ1
R
τ
Figure 27. Dependence of the refractive index (n), volumetric proportion of component with higher refractive index ϕ(Mmax) and rate of plunger motion V(Mmax) in vessel (1) (Figure 26) on distance R from the edge to the center of vessel (8) for copolymerization and duration of its filling (τ)
60
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
To increase the volumetric part ϕ(Mmax) from periphery to center of the object (or the same in a stream of mixture delivered to the vessel (8)) in accordance with the curve in Figure 27, the rate of plunger (5) motion in vessel (1) (Figure 26) must change according to the same relationship. That is why V(Mmax) can be represented on the ordinate axis instead of ϕ(Mmax), and hence the maximal value of V(Mmax) must be combined with the point of 100% content of Mmax. Thus, the nature of the dependence of n on R1 is equivalent to that of V(Mmax) on τ. A graph of dependence of the volumetric proportion of the component with lower refractive index ϕ(Mmin) on R (Figure 28) is plotted from the curve given in Figure 66. Using analogous reasoning to that above, this dependence can be reduced to the one of V(Mmax) on τ, where V(Mmax) is the rate of plunger (6) motion in vessel (2) filled with Mmin. These curves are integrated graphically according to the method given in ref. [144, 145]. Results are shown in Figure 29. Based on the dependence obtained, x = f(τ), the profile of cams (3) and (4) may be calculated.
R1 R
τ1 τ
Figure 28. Dependence of volumetric proportion of the component with lower refractive index ϕ(Mmin) and the rate of plunger motion V(Mmin) in vessel (2) (Figure 26) on distance R from the edge to the center of vessel (8) (Figure 26) for copolymerization and duration of its filling (τ)
Volume of the procurement, W, is: W = W1 + W2; W1 = πr2l1, W2 = πr2l2, where W1 and W2 are the volumes of components Mmax and Mmin that are extruded from vessels (1) and (2), respectively; r is the radius of vessels (1) and (2); l1 and l2 are maximal displacements of plungers (5) and (6) in vessels (1) and (2), respectively. It is clear that R12h = r2(l1 + l2).
(37)
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
61
X X1 a
X2
b
τ1 τ Figure 29. Dependence of relative displacement of plungers (Figure 26) on time (τ): 1 – in vessel (1); 2 – in vessel (2)
The following relation can be derived from Figure 1:
x1 =K. x2 Values of l1 and l2 depend on r. However, in any case:
x1 l1 = =K. x2 l 2
(38)
Comparing equations (37) and (38), we get:
l1 =k•l2
l2= R12h/r2(1+ K)
(39)
In Figure 29, maximal values of x1 and x2 equal the calculated values of l1 and l2, respectively, and are based on the dependence obtained by the method already used in Section 4 [138], where profiles of cams (3) and (4) are considered. This method allows us to obtain materials with a given profile of radial distribution and other properties that depend on the composition.
4.6. Method of Obtaining Cylindrical (Disk-Like) Objects with a Given Radial Composition (Refractive Index) Gradient Based on Powder-Like Materials [146] As powder-like substances are used for obtaining cylindrical objects by the method discussed in the previous Section, several specific problems must be solved. In particular,
62
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
when powder-like substances are injected according to a definite program into a cylinder vessel rotating around its axis, then the density of material within the vessel will decrease from the periphery to the center with centrifugal force. That is why the real shrinkage at melting of a powder-like material will increase with radius from periphery to center which, at leveling of the melt surface, leads to a shift of melt layers and distortion of the given radial distribution of the composition. In this Section, we present solutions for several major problems encountered in preparing laminar objects with a given radial distribution of refractive index, starting from powder-like materials. Figure 30 shows the main features of the apparatus required. The appliance consists of bunker (1) with partition (2) separating areas filled by powder-like substances I and II (view A-A) possessing different refractive indices. Bunker (1) is equipped with a sliding valve (3). The appliance also contains bunker-mixer (4) with mixer (5) and electric engine (6). Further on in the processing, the appliance possesses a cylinder molding volume (7) with a cone-like lid (8) and a hole (9). Volume (7) is fixed on the table of a centrifuge (10) connected with an electric engine (11). The appliance operates as follows. Powder-like components I and II are placed in bunker (1), to areas I and II, respectively. As slide valve (3) is displaced in the direction marked by the arrow, components I and II from bunker (1) are gradually delivered to bunker-mixer (4) and, mixed by mixer (5), are delivered through whole (9) to molding volume (7) rotating around its axis. When the latter is filled, rotation is stopped, and thermal processing is performed.
A
A
A-A 1 2
1 3
4
6
3 I
II
5 1
9 8 7 10
II
I
2 3
11 Figure 30. Principal features of the appliance used to obtain a cylindrical object from powder-like substances with the given radial gradient of refractive index. See text for details
The following notations are used in this Section:
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
63
n is the refractive index; n1 and n2 are refractive indices of components, n2 > n1; R is the radius of the cylindrical product; H is the height of the cylinder procurement; [mon.n1] is the concentration of the component of the cylindrical object in the monolith state with refractive index n1 and density ρ1; [mon.n2] is the concentration of the component of the cylindrical object in the monolith state with refractive index n2 and density ρ2; [pow.n1] is the concentration of the powder-like component in the cylindrical vessel with refractive index n1 and density ρ1(R), i.e. dependent on radius R; [pow.n2] is the powder-like component in the cylinder vessel with refractive index n2 and density ρ2(R), i.e. also dependent on radius R; ϕ is the volumetric part of the component; ∆r is the interval of constant length on the procurement radius R; j is the number of interval ∆r, j = 0, 1, 2, 3, …, k – 1; Vj is the component volume in the j-th layer, placed between two cylinder surfaces, radii of which are j∆r and (j + 1)∆r; mj is the component mass in the j-th layer; hj is the component height in the j-th layer. Assume that a cylinder of height H and radius R is prepared, in which radial distribution of the refractive index, i.e. dependence n = f(r) is of the shape shown in Figure 31, curve ‘a’. The central cross-section of such a cylinder is shown in Figure 32.
n n2
a
n1 R
r
Figure 31. The given dependence of refractive (n) on radius (R) of cylindrical product
To obtain such a product, components I and II with refractive indices n1 and n2 (n1 < n2) and density ρ1 and ρ2 are used. The refractive index from the cylinder center to periphery decreases with the ϕ-volumetric proportion of the component with n2 and ρ2 in the monolith state [mon.n2] mixed with the component with n1 and ρ1 in the monolith state [mon.n1]. As ϕ[mon.n2] decreases, ϕ[mon.n1] increases so that the following equation is true for every value of R:
ϕ[mon.n1] + ϕ[mon.n2] = 1.
(40)
64
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
n n2 H
a n1
r
R
R
0
r
Figure 32. Central cross-section of a cylinder-shaped product H high and R in radius, in which dependence of the refractive index (n) on radius (R) is expressed by curve ‘a’, i.e. it possesses the shape shown in Figure 31.
ϕ[mon. n2]
That is why the shape of the curve ‘a’ in Figure 31 will not change if ϕ[mon.n2] is substituted on the ordinate axis instead of n, and the n2 point is combined with the point of 100% content of this component, and the n1 point is replaced by the zero content point (Figure 33).
1
0
R
r
Figure 33. Dependence of the volumetric part (ϕ) of component in the monolith state with n2 on radius (R) of cylindrical product
ϕ[mon. n2]
Figure 34. Central cross-section of the cylindrical product H high and R in radius, in which dependence of the volumetric part (ϕ) of the component in the monolith state with refractive index n2 on radius of the cylinder, R, is expressed by curve ‘b’, i.e. it possesses the shape shown in Figure 33
Let us suppose that the average value of refractive index n in the product is given by n = n2ϕ[mon.n2] + n1{1 – ϕ[mon.n2]}.
(41)
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
65
Relation (41) implies that ϕ[mon.n2] depends on r, with 0 ≤ r ≤ R. Then relation (41) is reduced to the form: n(r) = n2ϕ[mon.n2](r) + n1{1 – ϕ[mon.n2](r)}.
(42)
Solving equation (42) in relation to ϕ[mon.n2](r), we get:
ϕ[mon.n2](r) =
n(r ) − n1 . n2 − n1
(43)
If a graph of ϕ[mon.n2](r) is plotted point by point with the help of Figure 31 and expression (43), the curve shown in Figure 33 will be obtained. By the same arguments, the contour of the central cross-section of the cylindrical product in Figure 32 will not change if it is presented in the coordinates of Figure 34. This Figure can be interpreted as follows: if [mon.n1] and [mon.n2] are mentally separated from each other for every value of R and disposed according to height H above each other, then the sought-for cylindrical product can be conditionally considered somewhat to consist of two parts, where the shaded area corresponds to [mon.n1] and the clear one to [mon.n2]. Let us divide the interval [0, R] in Figure 34 into intervals of constant length ∆r, the number of which is k = R/∆r (Figure 35).
1 H 0
R
∆r 2∆r
j∆r (j+1)∆r
R
Figure 35. See text for details.
Numbers of intervals are j = 0, 1, 2, 3,…, (k – 1), and cross-link points are 0, ∆r, 2∆r, 3∆r, …, (k – 1)∆r = R. Let us consider an interval [j∆r, (j + 1)∆r]. It represents a layer formed by two cylinder surfaces, radii of which are j∆r and (j + 1)∆r. Let us denote this layer as j. In the present case, height of this layer equals the height of the cylinder. Heights of [mon.n2] and [mon.n1] in this layer are equal to:
hj[mon.n2] = f j∆r +
∆r ; 2
hj[mon.n1] = H – f j∆r +
∆r . 2
Let us calculate volumes of [mon.n1] and [mon.n2] in the j-th layer:
(44)
(45)
66
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
∆r = π(2j + 1)∆r2⋅f j∆r + . 2
Vj[mon.n2] = π[(j + 1)∆r]2⋅f j∆r +
∆r ∆r 2 – π(j∆r )⋅f j∆r + 2 2 (46)
With regard to equation (45), Vj[mon.n1] is calculated in an analogous manner:
∆r = π(2j + 1)∆r2⋅[H – f j∆r + ]. 2
Vj[mon.n1] = π[(j + 1)∆r]2⋅[H – f j∆r +
∆r ∆r 2 ] – π(j∆r )⋅[H – f j∆r + ] 2 2 (47)
Masses of the components in the j-th layer are: mj[mon.n1] = ρ1Vj[mon.n1];
(48)
mj[mon.n2] = ρ2Vj[mon.n2].
(49)
Operating with the density notion suggests that densities of each pure component and a mixture with another component are equal. Such a suggestion applies to components in both powder and monolith states. To obtain a preform H high, the height of the molding vessel must be (H + ∆H), because material shrinkage occurs during melting of the powder-like components and monolith formation. Therewith, the real shrinkage increases with respect to radius from periphery to center proportionally to the filling density decrease stipulated by the centrifugal force decrease. This means that obtaining of a preform H high and exclusion of horizontal displacement of the material after melting of powder-like components demand ∆H changing with radius, i.e. it depends upon j. Determined experimentally are ρ1(R) and ρ2(R) – dependencies of the filling density by powder-like components with n1 and n2 on R at the given rotation frequency of centrifuge (11) electric motor (Figure 30). Let us denote powder-like substances loaded into the volume (7) (Figure 30) as [pow.n1] and [pow.n2]. Components possessing mass mj and present in the j-th layer of the monolith in the powder-like state with regard to filling density dependence on R occupy the following volumes:
V j [pow.n1 ] = V j [pow.n2 ] =
m j [pow.n1 ]
ρ1 ( R)
,
m j [pow.n2 ]
ρ 2 ( R)
(50)
.
(51)
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
67
As the mass of components is independent of their state, we get:
V j [mon.n1 ] = V j [mon.n2 ] =
m j [mon.n1 ]
ρ1 ( R)
,
m j [mon.n2 ]
ρ 2 ( R)
(52)
.
(53)
Volume increase, when we have [pow.n1] instead of [mon.n1], is: ∆Vj(n1) = Vj[pow.n1] – Vj[mon.n1]. With the regard to equation (52), we get:
∆V j (n1 ) =
ρ1
ρ1 ( R)
⋅V j [mon.n1 ] − V j [mon.n1 ] ,
ρ ∆V j (n1 ) = 1 − 1 ⋅ V j [mon.n1 ] . ρ1 ( R)
(54)
In an analogous way, the volume increase when [pow.n2] is taken instead of [mon.n2], is calculated as
ρ ∆V j (n2 ) = 2 − 1 ⋅V j [mon.n2 ] . ρ 2 ( R)
(55)
Let us calculate height growth of the j-th layer – ∆Hj, [pow.n1] and [pow.n2] are assumed instead of [mon.n1] and [mon.n2]: ∆Hj = ∆h’j + ∆h”j,
(56)
where ∆h’j and ∆h”j are height increments due to increase of ∆Vj(n1) and ∆Vj(n2) volumes, respectively:
∆h′j =
∆h′j′ =
4
π (∆r )2 4
π (∆r )2
⋅ ∆V j (n1 ) ,
(57a)
⋅ ∆V j ( n 2 ) .
(57b)
With the regard to equations (54) and (55), we get:
68
∆h′j =
∆h′j′ =
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
4
ρ ⋅ 1 − 1V j [mon.n1 ] , ρ1 ( R)
(58)
4
ρ ⋅ 2 − 1V j [mon.n2 ] . ρ 2 ( R)
(59)
π (∆r )2
π (∆r )2
Transforming these equations with regard to (46) and (47), and introducing into equation (56), finally, we obtain ρ ρ ∆r ∆r , ∆H j = 4( 2 j + 1) 1 − 1 h − f j∆r + + 4(2 j + 1) 2 − 1 ⋅ f j∆r + 2 2 ρ1 ( R ) ρ 2 ( R)
or
ρ ∆H j = 4(2 j + 1) 1 − 1 h − ρ1 ( R )
∆r ρ 2 f j∆r + − 1 ⋅ + 2 ρ 2 ( R)
∆r . f j ∆r + 2
(60)
Profile of a cone-like lid (8) (Figure 30), at which horizontal displacement of the melt and distortion of the given radial distribution of the composition are excluded, is calculated by equation (60). The present Section also suggests a variant of dosed delivery of powder-like components I and II to the tank (7) (Figure 30), demanded by some other definite shape to the bunker (1). For this purpose, the length of partition (2) (Figure 30) is set equal to R – the radius of the cylinder preform. Partition (2), as in Figure 74, is divided into intervals of constant length ∆r, the number of which k =
R , and numbers of intervals j = 0, 1, 2, 3, …, (k – 1), and cross ∆r
points 0, ∆r, 2∆r, 3∆r, …, j∆r, (j + 1)∆r, …, (k – 1)∆r = R (Figure 36). The values of ρ1(H) and ρ2(H), the apparent densities of powder-like components with refractive indices n1 and n2, respectively, are experimentally determined. If the component mass in the j-th layer of the preform is known, the volume of this component in the bunker can be determined:
V j [pow.n1 , ρ1 ( H )] = V j [pow.n2 , ρ 2 ( H )] =
m j [mon.n1 ]
ρ1 ( H )
,
m j [mon.n2 ]
ρ2 (H )
(61)
.
(62)
If the bunker is filled with powder-like components up to the height l, volumes of these components can be expressed in terms of the bunker parameters (Figure 36):
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
69
V j [pow.n1 , ρ1 ( H )] = l∆rx j (n1 ) ,
(63)
V j [pow.n2 , ρ 2 ( H )] = l∆rx j (n2 ) .
(64)
Substituting volumes from equations (61) and (62) to (63) and (64) and determining xj(n1) and xj(n2), we get expressions for calculating the profile of the bunker walls:
x j (n1 ) =
x j ( n2 ) =
m j [mon.n1 ]
ρ1 ⋅ l ⋅ ∆r
,
m j [mon.n2 ]
ρ 2 ⋅ l ⋅ ∆r
(65)
.
(66)
Clearly the length of the partition (2) in the bunker (1) (Figure 30) should optionally equal the preform radius. Moreover, to raise accuracy of the controlled delivery of powderlike components, thickness of the powder layer (l) and the front of components delivery x(n1) and x(n2) must be reduced, and the length of partition (2) must be increased.
3
0 ∆r
Component filling zone
2∆r
[pow. n1, ρ1(H)]
Component filling zone [pow. n2, ρ2(H)]
j∆r 2
(j+1)∆r 1
x(n1)
R
x(n2)
Figure 36. Scheme for calculating profile of bunker (1) walls (Figure 30): 1 – front side of the bunker; 2 – direction of slider (3) motion (Figure 30); 3 – bunker partition.
The method suggested can be applied to obtain materials with the radial gradient not only of the refractive index, but of other physicochemical properties also.
70
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
4.7. Method of Obtaining Long Polymeric Cylindrical Preforms with Gradual Radial Gradient of Refractive Index [126] As mentioned above, a monofiber with a core and a cover is able to transmit light energy only, but not images. To transmit images, a fiber must possess a gradient of refractive index. Such a fiber can be molded from a selfoc, prepared by the photopolymerization method [119, 120], for which either linear or three-dimensional polymers can be used. At the same time, the method of photopolymerization enables us not to have to form a previously given radial gradient of refractive index in a selfoc. Moreover (which is no less significant), making stricter demands on the monomers (in difference in copolymerization constants), this method narrows the class of polymers suitable for fiber molding. The method of a cylinder preform production of an arbitrary diameter with the given radial gradual profile of refractive index distribution based on polymers, from which optical fibers can be molded capable of image transmission, is discussed below. The initial substances are two fluid monomers (for example, methyl methacrylate or ethyl methacrylate and styrene), which at separate polymerization form transparent homopolymers with different values of the refractive indices, n1 and n2, in which we take n2 > n1. The same monomers at any volumetric relation form transparent copolymers. It is also necessary for shrinkage coefficients ρmon/ρpow to be equal or to be of close values, because this situation affects the degree to which the theoretical calculations can be realized.
R1
Figure 37. Cylinder bar from homopolymer with high refractive index n2 and radius R1.
First, a cylindrical bar of radius R1 from homopolymer with n2 (Figure 37) and a copolymeric belt with the axial composition gradient L long, S wide, and H high (Figure 38) are prepared. On one end of the belt (marked by a cross) structural units with n1 prevail, and on the other one (marked by a circle) the units with n2 predominate. The direction of increase of the refractive index over the belt length L from n1 to n2 is indicated by an arrow. The refractive index does not change along the belt width S (dotted line), as the concentration of the structural units with indices n1 and n2 is the same.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
L
71
H
S
Figure 38. Untwisted copolymeric belt with given sizes (L, S, H) and structural units with high refractive index n2 and low refractive index n1 prevailing on opposite ends of it (marked by a circle and a cross, respectively).
Such a copolymeric belt is tightly twisted on the bar from the homopolymer with n2 starting with the end where the prevailing structural units are those with index n2 (Figure 39), after which the preform is caked. Therewith, the preliminarily given distribution of the refractive index over radius R2 of the cylinder preform obtained (Figure 40) is provided.
Figure 39. Copolymeric belt partially twisted on cylinder bar from homopolymer starting with the end possessing structural units with high refractive index.
The copolymeric belt with the given profile of refractive index axial distribution is produced on a device (Figure 41), generally analogous to the one described above (Figure 36). Vessel (1) is designed for a monomer with n1, and vessel (2) for a monomer with n2. During rotation, cams (3) and (4) move plungers (5) and (6). Monomers flowing out of vessels (1) and (2) in the given permanently changing ratio are mixed in a worm mixer (7) and delivered through input sleeves (8) to casting mold (9) (L long and S wide) evenly moving in the direction indicated by an arrow. Limiting plate (10) makes for uniform
72
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
redistribution of the monomer mixture in the filling zone in the casting mold (9). The duration of the delivery of the monomer mixture to casting mold (9), i.e. duration of motion of the plungers (5) and (6), is the time it takes for the casting mold (9) to travel along the whole length L. As the casting mold (9) is filled, photo- and thermal polymerization of the mixture is performed.
R2
Figure 40. Long cylinder preform with given size and distribution of the refractive index over radius R2.
Calculations required for preparing a cylinder preform S high and R2 in radius representing a copolymeric belt twisted on a cylinder bar from homopolymer with radius R1 (Figure 40) are based on the following ideas. Recall that dependence n = f(R2) of refractive index on radius of the cylinder preform is, for example, shaped as in Figure 42.
2
1
3 5
4
4
3
Figure 41. Principal features of the device for producing a copolymeric belt with given sizes (L, S, H) and axial distribution of refractive index.
Obviously, decrease of n along R1 towards the preform periphery (Figure 40) is the consequence of a decrease of volumetric proportion ϕ of the polymerized component with index n2 in the copolymeric belt from 1 to 0 and of appropriate increase of the proportion by volume (1 – ϕ) of the polymerized component with index n1. That is why the curve illustrated
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
73
in Figure 42 will not change if n is substituted byϕ on the ordinate axis, and the value of n2 is combined with the point of 100% content of the component with index n2, and n1 with the point where it is of zero concentration (Figure 43). The justification for such substitution was discussed above (see Section 4.6).
n n2
n1 0
R1
R2 r
Figure 42. Given dependence of refractive index (n) on radius of a long cylinder preform (R2).
ϕ 1
0
R1
R2 r
Figure 43. Dependence of volumetric proportion (ϕ) of the component with high refractive index (n2) on radius of long cylinder preform (R2).
According to a change of copolymer composition along the belt length, difference in shrinkage coefficients ρ(mon)/ρ(pol) of the components with high and low values of refractive index must lead to an appropriate change in the belt thickness. However, as this change is low due to low thickness of the belt, the belt thickness h along its length is assumed to be uniform. The twisted belt represents a spiral. In the first approximation, a series of circles with alternating radii can be considered instead of the spiral. Let us designate length of the k-th loop as lk: lk = 2π(R1 + kH). Here k is the loop number; k = 1, 2, 3, …, i.
(67)
74
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov Total length of untwisted belt is
m 1+ m L = ∑ 2π (R1 + kH ) = 2π mR1 + H m , 2 k =1
(68)
where m is the number of loops; m = 1, 2, 3, …, i. In untwisted belt (Figure 38), points dislocated along the radius of the cylinder preform (Figure 40) will be disposed at the distance 2π(R1 + kH) from each other. Based on the graph (Figure 43) and with regard to equation (68), graphs [1 – ϕ](l) and ϕ(l) are plotted point by point, where 0 ≤ l ≤ L. Further on, these curves are graphically integrated. Graphs x1(l) and x2(l) are obtained in which x1 and x2 are maximum relative displacements of plungers (5) and (6) (Figure 41). Let us denote the relation: x2/x1 = z.
(69)
and introduce the following designations:
ρ1(mon) and V1(mon) are density and volume of the monomer with n1 spent, respectively; ρ1(pol) and V1(pol) are density and volume of copolymeric belt component formed from the monomer with n1; ρ2(mon) and V2(mon) are density and volume of the monomer with n2 spent, respectively; ρ2(pol) and V2(pol) are density and volume of copolymeric belt component formed from the monomer with n2. It is clear that
ρ1(mon)⋅V1(mon) = ρ1(pol)⋅V1(pol);
(70)
ρ2(mon)⋅V2(mon) = ρ2(pol)⋅V2(pol).
(71)
and V1(mon) = πR3 x1 ; 2
(72)
V2(mon) = πR3 x2 = πR3 x1Z , 2
2
where R3 is the radius of vessels (1) and (2) (Figure 41). The volume of the copolymeric belt equals: LSh = V1(pol) + V2(pol). With regard to equations (70), (71), (72) and (73), we get:
(73)
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties LSH = πR3 x1 ⋅ 2
ρ1 (mon ) ρ (mon ) + πR32 x1 z 2 , ρ1 (pol ) ρ 2 (pol )
75
(74)
which gives
x1 =
LSH . ρ 2 (mon ) 2 ρ1 (mon ) +z πR3 ( ) pol ρ ρ 2 (pol ) 1
(75)
Knowing x1, x2 can be calculated from equation (63). If shrinkage during copolymerization is neglected, expression (75) takes the following form:
x1 =
LSH . πR32 (1 + z )
(76)
At mentioned above, the duration of motion of the plungers (5) and (6) in vessels (1) and (2) (Figure 41), i.e. the time during which the mixture of monomers with indices n1 and n2 is delivered into the casting mold (9) equals the duration of motion of the mold (9) at a constant rate over the distance L. Designate this duration as τa. Let us select a value of R3 for vessels (1) and (2) and calculate numerical values of x1 and x2 . Plot graphs of functions x1(τ) and x2(τ), for which purpose the value of L on graphs x1(l) and x2(l) is equal to τa. Further on, profiles of cams (5) and (6) are calculated according to the methods described in ref. [138]. An example of the cam calculation is shown in Section 4.1. The method described allows us to produce polymeric cylinders, from which optical rods and fibers with the given radial gradual distribution of the refractive index can be molded, and which are suitable for image transmission.
4.8. Method of Diffusion Copolymerization of Monomers [33, 37, 61, 147 149] (See Section 3) The maximum diameter of selfocs obtained by the known methods is limited by the restrictive conditions – by the low degree of polymerization of gel-polymer, which is required to ensure the possibility of monomer diffusion with low refractive index deep into the selfoc. A flexible rod of large diameter taken out of the mold is deformed under the effect of its own weight, and a preform with distorted circular cross-section is obtained, which deteriorates the optical properties of the gradient element. However, at relatively high conversion, which is required to ensure enough rigidity in a rod of large diameter to avoid deformation under its own weight after it is taken out of the mold, diffusion of monomer with lower refractive index is hindered. Consequently, the width of the product displaying refractive index gradient, narrows.
76
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
A method of obtaining a gradient element, in which the stage of gel-matrix preparation and limitations associated with it are absent, is discussed below. At the same time, the method discussed includes aspects of both the method of exchange diffusion and lit-par-lit copolymerization [11, 42, 43, 119, 120], which is indicated below.
7
8
6 5
1
4 3
h
2
h1 R
r
2d Figure 44. Principal features of device for obtaining a selfoc. See text for details.
A device, the main features of which (diametrical cross-section) are shown in Figure 44, is used to realize the method. The device consists of a cylinder tumbler (2). Pipe (6) is tightly mounted at the middle of the polished base (3) of the tumbler (2). Tumbler (2) position is fixed by logs (1) and (4). The upper end of pipe (6) passes out of pipe (5) and is connected with electric motor (8) by a worm mechanism (7). Monomer-I (or a mixture of monomers) with high refractive index is poured into pipe (6) at height h. Monomer-II (or a mixture of monomers) with low refractive index and possessing density the same as the monomer-I in pipe (6) is poured into the space between the wall of tumbler (2) and pipe (6) at the same height h. Electric motor (8) is started up, and pipe (6) is carefully removed from tumbler (2) to exclude any possibility of flow formation leading to inhomogeneous mixing of monomers I and II. As the result of exchange diffusion of monomers I and II, the concentration gradient is obtained, which is fixed by carrying out the polymerization reaction. To illustrate the essence of the method suggested, assume that after pipe (6) is removed from tumbler (2), monomers I and II do not mix and just change their spatial forms – height h decreases, and R and r increase (see Figure 44). As density and level of monomers I and II are equal in the filling zones, pressure caused by these monomers on the internal and external walls of pipe (6) is also equal. It can be assumed that reduction of height h in the zones of monomers I and II is equal under the condition that R in the monomer-I zone and r in the monomer-II zone also increase equally (i.e. by d), which is achieved at definite scales of pipe (6) and tumbler (2).
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
77
Let us introduce the following designations: V(I) – the monomer I volume; V(II) – the monomer II volume; V(III) – the volume of pipe (6) dipped in the monomer; V*(I) – the volume of the monomer I after removal of pipe (6); V*(II) – the volume of the monomer II after removal of pipe (6). V(I) = πR2h; V(I) + V(III) = πh(R + 2d)2; V(I) + V(II) + V(III) = πh(R + 2d + r)2; V(II) = πh(R + 2d + r)2 – [V(I) + V(III)]; V(II) = πhr(2R + 4d + r).
(77)
As pipe (6) is completely removed from tumbler (2), height of the monomer-I column decreases down to h1, and radius increases up to (R + d). Analogously, height of the monomer-II ring decreases down to h1, and thickness of the ring increases up to (r + d). Volumes of monomers are equal to V*(I) = πh1(R + d)2; V*(I) + V*(II) = πh1(R + 2d + r)2; V*(II) = πh1(R + 2d + r)2 – V*(I) = πh1(R + 2d + r)2 – πh1(R + d)2; V*(II) = πh1(2R + 3d + r)(d + r).
(78a)
It is clear that V(I) = V*(I); πR2h = πh1(R + d)2; R2h = h1(R + d)2; V(II) = V*(II).
(78b)
With regard to equations (76) and (77), we get: πhr(2R + 4d + r) = πh1(2R + 3d + r)(d + r); hr(2R + 4d + r) = h1(2R + 3d + r)(d + r).
(79)
Let us divide equation (78) by (79):
( R2 R + d )2 = . r (2 R + 4d + r ) (2 R + 3d + r )(d + r )
(80)
Equation (80) expresses the condition when, at the initial equal level of monomers after removal of pipe (6) due to equality of densities, the monomers I and II fuse in the manner that only vertical planes contact with each other, i.e. a column from the monomer I (h1 high and (R + d) in radius) exists in the center of tumbler (2) surrounded by the circle from the monomer
78
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
II (h1 high and (r + d) in radius). This provides for the condition for radial exchange diffusion leading to formation of radial concentration gradient, fixed then by photo- and thermal polymerization. For this purpose, tumbler (2) is covered by a pipe furnace. In this case, mutual disposition of the components resembles that given in ref. [33] in appearance, in which one of the components is a cylinder gel-polymeric rod surrounded by a medium of a liquid monomer (Table 9). The method discussed also includes signs of lit-parlit copolymerization [11, 42, 43, 119, 120], when both components participating in the gradient element formation are liquids. The generality of these external signs is mentioned above. The method can be realized with the help of the following monomers: Table 9. Monomers
ρ 420
nD20
Styrene Diallylisophthalate Methyl methacrylate Ethyl methacrylate n-Propyl methacrylate iso-Propyl methacrylate n-Butyl methacrylate iso-Butyl methacrylate tert-Butyl methacrylate 1,1,3-Trihydrotetrafluoropropyl methacrylate
0.9060 1.12 0.9440 0.9135 0.9022 0.8847 0.8936 0.8858 0.8775 1.232
1.5468 1.5254 1.4142 1.4147 1.4183 1.4334 1.4240 1.4199 1.4143 1.375
The method described allows us to generate preforms with comparatively large diameter but with strictly rounded cross-section and smooth surface. If a component with lower refractive index is poured into pipe (6), and the space between the pipe and the tumbler is filled by a component with high refractive index, a selfoc is obtained equivalent to a defocusing lens.
4.9. Preparing a Selfoc with Elliptical Cross-Section [150] A selfoc able to transform radiation with asymmetric diagram of direction from band semiconductor radiation to a point irradiator with axis-symmetric radiation, as well as suitable as a preform for molding unimode wave guides capable of retaining the polarization plane of radiation passing though it, must be of elliptical cross-section. Such a selfoc is obtained in an analogous device, in which the pipe and the tumbler possess an elliptical cross-section (Figure 44). Pipe (1) with elliptical cross-section is filled by the monomer I with high refractive index, and the space between pipe (1) and tumbler (2) is filled by the monomer II with low refractive index. Monomers I and II are of the same density.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
79
2d c 1 2b 2 2a Figure 45. Projection of pipe and tumbler of the device, for producing a selfoc with elliptical cross-section.
Later, as described in Section 4.8, the pipe is carefully taken out and, after exposure, photo- and thermal copolymerization are performed. Using argument analogous to that given above, it can be shown that to provide conditions such that monomers I and II will join in the vertical plane after the pipe is removed from the tumbler, the overall size of the tumbler must be defined by the following equation:
ab a+b+d = , c(a + b + 3d + c) a + b + 3d
(81)
where a and b are the major and minor semiaxes of the pipe with elliptical cross-section, respectively; c is the distance between the external pipe wall and the internal tumbler wall, also with elliptical cross-sections; and d is the semi-thickness of the pipe wall, again of elliptical cross-section.
4.10. Preparing a Multi-Channel Light Focusing Matrix [151, 152] In Sections 4.8 and 4.9, equations (80) and (81) are deduced from the condition when parameters of the device for preparing a selfoc (tumbler (2) and pipe (1) diameters, and wall thickness of pipe (1)) are selected such that after pipe withdrawal after equal shrinkage of monomers, the radius of the central cylinder monomer column (3) and peripheral monomeric circle (4) wall thickness increase by the semi-thickness of the pipe (1) (Figure 46a). In Figure 46b, the volumes of the central and peripheral monomers are designated by V1 and V4, which fill volumes V2 and V3 that are vacated by taking out pipe (1). Hence, V1 = V2 and V3 = V4. General formulation of the regularity of the overall size change of the monomers at their equal shrinkage, independent of the cross-section profile of tumbler (2) and pipe (1), will broaden significantly the potential applications of the approach described above. Let us introduce the following designations: h1 is the initial monomer height in the tumbler and the pipe; h2 is the monomer column height after pipe withdrawal; S1 and S4 are the initial areas of the central and peripheral monomers; S2 is the base area part of pipe (1), by which the area of the central monomer increases after withdrawal of the pipe; S3 is the area of the remainder of the pipe (1), by which the peripheral monomer area increases after pipe
80
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
withdrawal. Therewith, values of S2 and S3, and V2 and V3, respectively, are not regulated by the semi-thickness of pipe (1) in either Section 4.8 or 4.9. S2+S3
S2+S3 1 2
S1
S4
3
S1
S4
V1
V4
4
V2
h1
V3
h2 a
b
Figure 46. See text for details.
It is clear that at even shrinkage of monomers, volumes V2 = S2h2 and V3 = S3h2 that become free after pipe (1) withdrawal are occupied by the central monomer volume V1 = S1(h1 – h2) and the peripheral monomer volume V4 = S4(h1 – h2), respectively. Hence S1(h1 – h2) = S2h2, S4(h1 – h2) = S3h2, which gives S1/S4 = S2/S3,
(82)
H2(S2 + S3) = (h1 – h2)(S1 + S4).
(83)
These equations express the change in the overall size of the central and peripheral monomers, possessing equal density, after the pipe withdrawal and are true for any crosssection profile (circle, ellipse, etc.) of the tumbler and the pipe. Based on equation (83), multichannel optical devices can be prepared, a single matrix of which will contain several selfocs simultaneously, which may be similar or different in area and cross-section profile, and chemical composition. For this purpose, the required number of pipes with chosen (similar or different) profiles and values of the cross-sectional area are placed into the tumbler. Pipes are filled with the same or different unsaturated fluid monomers (a mixture of monomers) with equal (equalized) density up to the same height, and the space between the pipes and the tumbler is filled by a monomer (a mixture of monomers) possessing the same density but lower refractive index up to the same height. Then all the pipes are withdrawn simultaneously. The system is now unrestrained, so that radial gradient of the composition, which is determined by the performance of the copolymerization, is achieved by diffusion exchange. Parameters of
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
81
pipes and the tumbler used in this case are related by the following equation in the reduced form of expression (83):
S (1) + S 4(1) S1( 2) + S 4( 2) S1(3) + S 4(3) S1( n ) + S 4( n ) h2 , = 1(1) + + + + ... h1 − h2 S 2 + S 3(1) S 2( 2) + S 3( 2) S 2(3) + S 3(3) S 2( n ) + S 3( n )
(84)
where h1 is the initial height of monomers in the tumbler and pipes;
S1(1) , S1( 2) , S1(3) , …, S1( n ) are areas of the apertures of the first, second, third, . . . up to the n-th pipe, respectively;
S 2(1) , S 2( 2) , S 2(3) , …, S 2( n ) are the parts of the tumbler base area occupied by the first, second, third, . . . up to the n-th pipe, respectively, in contact with the central monomer;
S 3(1) , S 3( 2) , S 3(3) , …, S 3( n ) are the remaining parts of the second, third, . . . up to the n-th pipe wall areas, respectively;
S 4(1) is the area of the peripheral monomer surface, when a single pipe is introduced into the tumbler;
S 4( 2) , S 4(3) , …, S 4( n ) are increments of the peripheral monomer surface when the second, third, . . . up to the n-th pipe are introduced into the tumbler. The total area of the apertures in the tumbler is i =n
i =n
i =n
i =n
i =1
i =2
i =3
i = n −1
S = ∑ S1(i ) + ∑ S 2(i ) + ∑ S 3(i ) + ... +
∑ S n(i−)1 + S n(i ) .
(85)
Table 10. Comparison of production methods for light focusing elements
Production method Two-stage copolymerization (diffusion copolymerization) [43, 44, 46] Lit-par-lit copolymerization (photocopolymeri-zation) [104 – 106, 112 – 114] Diffusion copolymerization of monomers
Polymers used Linear Spatial
Optical fiber molding
+
Multifunctional light focusing matrix obtaining +
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
Describing conditions of the equal shrinkage of monomers, equations (84) and (85) give the possibility for simultaneous regulation of changes of monomer overall sizes (h2, S2 and S3) and, consequently, overall size of light focusing elements. The method of diffusion copolymerization of monomers includes positive aspects of the above-mentioned methods of
82
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
two-stage polymerization [33] and photocopolymerization [123], both from the point of view of technological realization and characteristics of light focusing matrices obtained (Table 10).
4.11. Study of the Effects of γ-Irradiation on Optical Properties of Isotactic Polypropylene [153] All the above-mentioned methods for preparing GRIN-elements, in which the GRINforming process decelerates the diffusion/polymer-analogous transformation deep into the material, are characterized by limiting of the diameter/thickness of the element, as well as the difficulty of RID variation. However, ionizing radiation produces serious structural changes in polymers – degradation, branching and network structure formation, which produce significant change of some physical properties, including optical ones [154, 155]. That is why it is of special interest is study the possibility of using ionizing radiation as a GRIN-forming influence, γ-radiation, in particular, possessing an ability to penetrate deep into materials. This ability is discussed below using the example of isotactic PP (15 µm thickness) by studying the changes that are produced by radiation in the values of the most relevant parameters the characteristics of absorption in the UV-spectrum and refractive index in the visible region of the spectrum (radiation source, 137Cs isotope; radiation temperature, 25 ± 3°C, in air; radiation power, 2.5 Gr/min; quantum energy, E = 0.662 MeV; radiation dose, R ≤ 60 kGr; the range of low doses is selected because it is essential to preserve the optical properties in the visible spectrum). Note that for PP, degradation and cross-linking effects on γ-irradiation are equally probable [154].
µ ν~ , cm -1 700 600 500 400 300 200 100 0
54
50
45
40
35 3
ν ⋅10 , cm -1
Figure 47. Absorption spectra for PP films. The continuous line marks the initial sample; dotted line – after radiation by R = 28.8 kGr dose.
Figure 47 shows spectral dependencies of general losses index in the UV-spectrum, æ ν~ , for the initial PP films and those which have been γ-irradiated with a dose R = 28.8 kGr.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
83
Clearly, PP possesses an initial bright absorption band near frequency ν~ = 50⋅103 cm-1 (λ ≈ 200 nm), in which the tail spreads to ν~ = 27⋅103 cm-1 (λ ≈ 370 nm). In the visible spectrum, the samples remain transparent even after irradiation for given doses, thicknesses and spectrophotometer sensitivity. After γ-radiation in the range of low doses R ≤ 60 kGr, an increase of the refractive index in the main band near λ ≈ 200 nm is observed. Therewith, wavelengths of additional absorption maximums in spectra are almost coincident with wavelengths of extremes of the initial absorption in the main absorption band. Figure 48 shows fixed wavelengths for which ∆æ ν~ = f(R) graphs are plotted. They are: (1) and (3) – real maximums in the spectral absorption curve; (2) – the hidden maximum coincident with the bending point of the spectral absorption curve.
∆µ ν~ , cm -1 160
1
120 80
2 3
40 0
2
4
6
8
R, 3.6⋅103 Gr
Figure 48. Dependencies of additional absorption ∆æ in PP films on γ-irradiation dose R for three fixed wavelengths of absorption maximums on the dependence ∆æ = f(λ); 1 – 201 nm; 2 – 228 nm; 3 – 278 nm.
High loss intensity of æ ν~ = f(ν~ ) at frequency ν~ = 49.8⋅103 cm-1 (λmax ≈ 201 nm) in the main absorption band (Figure 47) is produced not only by absorption, but also by the contribution of scattering in crystalline PP film; and the complicated shape of the band with secondary absorption bands at λmax ≈ 228 nm and λmax ≈ 278 nm are, apparently, the result of the presence of additive chromophore groups [156, 157]. The main absorption band at λmax ≈ 201 nm consists of the superposition of an electron singlet-singlet absorption band long-wave rim and additive chromophore absorption band in spectral areas of ~60 – 200 nm and ~180 – 210 nm [158], respectively. This suggestion is confirmed by almost identical run of ∆æ ν~ = f(R, λ) dependencies for all three wavelengths of additional absorption maximums of PP (1), PP (2) and PP (3) in Figure 48. At amorphous and crystalline PP radiation, the latter possesses several-fold higher concentration of radicals at 20°C [159]. This is the reason for such high additional absorption,
84
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
∆æ ν~ = 110 – 190 cm–1, in the main absorption band with λmax ≈ 201 nm. On the other hand, the amount of chain breaks in PP at doses R = 25 – 50 kGr is 1.5 – 1.8 times higher in air, than in vacuum [160], i.e. the degrading influence of air oxygen is obvious, especially in the present case of after-radiation study of PP thin films, which also provides for ∆æ ν~ increase. The rate of accumulation of vinylidene groups during degradation of polymeric chains in isotactic PP is highest at low doses of γ-radiation [161]. However, variations in competitive processes involving their accumulation and degradation were apparently first observed in the present case, which is clearly seen in Figure 48. Let us discuss the problem of realization of the given radial profile of the refractive index in polymeric medium using the example of thin-film PP (Figure 49).
∆n 0.02
0.015 0.01
0.005
0
1
2
3
4
5
8 7 6 3 R, 3.6⋅10 Gr
Figure 49. Dependence of refractive index variation ∆n on γ-radiation dose R absorbed in PP film.
Occurrence of additional absorption in the far UV-spectrum in irradiated samples at the sacrifice of C-C bonds and production of vinylidene groups points out a possibility of a change in refractive index in the visible spectrum, where they are transparent, and with loss of the anomalous dispersion tail [162]. The dependence curve of ∆n = ϕ(R) at the wavelength λ = 632.8 nm is shown in Figure 50, where it may be observed that the after-radiation change of the refractive index rises with the γ-radiation dose, and at R > 14.4 kGr yields to the saturation branch, ∆nmax = 0.017. Shift of interference bands in a Mach–Zender interferometer at ∆n change of chlorinated PP films [134] and radiated PP films moves to the same side relative to the system of interference bands of the initial PP film. Hence, ∆n > 0, as may be expected due to the anomalous dispersion curve run, because ∆n > 0 at ∆æ > 0. It is common knowledge that, according to the empirical Gladstone–Dale formula and the theoretically proven Lorentz–Lorenz formula, the refractive index of optical material is proportional to its density. However, despite density decrease in the range of doses R < 6.0
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
85
MGr (for polyethylene, for example) a slight increase of dielectric permeation at frequencies from 10 kHz to 60 MHz is observed: ε = 2.27 for non-radiated and ε = 2.29 for polymer radiated by 640 kGr dose [163]. This indicates the predominant influence of the anomalous dispersion curve run on the refractive index change n = f(R) and the possibility of at least one more part of increment and saturation ∆n at high radiation doses of polymeric materials, isotactic PP, in particular, compared with doses indicated in this paragraph. The above-discussed experimental results provide for creating a refractive index profile of any shape in PP film by varying the exposure dose of γ-radiation on the surface sample [164]. This problem is discussed below.
4.12. Obtaining a Macrosurface GRIN-Medium by γ-Irradiation of Isotactic Polypropylene [164, 165] One of the variants for creating a given axial/radial gradient of the refractive index involves simultaneous treatment of the polymeric sample surface by γ-radiation, while a mask from a material absorbing radiation, for example, lead, is placed between the γ-radiation source and the sample. Therewith, the axial/radial distribution of the mask thickness is selected so that the real distribution of radiation by length/radius of the sample corresponds to the experimentally found doses required to achieve the given axial/radial change of the refractive index. The regime of γ-radiation to obtain the GRIN-medium is based on three graphs: 1. ∆n = f(R) – the experimentally found dependence of refractive index change, ∆n, on the dose absorbed of γ-radiation, R. This graph is shown in Figure 50. 2. K = ϕ(d) – the multiplicity dependence of γ-radiation intensity reduction, K, on lead mask thickness, d. Therewith, K = R0/R∆n, where R0 is the dose of γ-radiation affecting the lead mask; R∆n is the dose of γ-radiation passing through the lead mask. Such a graph for the quantum energy of 137Cs radiation of E = 0.662 MeV, obtained by averaging values E = 0.6 MeV and E = MeV from [164], is shown in Figure 51. 3. n = f(r) – the given RID, where r is the length/radius of the sample. Figure 52 shows the given (approximate) distribution of the refractive index difference, which must be realized in PP film of 30 mm radius. According to Figure 50, for the maximal change of the refractive index (∆n = 0.017), the PP film must be irradiated by the dose R = 14.4⋅103 Gr. For such part of the film, the lead mask thickness will be minimal, for example, d = 1 mm. As lead 1 mm thick reduces γradiation by K = 1.1 times (Figure 50), the maximal change of refractive index can be reached by increasing the γ-radiation dose affecting the lead mask up to: R0 = R(∆n = 0.017)⋅K(d = 1 mm) = 14.4⋅103⋅1.1 = 15.84⋅103 Gr. Hence, on the entire surface of the lead mask, the dose of γ-radiation is R0 = 15.84⋅103 Gr. On the part of the mask, where d = 1 mm, a part of the γ-radiation is absorbed, and R(∆n =
86
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
= 14.4⋅103 Gr passes through the mask and causes structural changes in the PP film, which will lead to increase of the refractive index by ∆n = 0.017. At the distance r = 3 mm from this part, ∆n = 0.0167 (Figure 51). To reach this value of ∆n, the radiation dose R(∆n = 3 0.0167) = 13.932⋅10 Gr is necessary according to Figure 50. That is why the γ-radiation dose affecting the mask surface must be decreased according to 0.017)
K=
R0 R( ∆n=0.0167 )
=
15.84 ⋅10 3 = 1.137 . 13.932 ⋅10 3
As shown in Figure 50, as K = 1.137, the lead layer thickness is d = 3 mm. Thickness of the lead mask for other points is calculated analogously. These results are summarized in Table 11. K 80
70 60 50 40 30 20 10 10
20
30 40 dPb, mm
Figure 50. Dependence of multiplicity of γ-radiation attenuation K on lead mask thickness d at radiation quantum energy E = 0.662 meV
∆n, ×10
-3
15
10
5
0
5 10 15 20 25 30 r, mm
Figure 51. Given distribution of different increments of refractive index ∆n by length/radius r of PP-film
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
87
The lead mask, for which dependence d = ψ(r) corresponds to the given Table 11 (instead of ∞, a thickness is conditionally chosen, for example, 40 mm), is placed between the source of γ-radiation and PP film (Figure 52). As the γ-radiation power is 2.5 Gr/min, to obtain R0 = 15.84⋅103 Gr radiation dose, the exposure time is 105.6 hours [165].
a
b
1
1
2
2
3
3
30 mm
60 mm
Figure 52. GRIN-element production with given axial (a) and radial (b) distribution of refractive index (principal features): a – front view; b – diametrical section; 1 – γ-radiation source; 2 – lead mask; 3 – PP-film
ϕ, ° 360
τ, h 100
337.5
90
300
80
262.5
70
225
60
187.5
50
150
40
112.5
30
75
20
37.5
10
0
0
40 r, mm
10
20 30
10
20 30 40 ρ, mm
Figure 53. Dependence of γ-radiation duration τ on radius r of PP-film (additional coordinates are explained in text)
88
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
In the technical solution described, the duration of γ-irradiation of the entire PP film surface is the same, and formation of a refractive index gradient is brought about by the specific gradient of the radiation dose over the length or radius of the sample. For completeness sake of the presentation, let us discuss another solution, when the radiation dose gradient is formed by the radiation duration gradient over the sample radius at equal specific radiation dose. Using data from Table 1, we determine that
τ=
R∆n (Gr) , 2.5 (Gr/min)
(86)
where τ is the duration of γ-radiation, during which the radial gradient of the radiation dose is provided along the sample radius, which is necessary for creating the given radial gradient of the refractive index change (Figure 51). The appropriate graph of dependence τ = f(r) is shown in Figure 53. In the general case, when the given RID, n = f(r), is described analytically, and the experimental dependence ∆n = f(R) = ∆nmax⋅(R/Rmax) is used in its linear part (∆nmax is the maximal value of ∆n on the linear part ∆n = f(R); Rmax is the maximal dose of absorbed γradiation corresponding to ∆nmax), the profile of the lead mask d = f(r) can be calculated using the expression n(R) = n0 + ∆nmax⋅eæd, where n0 is the initial (before radiation) value of the refractive index; æ = 0.087 mm–1 is the absorption coefficient for 137Cs γ-radiation in lead calculated according to table values [166] (e.g. Figure 50) with the help of expression for γ-radiation reduction: K = f(d) = eæd. Suggesting that ∆n ≈ 0, for example, at K = eæd = Rmax/R ≈ 100, we obtain æd ≈ ln100 and d ≈ 53 mm.
ρ
ϕ
(30 mm, 360°)
Figure 54. Lead mask window contour (polar coordinates: ρ - radius-vector; ϕ - angle between the radiusvector and the polar axis)
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
89
For practical realization of the dependence shown in Figure 54 a lead mask with a window, the contour of which can be represented by the function F(ρ, ϕ), where ρ is the radius-vector, and ϕ is the angle between the radius-vector and the polar axis. The value of ϕ corresponds to the determined values of radiation duration, and ρ = r (additional coordinates in Figure 53). Figure 54 presents function F(ρ, ϕ) in polar coordinates. A lead mask with diameter of, for example, 80 mm and with such window in the center (for the remainder with thickness of, for example, d ≥ 40 mm, at which the influence of penetrated radiation dose on properties of PP film is neglected under present conditions) is placed between the γ-ray source and PP film. The centers of the sample and the mask are superposed, around which the sample or the mask rotate for 96 hours (τmax = 96 h). The rotation frequency is chosen so that at incomplete rotations the lack of γ-radiation on some parts of the PP film can be neglected [165]. Great depth of γ-radiation penetration and continuous structural changes in the polymer thickness accompanied by GRIN-forming influence allow us to create RID profiles of any shape in optical polymeric materials by distributing the intensity or γ-radiation exposure on the surface, independent of the size and shape of the material. Table 11. Distance from one of the ends of processed part/length of the sample radius, r (mm) 0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30
γ-Radiation dose ∆n (see Figure 50) 0.017 0.0167 0.016 0.015 0.0139 0.0123 0.0107 0.0088 0.0065 0.0042 0
required for transfor-mation, R∆n (Gr) (see Figure 50) 14.4⋅103 13.932⋅103 10.8⋅103 9.252⋅103 7.92⋅103 5.4⋅103 4.068⋅103 2.88⋅103 1.543⋅103 0.936⋅103 0
Required multiplicity of γ-radiation subsidence, K = R0/R∆n 1.1 1.137 1.257 1.7 2.0 2.93 3.894 5.5 10.23 16.928 ∞
Lead mask thickness, d (mm) 1 2.5 3.5 5.5 8 11 15 18 23 28 ∞
The present method illustrated using the example of thin-film isotactic polypropylene can be easily extended to other types of polymers with regard to their sensitivity to γ-radiation and wider applicability to optical instrument making.
4.13. Method of Producing a Gradient Birefringent Element The general practice, world-wide, in gradient optics has been to focus attention only on the refractive index gradient. However, materials with gradients of other optical properties are of interest also, and in particular, with a gradient of birefringence (GB). Optical polymeric films with linear GB can be used in polarimeters used for various applications, including
90
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
equalizers for measuring birefringence value and studying character of birefringence distribution, etc. The preparation and description of a device for creating a given axial GB in polymeric films is discussed in this Section [167, 168]. It is suggested that such films should be called GB-elements or GB-materials [167, 168]. Supposedly, successful creation of GB-elements, investigation of properties and determination of fields of their application require broadening of the notion of ‘gradient optics’, subdividing it into two groups – GRIN-optics (optics of materials with refraction gradient) and GB-optics (optics of materials with birefringence gradient). It is common knowledge that deformation of polymers above the glass transition point is accompanied by uncoiling of flexible chains of macromolecules and orientation of their segments in the stretch direction. The sample thus obtains the symmetry of a one-axis crystal, the optical axis of which coincides with the stretching direction. Orientation of optically anisotropic molecular chains is the reason for the occurrence of birefringence in the polymer, which is a function of the relative stretch deformation of the sample: ∆n = n1 – n2 = γλ,
(87)
where ∆n is birefringence; n1 and n2 are refractive indices of singular and ordinary rays, respectively; γ is the optical deformation coefficient; λ is the relation of elongation to the initial sample length. At one-axis stretching of a rectangular-shaped polymer film, elongation along the width of the film is practically1 the same. That is why the orientation degree and, consequently, the value of birefringence in the direction perpendicular to the stretching are the same. If a trapezium-shaped (equilateral/non-equilateral) sample is stretched, i.e. when clips are disposed on not parallel lines, but at some chosen angle (Figure 55), then the relative elongation over height h will be different. It will increase from the longer side of the trapezium to the smaller one. This, according to equation (87), provides for GB growing in the same direction. Clearly, if at the long (free) edge of sample (2) (at the longer side of the trapezium) elongation is zero, and then the range of GB will be maximal. Described below is a device for obtaining a GB-element. It allows formation of an inhomogeneous mechanical field with the required degree of inhomogeneity, application of which to the sample forms the given axial gradient of elongation (the given gradient of orientation degree of molecular/permolecular structure) and, consequently, the given axial GB.
1
Strictly speaking, elongation along the sample surface is different even under conditions of homogeneous stretching, i.e. if a ‘neck’ does not occur. Elongation increases on both sides from the central part of the sample in the direction of their free (unfixed) edges, which shows as narrowing of the sample, which, in its turn, increases from fixed ends of the sample to its center in the stretch direction. Relative values of narrowing and their distribution in the stretch direction depend on relation of the ratio of rectangle side lengths and the deformation mode (rate, relative elongation, temperature, etc.). Nevertheless, this difference in values of elongation can be neglected, because it is insignificant for forming a practical GB.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
∆l
4
h
91
1
3 ∆l
2
Figure 55. Scheme of sample stretching without elongation gradient.
The principal features of the device are shown in Figure 56. Sample (8) (a film, a plate) trapezium-shaped, x high, is fixed by two clips (3) and (6) with non-parallel chamfered rims. To demonstrate the character of elongation distribution, a grid can be applied to sample (8). Clips (3) and (6) are rotated in opposite directions around parallel axes (4) and (5) by an electric motor with reducing gear (1) and gearwheels (2) and (7). As clips (3) and (6) rotate, their rims, in fact, are moving along the surfaces of round cones, generatrices of which are disposed at angles of ϕ1 and ϕ2 to the heights of the cones, coincident with rotation axes (4) and (5) in space. Clips (3) and (6) (clip rims) can be separately set at different angles to rotation axes (4) and (5). Therewith, different variants are available: ϕ1 ≥ ϕ2, or ϕ1 > 0 and ϕ2 = 0. Points of intersection of the rims of clips (3) and (6) with rotation axes (4) and (5) are static (immovable). The distance between them equals the length of the greater side of the trapezium – the maximal length of the initial sample (8) and remains constant during elongation: lmax = l(x = 0; 0° ≤ α ≤ 90°) = const, where α is the rotary angle of clips (3) and (6), whereas moving from the longer side towards the smaller one of the trapezium, i.e. from x = 0 to x = h, the absolute elongation increases. 1 2
7 lmax 8
x 1 2 3
6
3 ϕ1
h 4
ϕ2 5
Figure 56. Scheme of device for sample stretching with elongation gradient (see text for details)
92
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
As shown below, change of the sample appearance on elongation is governed by complicated rules. If the process of deformation is idealized and we assume conditionally that change of distances between rims of the clips (3) and (6) (Figure 57) accurately correspond to the appearance and overall size of the sample, the following suggestions can be made: • •
As clips (3) and (6) are rotated in the range 0° ≤ α ≤ 90°, both longitudinal and transverse elongation occur, the latter reducing the degree of anisotropy; It can be shown that for the case ϕ1 = ϕ2, length and width increments are ∆l =
(
2x⋅tgϕ(1 – cosα) and ∆h = h 1 + sin •
2
)
α ⋅ tg 2ϕ − 1 , respectively;
Conditions under which the inequality
∆l/2 > ∆h,
(88)
is fulfilled must be estimated, as the criterion for providing dominant orientation and, consequently, advisability of application of the method. It can be easily shown that inequality (88) is fulfilled, when inequality cosα < h/R is true (where R is the base radius of the imaginary cones, along the surface of which clips (3) and (6) are moved). Therefrom, it follows that if h > R, then inequality (88) is true at any values in the range [0°, 90°]. If h < R, inequality (88) is true at any values of α in the range [arccos (h/R), 90°]. Clearly, if α > 90°, ∆h decreases, and the sample must be narrowed, whereas ∆l increases continuously; •
Distribution of sample widths in the general form (ϕ1 ≥ ϕ2, or ϕ1 > 0 and ϕ2 = 0) is described by the relation:
l ( x;α ) =
[x sin α (tgϕ1 − tgϕ 2 )]2 + [l ( x;0) + x(1 − cosα )( tgϕ1 + tgϕ 2 )]2 ,
(89)
where l(x; α) is the sample length on the selected part (at distance x from the longer trapezium side) at clips rotation by angle α; l(x; 0) is the initial sample length on the same part. Relation (89) is deduced from the condition that the line connecting static points on rotation axes (4) and (5) (the longer side of the trapezium in Figure 57) is parallel to the direction in which the sample is stretched. To preserve this condition, clip (6) is designed with the possibility of being displaced by the trapezium height, as well as along the stretch direction; •
If ϕ1 = ϕ2, then as clips are rotated by 90° the length of sample (8) remains the same over the whole width x and equals the maximal initial length:
l(0 ≤ x ≤ h; α = 90°) = l(x = 0; 0° ≤ α ≤ 90°); •
The sample attains a rectangle shape; its width equals the length of the generatrix of the imaginary cones, on the surface of which clips (3) and (6) are moving.
Clip rims can be not only linear, but may possess a more complicated, almost arbitrary shape, when ϕ1 and ϕ2 are different for separate parts or are changing continuously. For such
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
93
cases, equation (89) can be reduced to another form taking into account that r = xtgϕ, where r is the clip rim distance from rotation axis in the stretch direction on the value of x chosen. In the device described, the maximal rotation of clips (3) and (6) is αmax = 90°. As α > 90°, sample (8) will be applied to the rims of clips (3) and (6). Therewith, constructions are suggested in which αmax = 180° [267]. Obtaining of a GB-element is illustrated below using the example of an isotropic amorphous PVS film, deformed in water at 20°C, at an angular rotation rate of 0.0785 s–1.
lmax = 72 mm x 1 2 3
ϕ1 = ϕ2 ≈ 46° ϕ2
ϕ1 45 mm
h = 33 mm h
h 10 mm
a
18 mm 1
0
1
h = 24 mm ∆h = 9 mm 3 mm
b Figure 57. Topographic image of deformation distribution in PVS film at stretching with elongation gradient (see text for details)
Figure 57 shows a typical scheme of the sample with applied grid before and after elongation (rotation angle of clips α = 90°). A complex connection between features of the superposed inhomogeneous mechanical field and topographical picture of deformation distribution is observed. The sample is elongated inhomogeneously. The area of dominant deformation, localized in the sample center in its upper part, gradually spreads down at the whole width of the sample. At maximal (theoretical) elongation of the lower rim of the sample, equal to 620%, longitudinal elongation is ∆h = 8.5 – 9 mm (~75% from theoretical
94
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
one). Gradient deformation provides for clearly expressed dominant narrowing of the sample in the upper part. The initial horizontal rim of the sample corresponding to x = 0 is elongated by ~10%. The shortest width of the sample is 24 mm. The sample material shifts downwards, and the non-curved horizontal line represents somewhat a ‘center of gravity’ of narrowing (dotted line in Figure 57, b), which in the case of parallel clips applied is disposed in the central zone of the sample and in the present case is strongly shifted to the side of the most elongated part. Figure 58 shows quantitative characteristics of a GB-element produced by the abovementioned method. ∆n d, µm ∆l, % 140
140
700
120
120
600
100
100
500
80
80
400
60
60
300
40
40
200
20
20
100
2 3
5
10
1
15 20
25 h, mm
Figure 58. Distribution of elongation (curve 1), thickness (curve 2) and birefringence (curve 3) by width (h) of GB-element from PVS.
I 1.0 0.8 0.6 0.4 0.2
5
10 15 20
25 h, mm
Figure 59. Dependence of relative light intensity passing through a PVS film with GB by width (h) of GBelement.
Curve 1 (Figure 58) displays distribution of longitudinal elongation by PVS width deformed in an inhomogeneous mechanical field. Countdowns are made for the most deformed part of the film, marked by digits 1-1 in Figure 57, b. It is clear from the Figure that
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
95
a jump of elongation exists in the sample, changed by a decimal degree. Under special conditions, the elongation jump can be increased by 2 – 3 decimal degrees [167, 168]. Curve 2 (Figure 58) shows dependence of the sample thickness on its width. Countdowns are taken by the zero line located in the middle of the sample (Figure 58, b). As would be expected, the sample thickness is reduced as longitudinal elongation increases. Finally, curve 3 (Figure 58) shows the distribution of birefringence over the width (on the zero line) of the same sample. Measurements were performed with the help of a Berek capacitor. The Figure shows that the sample possesses clearly displayed axial GB in complete concordance with the character of elongation (curve 1) and thickness (curve 2). Figure 59 shows dependence of the relative light intensity passing through the same sample from PVS with GB (wavelength λ = 0.63 µm, junction Nicols). Countdowns were made by the same zero line (Figure 58b). The Figure shows that light intensity passing through the PVS film is modulated depending on values of h coordinate with quite good correspondence to the known expression [169]: I = I0sin2[(π/λ)⋅∆n⋅d],
(90)
where I0 and I are light intensities after passing polarizer and analyzer, respectively. Deviation of the experimental curve by both Imax and Imin values, and the form of expression (90) should be, apparently, related to local inhomogeneities in the film occurring during its formation as a one-axis GB-element [170]. In the authors’ point of view, these very initial results already point out unambiguously that GB-elements, polymeric films with the given axial GB, can be prepared according to the method suggested. Let us just note that recently a device has been suggested that essentially allows creation of radial GB in a polymeric film [171].
REFERENCES [1] [2] [3] [4] [5] [6] [7]
[8] [9]
Asatiani L.P., Lekishvili N.G., Rubinstein G.M., and Chagulov V.S., Functional Classification of Optical Polymers, 1990, Izd. Tbilisi University, 84 p. (Rus) Lekishvili N.G., Rubinstein G.M., and Asatiani L.P., Polymer Waveguides: Production, Properties, Perspectives, 1994, Izd. Tbilisi University, 131 p. (Rus) Shepurev E.I., Optomechanical Industry, 1986, No. 1, p. 51. (Rus) Levy A.C. and Tylero C., In: Encyclopedia of Polymer Science and Engineering, Krosh-Witz Ed., Wiley: New York, 1987, vol. 7, p. 1. Kaino T., Senji Gakkaisi, 1986, vol. 42(4), 21 – 29. Smirnov B.R., Berezin M.P., and Rashupkina N.E., Polymer optical materials, Collection of articles, 1989, pp. 3 – 37, Chernogolovka. (Rus) Bukhbinder T.L., Kosyakov V.I., Tukhvatulin A.Sh., V All-Union Conference on Polymer Optical Materials. Plenary and Stand Materials, Leningrad June 11 – 14, 1991, pp. 9 – 10. (Rus) Born M., and Vonkf E., Optics Grounds, Moscow, Nauka, 1970, 355 p. (Rus) Luneberg R.R., The Mathematical Theory of Optics, Berkley, Los Angeles, Univ. Col. Press, 1964, p. 465.
96
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
[10] Zelikin E.G. and Petrova R.A., Lens Antennas, Moscow, Sov. Radio, 1974, 277 p. (Rus) [11] Koike Y., Hidaka N., and Ohtsuka Y., Appl. Opt., 1985, vol. 24(24), pp. 4321 – 4325. [12] Hamblen D.R., U.S. Patent No. 3,486,808 (1969). [13] Bronfin F.B., Il’in V.G. et al., ZhPS, 1973, vol. 18(3), p. 523. (Rus) [14] Kandelaki S.A., Doctoral Thesis in Chemistry, Leningrad, 1989. (Rus) [15] Barnoski M., Introduction into integral optics, Moscow, Mir, 1977, 368 p. (Rus) [16] Sodha M.S. and Ghatak A.K., Heterogeneous optical waveguides, Moscow, Mir, 1980. (Rus) [17] Mikaelyan A.L., Application of stratified medium for waves focusing, Doklady AN SSSR, 1951, vol. 81, pp. 569 – 571. (Rus) [18] Mikaelyan A.L., Optical waveguides with alternating refractive index, Optika i Spektroskopiya, 1978, vol. 44(2), pp. 370 – 378. (Rus) [19] Kapron F.P., Geometrical optics of parabolic index – gradient cylindrical Lenses, J. Opt. Soc. An., 1970, vol. 60, pp. 1433 – 1436. [20] Rawson E.G., McHerriot O.R., and Kenna J., Analysis of refractive index distribution in cylindrical gradient index glass rods (GRIN rods) used as image release, Appl. Opt., 1970, vol. 9, pp. 753 – 759. [21] Uchida T., Furasawa M., Kitawa I. et al., Optical characteristics of light, IEEE J. Quant. Electr., 1970, vol. QE-6(10), pp. 606 – 612. [22] Kawakami L. and Nishirawa I., An optical wave guide with the optimum distribution of refractive index with reference of waveform distribution, IEEE J. Trans. Microwave Theory Tech., 1968, vol. MTT-16, pp. 814 – 818. [23] Markuze A., Optical waveguides, Moscow, Mir, 1974, 576 p. (Rus) [24] Bukhbinder T.L., Kosyakov V.I. et al., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1991, vol. 32A(4), p. 245. (Rus) [25] Veinberg V.B. and Sattarov D.K., Waveguide optics, Leningrad, Mashinostroenie, 1977, 320 p. (Rus) [26] Galimov N.B., Kosyakov V.I., Tukhvatulin L.Sh. et al., Optika i Spektroscopiya, 1981, vol. 50(3), pp. 546 – 549. (Rus) [27] Il’in V.G., Karapetyan G.O., and Polyanskii, Zh. Prikl. Spektroskopii, 1978, vol. 28, pp. 121 – 130. (Rus) [28] Tukhvatulin L.T., Galimov N.B., and Kosyakov V.I., Zh. Teor. Fiz., 1980, vol. 50(3), pp. 1345 – 1347. (Rus) [29] Galimov N.B., Kosyakov V.I., Lishkov I.V., and Tukhvatulin A.Sh., Proceedings of scientific-technical conferences, Leningrad, September 25 – 26, 1984, pp. 51 – 54. (Rus) [30] Il’in V.G., Karapetyan G.O., Repilov N.V., Petrovskii G.T., and Polyanskii M.N., Optics of selfocs, Uspekhi Nauchnoi Fotografii, 1985, vol. 23, pp. 106 – 118. (Rus) [31] Patent No. 553,525 (USSR); BI 1977, No. 13; MKI 01.21/46. (Rus) [32] Marcuse D., In: Principles of optical fiber measurements, Academic Press, NY, 1981, pp. 141 – 156. [33] Ohtsuka Y., Appl. Phys. Lett., 1973, vol. 23, p. 247. [34] Kosyakov V.I. et al., Zh. Teor. Fiz., 1995, vol. 65(4), pp. 46 – 56. (Rus) [35] Moore D.T., Gradient-index optical review, Appl. Opt., 1980, vol. 19(7), pp. 1035 – 1038.
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
97
[36] Ohtsuka Y. and Terao Y., J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1981, vol. 26, p. 2907. [37] Ohtsuka Y. and Sugano T., Appl. Opt. 1983, vol. 22, p. 413. [38] Budovskaya L.D., Karapetyan G.O., Kosyakov V.I., and Tikhonova L.Yu., Zh. Prikl. Khrom., 1984, vol. 52(5), p. 1730. (Rus) [39] Galimov N.B., Kosyakov V.I. et al., Zh. Prikl. Khrom., 1981, vol. 54(7), pp. 1552 – 1558. (Rus) [40] Patent No. 722,128 (USSR), B.I. No. 31, 1980. (Rus) [41] Jui-Hsiang Lui and Hung-Tsoi Liu, Optics Letters, 1997, vol. 22(10), pp. 668 – 670. [42] Koike Y., Kimoto I., and Ohtsuka Y., Appl. Polym. Sci., 1982, vol. 27, pp. 3253 – 3264. [43] Koike Y. and Ohtsuka Y., Appl. Opt., 1983, vol. 22(3), pp. 418 – 432. [44] Application No. 61-47,909 (Japan). [45] Application No. 61-189,509 (Japan). [46] Koike Y., High-bandwidth graded-index polymer optical fiber, Polymer, 1991, vol. 32, pp. 1737 – 1745. [47] Yang S.Y., Ho B.C., Chen J.J., Tsang T.W., and Lee M.S., Proc. SPIE 2000, 1993, p. 396. [48] Lekishvili N.G., Asatiani L.P., Kandelaki S.A. et al., Soobshch. AN Gruzii, 1990, vol. 137(3), pp. 537 – 540. (Rus) [49] No B.C., Chen J.H., Chen W.C., and Chang Y.N., Polym J., 1995, vol. 27, p. 310. [50] Kandelaki S.A., Lezhava B.S., and Lekishvili N.G., Patent No. 1,561,496 (USSR). (Rus) [51] Application No. 61-35,363 (Japan). [52] Application No. 60-35,641 (Japan). [53] Koike Y. and Ohtsuka Y., Appl. Opt., 1986, vol. 25(19). [54] Lekishvili N., Nadareishvili L. et al., International Conference on Polymer Characterization, Abstracts, North Texas, Polychar-8, January 11 – 14, 2000, p. 60. [55] Nadareishvili L., Lekishvili N., Khanashvili L. et al., Russian Polymer News, 1999, vol. 4(3), pp. 4 – 12. [56] Karapetyan G.O. and Kosyakov V.I., Polymer Selfocs: Properties and Application of Optically Transparent Polymers, Ed. E.I. Shepureva, Reports Thesis on All-Union School of Young Scientists and Specialists on Optical Processing of Information, Minsk, Electronics Institute AS BSSR, 1982, pp. 177 – 178. (Rus) [57] Kosyakov V.I., Sadikov S.N., and Tukhvatulin A.Sh., On criterion of optical quality of gradient lenses, In: Thesis on Optical Processing of Information, Kiev, 1984, pp. 396 – 398. (Rus) [58] Budovskaya A.D., Karapetyan G.D. et al., Zh. Prikl. Khrom., 1984, vol. 57(8), pp. 1730 – 1732. (Rus) [59] Ohtsuka Y. et al., Appl. Phys. Lett., 1974, vol. 25(11), pp. 659 – 661. [60] Bukhbinder T.L., Dremina E.A., Kosyakov V.I., Moriganov A.N., and Tukhvatulin A.Sh., Zh. Teor. Fiz., 1997, No. 4, pp. 83 – 87. (Rus) [61] Nadareishvili L., Lekishvili N. et al., Russian Polymer News, 1997, vol. 2(3), pp. 35 – 43. [62] Application No. 61-189,509 (Japan). [63] Rubinstein G.M. and Chagulov V.S., Dipolephoresis Effect in Polymer Systems. Polymer Optical Materials, Collection of articles, Semenov’s Institute of Chemical Physics, Chernogolovka, 1989, pp. 112 – 113. (Rus)
98
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
[64] Lekishvili N.G., Nadareishvili L.I., and Rubinstein G.M., In: Fundamental Problems of Science of Polymers, Intern. Conf. 90th Anniversary of Acad. V.A. Kargin, Moscow, January, 1996, pp. 3 – 57. (Rus) [65] Oikawa M., Iga K., and Sanada T., Jap. J. Appl. Opt., 1981, vol. 20(1), pp. 1296 – 1298. [66] Fadeev E.A., Kosyakov V.I., and Tukhvatulin A.Sh., Zh. Teor. Fiz., 1998, vol. 68(10), pp. 70 – 73. (Rus) [67] Iga K. and Yamamoto U., Appl. Optics, 1977, vol. 16(7), pp. 1305 – 1310. [68] Baldyrev N.G., Galimov N.B., and Kosyakov V.I., Patent No. 713,159 (USSR). (Rus) [69] New in Fluorine Technology, Ed. N. Isikawa (Translation from Japanese), Moscow, Mir, 1984, p. 269. (Rus) [70] Lekishvili N.G., Kandelaki S.A. et al., Soobshch. AN Gruzii, 1995, vol. 158(1), pp. 234 – 237. (Georg.) [71] Ginzburg L.I., Krivchenko E.I. et al., Patent No. 1,115,457 (USSR). (Rus) [72] Ginzburg L.I. et al., SRW Report, No. 01,840,067,242 (1984 – 1986), Leningrad; 1988. (Rus) [73] Tikhonova L.Yu. et al., Patent No. 1,007,384 (USSR). (Rus) [74] Bukhbinder T.L. and Kosyakov V.I., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1986, vol. B28, p. 625. (Rus) [75] Lekishvili N.G., Nadareishvili L.I., Rubinstein G.M. et al., Patent No. 557 (Georgia), Bull. 1(10), 1997. [76] Budovskaya L.D., Tikhonova L.Yu., and Ivanova V.N., Synthesis of Gradient Interpenetrating Networks Based on Oligoetheracrylates, Polymer Optical Materials, Collection of Articles, Chernogolovka, 1989, pp. 101 – 103. (Rus) [77] Ohtsuka Y. and Koichi I., Appl. Opt., 1981, vol. 20(20), p. 3562. [78] Bartlett P.D. and Fate F.H., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 1953, vol. 75, p. 91. [79] Imai I., Matsumoto A., and Oiwa M., J. Polym. Sci., Polym. Chem. Ed., 1978, vol. 16(6). [80] Irushida K., Matsumoto A., and Oiwa M.I., J. Polym. Sci., Polym. Chem. Ed., 1978, vol. 16(5), 1081 – 1091. [81] Ushakova I.L., Denisov V.M., Lebedev M.F. et al., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1989, vol. A31(1), pp. 140 – 146. (Rus) [82] Berlin A.A., Korolev T.V., Kefeli T.Ya., and Severgin Yu.M., Acrylic Oligomers and Materials on Their Base, Moscow, Khimia, 1983, p. 232. (Rus) [83] Bol’bit N.M., Bol’shakova T.A. et al., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1983, vol. A25(9), pp. 1895 – 1810. (Rus) [84] Nikiforenko V.S., Alexeev N.N., and Zaitsev Yu.S., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1986, vol. A28(10), pp. 2061 – 2068. (Rus) [85] Schnatt E. and Busel K.I., J. Polym. Sci., Polym. Chem. Ed., 1980, vol. 18, p. 913. [86] Nikiforenko V.S., Alexeev N.N. et al., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1986, vol. B28(1), pp. 57 – 61. (Rus) [87] Berlin A.A., Korolev T.V., and Kefli T.Ya., Poly(ether acrylates), Moscow, Nauka, 1967, 332 p. (Rus) [88] Berlin A.A., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1978, vol. A20(3), p. 438. (Rus) [89] Rozhunkin V.P., Ozerovskii B.V., Khalmykov Yu.B., and Korolev T.Z., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1977, vol. A19(4), pp. 699 – 706. (Rus)
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
99
[90] Beriozin M.P. and Korolev G.V., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1980, vol. A22(8), pp. 1872 – 1878. (Rus) [91] Ipzhak V.I., Rozenberg B.A., and Enikolopyan N.S., Polymer Networks: Synthesis, Structure, Properties, Moscow, Nauka, 1979, p. 248. (Rus) [92] Irzhak V.I. and Rozenberg B.A., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1985, vol. A27(9). (Rus) [93] Korolev G.V., In: Reports of I All-Union Conference on Chemistry and Physicochemistry of Polymerization-Able Oligomers, Chernogolovka, OIChR AS USSR, 1977, vol. 1, p. 144. (Rus) [94] Smetanina I.K. and Emelianov D.N., In: Physicochemical Grounds of Polymer Synthesis and Processing, Gorky, Izd. Gork. Gos. Univ., 1980, pp. 56 – 58. (Rus) [95] Emelianov D.N., Smetanina I.K., and Vinogradova G.V., Rh. Acta, 1982, vol. 21(2), p. 280. [96] Rafikov S.R., Budtov V.P., and Monakov Yu.B., Introduction to Physical Chemistry of Polymer Solutions, Moscow, Nauka, 1978, 328 p. (Rus) [97] Bukhbinder T.L., Kosyakov V.I., and Tukhvatulin A.Sh., Zh. Teor. Fiz., 1990, vol. 60, pp. 631 – 634. (Rus) [98] Vasilevskaya V.V., Ryabina V.A., Starodubtsev S.G., and A.R. Khokhlov, Vysokomol. Soedin., 1989, vol. A31(4), p. 313. (Rus) [99] Kandelaki S.A., Lekishvili N.G., Mikadze A.Z., and Chugalov V.S., Izv. AN SSSR, Ser. Khim., 1992, vol. 18(2), pp. 124 – 131. (Rus) [100] Kandelaki S.A., Gogoberishvili K.M., Lekishvili N.G. et al., Soobsh. AN GSSR, 1989, vol. 134(3), pp. 553 – 556. (Rus) [101] Budovskaya L.D., Ivanova V.I., Kosyakov V.I. et al., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1988, vol. A30(7), pp. 1528 – 1533. (Rus) [102] Rubinstein G., Lekishvili N., Kandelaki S. et al., Intern. J. Polym. Mater., 1998, vol. 41, pp. 79 – 88. [103] Ysigure T., Nihei E., Koike Y. et al., IEEE Photonics Technol. Lett., 1995, vol. 7, p. 403. [104] Ho B.S., Chen W.C., Chen I.H., Chen I.I., and Tsang T.W., Polym. J., 1995, vol. 27, p. 310. [105] Chen W.C., Chen I.H., Yang S.Y., Ho B.C., and Tsang T.W., Photonic and Optoelectronic Polymers, Eds. Samson, A. Ienekhe, E. Kenneth, I. Wynne, Chapter 6, A.C.S. Washington DC, 1997. [106] Sheng Pin Wu, Eisuke Nihei, and Yasuhiro Koike, Appl. Opt., 1996, vol. 35(1), pp. 28 – 32. [107] Koike Y., In: Proc. ECOC’92, 1992, vol. 2, pp. 679 – 686. [108] Koike Y., Isigure T., and Nihei E., J. Lightwave Technology, 1995, vol. 13(7), pp. 1475 – 1489. [109] Chagulov V.S., Lekishvili N.G., Rubinstein G.M., and Sanadze N.S., Patent No. 1,671,032, 1991 (USSR). (Rus) [110] Sklyar I.E., Tukhvatulin A.Sh., Kosyakov V.I., and Bukhbinder T.L., Zh. Teor. Fiz., 1995, vol. 65(4), pp. 46 – 57. (Rus) [111] Patent No. 3,999,834 (USA). [112] Oikava M. and Iga K., Japan J., 1981, No. 1, pp. 251 – 264. [113] Oikava M. and Ig K., Appl. Opt., 1982, vol. 21(6), pp. 1052 – 1056. [114] Yamamoto T., Mishina Y., and Oda M., Patent No. 4,852,982, 1989 (USA).
100
N. G. Lekishvili, L. I. Nadareishvili and G. E. Zaikov
[115] Technical Inform. Selfoc Lens Array, NCC, American Inc., 1991. [116] Patent No. 3,617,005 (FRG). [117] Karapetyan G.O., Kosyakov V.I., and Moriganov A.N., Gradient planar structures, In: Report Thesis V All-Union Conference on Polymer Optical Materials, Leningrad, June 11 – 14, 1991, p. 35. (Rus) [118] Ohtsuka Y. and Koike Y., Appl. Opt., 1984, vol. 23, p. 1774. [119] Koike Y., Kimoto Y., and Ohtsuka Y., Appl. Opt., 1982, vol. 21, p. 1057. [120] Liu I.H. and Chu M.N., Angew. Makromol. Chem., 1989, vol. 174, p. 1. [121] Ohtsuka Y. and Nakamoto Y., Appl. Phys. Lett., 1976, vol. 29(9), p. 559. [122] Patent No. 4,521,351 (USA). [123] Ohtsuka Y. and Koike Y., Appl. Opt., 1985, vol. 24(24), pp. 2316 – 2320. [124] Nadareishvili L.I. and Lekishvili N.G., Polymeric media with gradient of optical properties. Controlled gradient formation, 2000, p. 102, Izd. “LEGA”, Tbilisi. (Rus) [125] Nadareishvili L.I., Chubabria M.Ya., Topuridze N.S. et al., Patent No. 1,521,801 (USSR). (Rus) [126] Smith D.W., Hoeglund A.B. et al., Polymer Prepr., 2000, vol. 41(2), pp. 1163 – 1164 (A.C.S. 24.07.2000). [127] Nadareishvili L.I., Akhobadze V.N., and Japaridze K.G., Patent No. 997 (484,333,032), 1997 (Georgia). (Georg.) [128] Nadareishvili L.I., Akhobadze V.N., and Japaridze K.G., Patent No. 996 (4,842,673), 1997 (Georgia). (Georg.) [129] Nadareishvili L.I., Topuridze N.S., Akhobadze V.N., and Japaridze K.G., Patent No.887 (4.887568), 1997 (Georgia). (Georg.) [130] Nadareishvili L.I., Akhobadze V.N., and Japaridze K.G., Patent No. 1012 (4,887,585), 1997 (Georgia). (Georg.) [131] Nadareishvili L.I., Topuridze N.S., Gvatua Sh. Sh., Japaridze K.G., Lekishvili H.G., and Asatiani L.P., Izv. AN Gruzii, Ser. Khim., 1999 (in press). (Georg.) [132] Nadareishvili L.I., Chubabria M.Ya., Topuridze N.S. et al., Izv. AN Gruzii, Ser. Khim., 1991, vol. 17(2), p. 133. (Rus) [133] Nadareishvili L.I., Lekishvili N.G. et al., Patent No. P2361 (Georgia), 2000. (Georg.) [134] Nadareishvili L.I., Gvatua Sh.Sh., Topuridze N.S., and Japaridze K.G., Opticheskii Zhurnal, 1997, vol. 64(12), p. 69. (Rus) [135] Nadareishvili L.I. et al., Patent No. P1963 (Georgia), 1999. (Georg.) [136] Afanasiev V.A., Optical Measurements, Moscow, Vysshaya Shkola, 1981, p. 107. (Rus) [137] Klimova V.A., Basic Micromethods for Analyzing Organic Compounds, Moscow, Khimia, 1967, p. 101. (Rus) [138] Popov N.I., Calculation and Projecting of Cam Mechanisms, Moscow, 1965. (Rus) [139] Nikolaev A.F., Synthetic Materials and Plastics on Their Base, Moscow-Leningrad, Khimia, 1966, p. 186. (Rus) [140] Industrial Chlororganic Products, Reference book, Moscow, Khimia, 1978, p. 588. (Rus) [141] Van Crevelen D.V., Properties and Chemical Structure of Polymers (Transl. from Holland), Moscow, Khimia, 1976, p. 199. (Rus) [142] Lekishvili N.G., Nadareishvili L.I., Kandelaki S.A., and Asatiani L.P., Polymeric media with refractive index gradient, 1999, Izd. “Intellect”, p. 13. (Rus)
Polymeric Media with the Gradient of the Optical Properties
101
[143] Lu H., Van Z., and Shiyu H., 1988, vol. 17, p. 714. [144] Concise Chemical Encyclopedia, 1967, vol. 5, p. 687. (Rus) [145] Bronstein I.N. and Semendyaev K.A., Mathematical Reference Book, Moscow, 1981, p. 150. (Rus) [146] Nadareishvili L.I., Nakaidze D.M., and Japaridze K.G., Izv. AN Gruzii, Ser. Khim., 1995, No. 4, p. 771. (Georg.) [147] Nadareishvili L.I., Skhirtladze A.A., and Japaridze K.G., Patent No. 203 (Georgian). (Georg.) [148] Nadareishvili L.I., Skhirtladze A.A., and Japaridze K.G., Patent No. 1,808,733 (USSR). (Rus) [149] Lekishvili N., Nadareishvili L., Kandelaki S. et al., Proceedings of the GAS, Ser. Chem., 1999, vol. 25(1-2), pp. 138 – 150. [150] Nadareishvili L.I., Skhirtladze I.A., Gvatua Sh.Sh., and Japaridze K.G., Patent No. 1350AI (Georgia), 1998. (Rus) [151] Nadareishvili L.I. et al., Izv. AN Gruzii, Ser. Khim., 2000, vol. 26(3-4), p. 157. (Rus) [152] Nadareishvili L.I., Topuridze N.S. et al., Patent No. 2261 (Georgia), 2000. (Rus) [153] Nadareishvili L., Lekishvili N., Japaridze K. et al., Russian Polymer News (in press), 2001. [154] Charlesby A., Nuclear Radiation and Polymers, Moscow, Inostr. Lit., 1962. (Rus) [155] Bovey F., The Effect of Ionizing Radiation on Natural and Synthetic Polymers, Moscow, Inostr. Lit., 1959. (Rus) [156] Ranby B., Rabec Ya., Photodegradation, Photooxidation, Photostabilization of Polymers, Moscow, Mir, 1978, 230 p. (Rus) [157] Tsuji K. and Seiki T., J. Polym. Sci., 1970, vol. B8(11), pp. 817 – 819. [158] Partridze R.H., J. Chem. Phys., 1968, vol. 49(8), pp. 3656 – 3668. [159] Malinchuk V.I., Pshezetskii S.Ya., Kotov A.G., Tupikov V.I., and Tsivenko V.I., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1963, vol. 5(1), pp. 71 – 74. (Rus) [160] Makhlis F.A., Radiation Physics and Chemistry of Polymers, 1970. (Rus) [161] Veselovskii R.A., Leshchenko S.S., and Karpov V.L., Vysokomol. Soedin., 1968, vol. 10(4), pp. 760 – 769. (Rus) [162] Speranskaya T.A. and Tarutina L.I., Optical properties of polymers, 1976, Leningrad, Khimia. (Rus) [163] Nikitina T.S., Zhuravskaya E.V., and Kuzminskii L.S., The Effect of Ionizing Radiation on Polymers, Moscow, Roskhimizdat, 1959. (Rus) [164] Nadareishvili L.I., Gogebashvili M.E. et al., Application No. 6630 (Georgia), 1998. (Georg.) [165] Nadareishvili L.I., Gvatua Sh. Sh., Lekishvili N.G., and Japaridze K.G., Method of Selfoc Preparation by γ-Irradiating Isotactic Polypropylene, Georgian Engineering News, 1999, pp. 83 – 86. [166] Tables of Physical Values, Reference book, Moscow, Atomizdat, 1976, 964 p. (Rus) [167] Nadareishvili L.I. et al., Application (Georgia), 2001. [168] Nadareishvili L.I. et al., Application (Georgia), 2001. [169] Il’in R.S., Fedotov G.I., and Fedin L.A., Laboratory Optical Devices, Moscow, Mashinostroenie, 1966, pp. 202 – 227. (Rus) [170] Nadareishvili L., Japaridze K. et al., Georgian Engineering News (in press), 2001. [171] Nadareishvili L.I. and Khoshtariya P.P., Patent No. 717,616 (USSR). (Rus)
In: Polymer Reactivity ISBN 1-60021-263-8 Editors: G. E. Zaikov and B. A. Howell, pp. 103-115 © 2006 Nova Science Publishers, Inc.
Chapter 2
FUNDAMENTAL REGULARITIES OF THERMAL OXIDATION OF HEAT-RESISTANT HETEROCHAIN POLYMERS E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva1* and G. E. Zaikov2 Polyplastic Co., 14A, General Dorokhov st., Moscow 119530, Russia 1 N.N.Semenov Institute of Chemical Physics, 4, Kosygin st., Moscow 119991, Russia 2 N.M.Emanuel Institute of Biochemical Physics, 4, Kosygin st., Moscow 119991, Russia
The papers [1-4] considered phenomenological features of degradation process developing in polysulfones (PSF) and polyesterimide (PEI), poly(alkaneimide) (PAI) and polyphthalamides (PPA) in the presence of oxygen at processing temperature (300 - 400°C) and solid-phase oxidation (150 - 250°C). These processes define loss of operation properties by polymers and materials derived from them. Before passing to description of attempts to decelerate degradation processes, let us generalize the above-mentioned experimental material and present the mechanism of thermal oxidation of the studied polymers. The primary important similarity in the degradation behavior of all studied TP is their absorption of oxygen already at relatively low temperatures (150°C). At temperatures, when oxygen absorption kinetics (200°C or higher) becomes possible to trace, polymers display identical kinetic type of oxidation with no respect to the test temperature (refer to [1 - 4]), the process proceeds in two stages, subsequently obeying order one and zero laws. The existing data from literature [5] show that kinetics of the solid-phase oxidation includes one more stage, associated with self-exited acceleration of the process. Such complex kinetic type of oxidation was not previously observed. Of special interest is the initial stage of aging, during which oxygen absorption and CO2 release follow the order one kinetic law. At this very stage physicomechanical characteristics of heat-resistant polymers decrease significantly. Quick development and completion of this stage nudges possible anomalies in the structure of polymers or additives. If the first stage of aging of PEI and PSF, PAI and PPA, liquid-crystal copolyesters (LCP) etc. is the artifact, and
104
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
it may be removed by some technical steps, Kinetics of the process leads to quite widespread type of thermal oxidation, when primarily, slowly developing thermal oxidation with the induction period transits to the self-excited acceleration mode. This indicates the radical-chain branched oxidation process. As discussed in [1 - 5], the induction period of oxidation may be observed at PSF thermal oxidation in the system with oxygen deficiency. However, correspondence of the first oxidation stage to inadequacy of the polymer structure is impossible, because it argues the experimental data. Let us discuss these contradictions in more detail. In the first stage, up to 10% of carbon is removed with carbon oxides. Relation of this percent to the content of anomalous structures in the polymer indicates that different structure degree is too high, much higher than the sensitivity of spectral methods. Meanwhile, preliminary analyses of studied thermoresistant polymeric materials (TP) showed their correspondence to postulated formulae, i.e. PSF corresponds to bisphenol A-derived polysulfone structure, PAI corresponds to fatty-aromatic polyimide derived from PPA and dodecamethylene diamine, etc. Further on, we will discuss in detail the effect of organic and inorganic additives on thermal stability of TP, which will show their negative impact on thermal transformation rate. Anyway, this effect is drastically lower than displays of the first TP aging stage. Moreover, differences in kinetics of different stages of aging are not accompanied by the change in composition of products released at every stage. No typical products of thermal transformations of solvents, used in syntheses of corresponded polymers, possess oligomers, which release should be expected under acceptance of regular structure deterioration by anomalous, thermally labile groups. Meanwhile, at high-temperature thermal oxidation a broad selection of heavy oligomeric products: all homologues in PAI and a selection of structure fragments in PSF, PEI, PPA, LCP, etc. According to [6], defect zones are the first which degrade and initiate degradation of the main polymer structure. The most practical statement is that the first stage of TP aging is associated with the features of their chemical structure. This kinetic type of oxidation is displayed by aromatic polyimide (PI), polyphenylene quinoxaline (PPQ) and copolyimidophenyl quinoxalines [5]. The second similarity in TP degradation behavior is formation of the similar type of the degradation product (with respect to structure of the elementary unit). More precisely, it is pyromellite diimide (PDI) in PAI and PI:
and it is terephthalic acid (TPA) amide for PPA
Fundamental Regularities of Thermal Oxidation …
105
It is also 2,2’-1,4-phenylene-bis-(3-phenylpyrazine) (PPP) for PPQ
Formation of these products as a result of thermal oxidation of appropriate polymers was not previously known in the literature, but gave new information on understanding of the TP aging mechanism. To separate such fragments, one should make an “impact” and “tear out” these structures from the macromolecule. The relation of PDI and CO2 outputs (in moles) at PI thermal oxidation (300°C) is close to 1/24, and for PAI (200°C) – 1/10, i.e. diamine components must be oxidized completely to CO2. If the primary oxygen attack is random, as oxidation develops a definite tendency to activation is observed. The random O2 attack on the next amine residue would cause formation of several oligomeric structures with appropriate end groups. However, besides the mentioned fragments, no other oligomeric products were detected in the “cold ring” or at PPA and PAI aging directly on the surface of mold samples. Thus, TPA amid formation in PPA, PDI in PAI and PI, PPP in PPQ and copolyimidophenyl quinoxaline (CPIPQ), and the absence of such oligomeric compounds among these products testifies that oxidation of a single amine residue activates oxidation of the nearest amine residues, remaining the oxidizing component unchanged and releasing it under the same conditions, in the form of individual compound (PDI, PPP, TPA-amide). Invulnerability of the oxidation component to O2 attack and, under these conditions, stability of the imide cycle, preserved even in degradation products, eliminates the thermohydrolytic mechanism, discussed in the literature. Thus, during TP aging oxidation is aimed at amine residues of macromolecules; oxygen is added to these structures and oxidizes them: PDI, PPP and amide-TPA are exclusive products of thermal oxidation. Therefore, the role of oxygen may not be reduced to oxidation of thermal degradation products. According to the data obtained [7], the absence of nitrogen-containing products and nitrogen content (%) increase in oxidized residue are typical of PI oxidation. This was explained [8, 9] by easiness of nitrogen introduction into combination reactions; therefore, it remains in the polymer residue until deep degradation stages. It has been found [5] that PDI
106
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
release at PI oxidation in the solid phase under relatively “soft” conditions”, when the film transformation degree is below 5%. Intermolecular crosslinking is general for all TP which leads to full loss of polymer solubility in the solvents, where they dissolved before thermal oxidation. In the absence of oxygen crosslinking at the solid-phase oxidation, i.e. at relatively low temperatures, either proceeds or proceeds at much lower rate. During high-temperature oxidation oxygen also activates crosslinking and branching processes. Apparently, this is one more proof for the activating effect of oxygen at some place of macromolecule and then along the backbone. This is the only way to explain formation of products (TPA amide, PDI, PPP) in appropriate polymers. In this case, common hypothesis about molecular complex formation between a macromolecule and oxygen is actual. Hydrogen release was also associated with the crosslinking process. Hydrogen is the main product of purely thermal degradation of PI and other thermoresistant engineering plastics (TIP) above 500°C. In the presence of oxygen, H2 release at high temperature is abruptly decreased. Hydrogen is not released at oxidation of aliphatic hydrocarbon polymers, below 300°C, i.e. in the well-studied process reliably described by the radical-chain scheme. Hydrogen was identified among thermal oxidation products, such TP, as PEI, PAI, PI and PPQ under soft conditions, and O2 initiates its formation. Apparently, O2 interaction with the aromatic structure activates C-H-bond break, which then enter intermolecular interaction. Analysis of external manifestations of PI, PPQ, PAI, PPA, PEI, PSF, etc. thermal aging induces a conclusion about general regularities: -
kinetic features of the oxidation process are similar; with respect to structure of the elementary unit, the selection of thermal oxidation products is also similar; tendencies to branching and crosslinking of macrochains are the same.
Thus, thermal oxidation mechanisms of studied polymers are similar. Differences in thermal behavior are of the quantitative type. Let us dwell on consideration of thermal oxidation at high processing temperature. Let us start with O2 molecule. The strength of O-O bond in this molecule is 493 kJ/mol. TP degradation form products containing a half of O2 molecule: CO, H2O, quinones, i.e. O2 molecules dissociate during oxidation. In the theory of oxidation processes, including combustion theory, oxygen dissociation is possible due to energy reasons only via peroxide or peroxy radical formation. Scientists from Institute of Chemical Physics, Russian Academy of Sciences discovered the effect of isotropic enrichment by oxygen in hydrocarbon and hydrocarbon polymer oxidation [10, 11]. The theory explains this phenomenon by spin effects at the second degree recombination of peroxy radicals and macroradicals. To some extent, the phenomenon may be considered as an indirect proof of peroxide radical participation in thermal oxidation. Another reaction may compete with usual oxidation initiation in rigid structures: • RH + O2 = R• + HO 2
Fundamental Regularities of Thermal Oxidation …
107
which requires energy consumption equal the bond strength (ER-H = 196 kJ/mol, for aromatic about 251 – 263 kJ/mol). Figure 79 shows the fluorescence spectrum for PI film at light excitation, λ = 320 nm. The long-wave boundary of the spectrum characterizes energy required for electron transfer from external, occupied orbital to lower, loosening orbital. For PI film, the long-wave boundary of fluorescence falls at 520 – 530 nm, corresponded to energy of 217 – 226 kJ/mol. Thus, macromolecule transition to the active state via electron excited one is by 40 kJ/mol more energetically profitable than by usual (for aliphatic polymers) reaction between P-H-bond and molecular oxygen. Electron excitation contributions were discussed in works by Belyakov et al., and light flashes were observed at thermal oxidation [12].
Figure 1. Fluorescence spectrum of PI films (a) without increments and (b) with 2 wt.% BT-5
Oxygen is added as biradical to the aromatic system in the triplet state. The internal peroxide or endoperoxide is formed. The possibility to initiate this act was assessed using quantum-chemical calculations, and reactivity of imide, quinoxaline and phthalamide structure were compared [5, 13]. Quantum-chemical calculation techniques were found efficient for studying reactivity of organic compounds in various reactions [14 - 16]. Molecular diagrams for many models of heat resistant polymers were calculated [14]. Quantum parameters of the system are low dependent on doubling or tripling of the molecule which imitates the elementary unit. Therefore these parameters may also be related to the macromolecule. A correlation between energy of higher occupied molecular orbital (EHOMO) in the system and its thermal oxidation stability was found. The authors used the Waters idea in which oxidation as the electron migration process is considered [17]. We based upon a suggestion on endoperoxide formation in thermal oxidation of heat resistant polymers. The possibility of cyclic peroxide formation is also shown [18 - 20]. Moreover, endoperoxide transformation to quinoid structures may also be imagined. Occurrence of these structures during PI, PEI, PSF etc. oxidation were proved experimentally. As forming on aromatic ring, endoperoxides change the primary π-system of the compound which corresponds to localization of two π-electrons of the ring. The appropriate change in πelectron energy may be considered as the localization energy (απ) [15]. The value of απ was
108
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
selected as the measure of endoperoxide formation probability. The higher απ (its absolute value) is, the lower is the gain of O2 and the higher is polymer resistance to oxidation. Molecules of model compounds under consideration, PI and PPQ [5], contain 28 atoms each. Calculation of so large molecules requires taking a tremendous number of integrals. The reactivity study of a single multi-atom molecule using non-empirical calculation of the electron structure demands many hours of computer time. Usually, these tasks are solved using semi-empirical methods, in which some groups of electrons are neglected. In this case, some integrals of electron energy become zero or are reduced to different integrals; some Hamiltonian terms are neglected or expressed through some empirical parameters.
Figure 2. Charges on atoms and bond degrees in model compounds of polyimides
Fundamental Regularities of Thermal Oxidation …
109
In the current case, the Parizer-Parr-Pople (PPP method) semi-empiric, quantumchemical method was used [21]. This method considers only π-electrons in the calculation. It allows quick obtaining of reliable π-electron energy values, required for απ determination. Besides απ, both molecular orbital energies (EHOMO values are shown in Table 1), changes on atoms and bond orders (Figure 2) are calculated. The standard series of parameters selected for reactivity calculation is used [22]. The values of απ were determined as the difference 0 between π-electron energies of the initial compound ( Eπ ) and endoperoxide (Eπ). The value of Eπ represents a sum of π-electron energies of endoperoxide fragments and energies of two π-electrons excluded from the conjugation system due to O2 addition. The bond length between phenyl cycles equals 1.5 Å. It is suggested that all compounds have flat structure. The variation of geometrical parameters indicated independence of calculation results on bond length changes below 0.05 Å and valence angles in the range of ±5°. Therefore, average bond lengths and average valence angles were used in the calculation (Figure 3).
Figure 3. Bond lengths and valence angles in 2-phenylquinoxaline (1) and N-phenylphthalimide (2)
To compare resistance to oxidation of different macrochain fragments in polymers, απ values were calculated for endoperoxide formation on aromatic rings of acid and amine components of PI model compounds and ketone and amine fragments of PPQ and PPA model compounds. Table 2 shows that for all compounds απ values are lower for the amine component that testifies about its higher attackable by oxygen compared with ketone and acid components. These results correlate with already discussed experimental data on PI and PPQ thermal oxidation [5].
110
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
The value of may be suggested as a criterion of both polymers and macromolecule fragments heat resistance. Table 1. Higher occupied molecular orbital energy and π-electron localization energy in model compounds
Acid component
EHOMO, eV
απ, eV Amine component
-12.04
-
6.95
-10.99
6.33
6.96
-12.68
-
7.48
N
-11.20
6.18
7.33
O
O
C C
C C N
-11.16
6.32
7.34
O
O
-10.71
5.75
-
-10.47
5.76
6.42
-10.31
5.76
6.68
Structure
O C C
N
H
O O C C
N
O
H N
H
N
O
O
C C
C C
O
O
O
O
C C
C C
O
O
N
N
N
H
N N N
N
N
N
N
Fundamental Regularities of Thermal Oxidation …
111
Table 2. The amount of absorbed oxygen and release carbon oxides as a result of PI and PPQ model compound oxidation (T = 300°C, t = 100 h, P(O2) = 26.7 kPa)
Compound N-phenylphthalimide N,N’-diphenylpyromellitimide 6,6’-oxy-bis-(2,3diphenylquinoxaline) 2,2’-(1,4-phenylene)-bis-(3phenylquinoxaline) 2,3’-diphenylquinoxaline
Absorbed oxygen, mol/base-mol 0.034 0.045 1.71
Oxidation products, mol/base-mol CO2 CO 0.02 0.002 0.03 0.003 0.91 0.09
0.28
0.16
0.014
0.27
0.19
0.021
As previously shown by Kosobutsky [14], there is the opposite dependence of polyheteroarylene thermal stability in the presence of oxygen and their EHOMO. The correlation is also confirmed by calculation results obtained by the authors of the current monograph (Table 1) [5] and assessment of PI and PPQ models of thermal stability. However, the use of απ both indicates the formal substance disposition in the thermal stability sequence among other substances and binds thermal stability with particular elementary act which is O2 linking with endoperoxide formation. In the quantum-chemical study the probability of molecule ionization at TP decomposition, for example, by proton detachment, was also taken into account. In the frames of semi-empirical FNDO/2 method (Full Neglecting of Differential Overlapping) the energy of H+ detachment (Table 3) was calculated by the difference between total electron energy of the molecule and energy of its negative ion (H+ detachment). These observations do not correlate in any way with the experimental data on thermal stability. This, apparently, removes the problem of ionic state participation in the degradation process. Quantum-chemical calculations based on the endoperoxide model confirm experimental conclusions: -
oxidation is developed in the amine component of imide and quinoxaline structure; oxygen addition causes changes in electron densities on structure skeleton atoms e.g. activation or conjugation; electron effects conform to higher reactivity of the imide (or amide) or quinoxaline structure in oxidation processes. Thus, there is no direct proof (positive analysis) of endoperoxide formation in PI, PPQ, PSF, PEI and PPA, but positive calculation prerequisite and indirect experiments proofs are observed.
Endoperoxide decomposition causes occurrence of oxygen-containing structures in the phenylene structure. Deeper oxidation causes the ring break, CO2 and CO release, where carbon from the aromatic ring “combusts” (e.g. oxidizes). It is suggested that the acts of endoperoxide electron excitation, formation and dissociation form the initial oxidation stage. As degradation proceeds, paramagnetic properties of PI, PSF, PAI, etc. increase. This may be associated with accumulation of hexadienyl oxidized structures, radicals and biradicals in the macrostructure, and increase of
112
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
the system conjugation degree. The excitation level is reduced, and the system becomes selfcatalytic. This is the third stage of the process, described for PI and PPQ [5]. For oxygen absorption and gas product release, γ values are almost the same. This indicates that oxygen absorption and structure degradation elementary acts become maximum close in time. Apparently, the stage of endoperoxide formation disappears, whereas O2 is added to numerous elementary centers in the conjugated structure and C atom is immediately detached from already linear residue of the aromatic structure. This stage of the aging process is of just theoretical interest, because the loss of operation properties of the material is ended at the second thermal oxidation stage. At this stage, for the gross, one aromatic ring in the elementary unit decomposes (as deduced from carbon oxide yield). Table 3. The energy of H+ detachment from aromatic rings in model compounds Energy of H+ detachment, eV ∆E1 ∆E2 25.773 -
Structure H2N
N H2
H2N
N H2
O N
25.836
24.805
-
24.391
-
24.969
25.447
-
25.564
-
25.698
-
C C O
H3 C
N
O
O
C
C
C
C
O
O
O C C
N
N
CH3
CH3
O H3 C
CH3 N
N
H3 C
CH3
H3 C N H3 C N (CH 3 )2 N (CH 3 )2
Concerning the above experimental material (refer to [1 - 5]), Schemes of PI, PAI, PPQ, PEI and PSF thermal oxidation schemes may be shown as follows:
Fundamental Regularities of Thermal Oxidation …
113
The problem is: what is the way of TP thermal stabilization in the context of their degradation? The classical inhibition of oxidation processes is based on kinetic chain break and deactivation of branching, intermediate products. In the case of TP, chain type of the process is not obvious. The chain break in chemical increments suggests the inertness of residual inhibitor radical. These radicals are active above 200°C. Therefore, classical antioxidants are ineffective at high temperatures. It is accepted that TP must be thermally stabilized towards the structure transition into electron-excited state (quenching these states), prevention of charge transfer complex formation (interaction or complex formation between O2 and amine residues in macromolecules for PI, PPQ, PEI, etc.) to reduce their reactivity, for example, down to acid or ketone residues and, finally, free radical deactivation.
REFERENCES [1]
Neiman M.B., Aging and Stabilization of Polymers, Moscow, Nauka, 1964, 332 p. (Rus)
114 [2] [3] [4] [5]
[6]
[7] [8] [9] [10]
[11]
[12]
[13] [14]
[15] [16] [17] [18]
[19] [20] [21]
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov Kuz’minsky A.S., Oxidation of Caoutchoucs and Rubbers, Moscow, Goschimizdat, 1957, 319 p. (Rus) Grassi N., Chemistry of Polymer Degradation Processes, Moscow, Inostrannaya Literatura, 1959, 252 p. (Rus) Zaikov G.E. and Moiseev V.V., Chemical Resistance of Polymers in Aggressive Media, Moscow, Khimia, 1979, 216 p. (Rus) Vdovina A.L., ‘Thermal Transformations and Stabilization of Polypyromellitimide, Polyphenylquinoxaline and Copolyimidophenyl-quinoxalines’, Candidate Dissertation Thesis, Moscow, 1988. (Rus) Pravednikov A.N., ‘Thermal degradation of polymers with rings in the cycle’, A Report at the 5th Polymeric School Devoted to Methods of Synthesis and Study of HeatResistant Polymers, Gomel’, 1972, 12 p. (Rus) Annenkova N.G., Kovarskaya B.N., and Gur’yanova V.V., ‘High-temperature oxidation of polyimides’, Vysokomol. Soed., 1975, vol. A17(1), pp. 134 - 142. (Rus) Gaudiana R.A. and Conley R.T., ‘Weak-link versus active carbon degradation of aromatic heterocyclic systems’, J. Polym. Sci., 1969, vol. 7(11), pp. 793 – 801. Gaudiana R.A. and Conley R.T., ‘Weak-link versus active carbon degradation of aromatic heterocyclic systems’, J. Macromol. Sci., 1970, vol. 4(2), pp. 441 – 480. Buchachenko A.L., Galimov E.M., Ershov V.V., Nikiforov G.A., and Pershin A.D., ‘Isotope enrichment, induced by magnetic interactionsin chemical reactions’, Doklady AN SSSR, 1976, vol. 228(2), pp. 379 – 381. (Rus) Buchachenko A.L., Yasina L.L., Makhov S.V., and Galimov E.M., ‘Magnetic isotope effect and 17O enrichment at polypropylene oxidation’, Doklady AN SSSR, 1981, vol. 260(5), pp. 1143 – 1145. (Rus) Belikov V.K., Belyakova I.V., Kozlova M.V., Okunev P.A., and Tarakanov O.G., ‘The effect of chemical structure of polyheteroarylenes on resistance to thermal oxidation’, Vysokomol. Soed., 1973, vol. A15(12), pp. 2635 – 2642. (Rus) Kalugina E.V., ‘Thermal transformations and stabilization of some heat-resistant heterochain polymers’, Doctoral Dissertation Thesis, Moscow, 2003. (Rus) Kosobutsky V.A., ‘Electron composition and some physical and chemical properties of aromatic polyamides and polyheteroarylenes’, Candidate Dissertation Thesis, Rostovna-Donu, 1973. (Rus) Bazilevsky M.B., The Method of Molecular Orbitals and Reactivity of Organic Molecules, Moscow, Khimia, 1969, 303 p. (Rus) Straightwiser E., The Theory of Molecular Orbitals, Moscow, Mir, 1965, 435 p. (Rus) Waters W., Oxidation Mechanism of Organic Compounds, Moscow, Mir, 1966, 175 p. (Rus) White E.N. and Harding M.J.C., ‘Chemiluminescence in liquid sols. – Chemiluminescence of laphine and its derives’, J. Am. Chem. Soc., 1964, vol. 86, pp. 5686 – 5698. Kurtz D.W. and Shetcher H., ‘Photooxidation of tryphenyl oxazole’, J. Chem. Soc. Ser. D. Chem. Commun., 1966, No. 7, pp. 689 – 698. Matsuuta T. and Saito J., ‘Photosensitized oxidation of hydroxylated purines’, Tetrahedron Letters, 1968, vol. 29, pp. 3273 – 3281. Parr R.G., Quantum Theory of Molecular Electronic Structure A. Lecture – note and reprint volume, N.Y., W.A. Benjamin Inc. Publ., 1964, p. 510.
Fundamental Regularities of Thermal Oxidation …
115
[22] Kuthan J., Danihel J., and Skala V., ‘Quantum chemical study of dissociation of metaand para-substituted benzoic acids in π-electron approximation’, Collect Czechosl. Chem. Commun., 1978, vol. 43(2), pp. 447 – 462.
In: Polymer Reactivity ISBN 1-60021-263-8 Editors: G. E. Zaikov and B. A. Howell, pp. 117-171 © 2006 Nova Science Publishers, Inc.
Chapter 3
PRACTICAL STABILIZATION OF HEAT RESISTANT POLYMERS E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva1 and G. E. Zaikov2 Polyplastic Co., 14A, General Dorokhov st., Moscow 119530, Russia 1 N.N.Semenov Institute of Chemical Physics, 4, Kosygin st., Moscow 119991, Russia 2 N.M.Emanuel Institute of Biochemical Physics, 4, Kosygin st., Moscow 119991, Russia
The papers [1-11] discuss the features of thermal and thermal oxidation transformations in highly heat resistant polymers. Polymers selected for the experiment were had “ideal” structure which contained no increments. Many experiments were performed on “model” samples, which were compounds with lower molecular mass, or oligomers. Such searching approach is required for understanding the degradation mechanism. However, under real conditions, there is no opportunity to obtain a polymer of either “ideal” structure or the above-mentioned purity. Therefore, to solve the applied tasks, the most important of which is stabilization, the investigators must base upon studies of degradation mechanisms, developed on appropriate models, and take into account “negative” contributions characterizing real polymeric structures. These are all reasons why this Chapter thoroughly discusses the effect of structure defects, end groups, molecular-mass distribution (MMD), organic and inorganic additives on thermal stability of polymers.
LABILE STRUCTURES AND ADDITIVES Polysulfones (PSF) To make the regularities not only characteristics of the studied sample, but the regularities of a class of substances, one should understand how strong are effects of labile
118
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
groups in the polymer structure, processing and other additives on the degradation process. To put it differently, selection of the polymer sample is of the principal meaning. Similar to other compounds, polymer may be “real” or “ideal” product. In the first case, structure and composition of the polymer, usually produced by an industrial or semi-industrial way, represents a compromise of production costs and competitive ability of the product by its quality. Most frequently, “ideal” or similar product is obtained in laboratory in vitro, using pure monomers and optimal technique. The latter should provide the absence of labile structures. However, quantity of “ideal” samples is limited, so it is not enough for performing pilot studies of aging and stabilization, in which the effect of these factors on macroscopic properties of polymers are considered. Therefore, a standard must be selected among industrial PSF. It should approach the “ideal” polysulfone in purity and the presence of labile structures. We mean not full absence of the mentioned defect, but their minimal content that causes no significant effect on thermal behavior. Data from the literature [1] and industrial laboratory tests [2 - 4] indicate specific danger from the side of hydroxyl end groups in the PSF molecule for thermal oxidation stability. Let us make an assessment, how high is the effect of end OH-group on thermal oxidation stability of rather long macromolecule, for example, the one containing 30 – 50 units, each containing two side methyl groups the fragments of isopropylidene bridge from bisphenol A residues) tender to oxidation at high temperatures. The model is the following. Oxygen molecule attacks the macromolecule according to common autooxidation initiation mechanism [5 - 8]: RH + O → R + HO2. Aromatic rings are eliminated from the consideration. Since experimental data [9] show relative stability of the aromatic structure, as compared with aliphatic one, even at thermal oxidation of alkyl-aromatic polymers, at the initial stage aromatic rings are not involved in the process. Thermal oxidation by chlorophenylene end groups (end Cl-groups) may not be initiated by this reaction. Initiation by dehydrochlorination is also improbable due to high strengths of Carom-Cl and Carom-H bonds - 400 and 450 kJ/mol, respectively [10]. The activation energy, Ea, of the above-mentioned elementary act of initiation is approximately equal to its heat [5], because −1 1 Q = E a + Ea,
1 −1 where E a and E a correspond to direct and reverse radical recombination, respectively.
According to [5], they approach zero. Generally speaking, one of the features of the solidphase oxidation is high Ea value of macroradical recombination. For instance, Ea of the second degree recombination of peroxy radicals reaches 50 – 100 kJ/mol [11, pp. 64, 69]. However, it is also known that PO recombination mechanism is superimposed with migration of free valences. Intensification of molecular movements due to plasticization or transition to amorphous systems causes an abrupt decrease of Ea to 10 – 20 kJ/mol [11, p. 64]. These values are typical of transfers in liquids [6, p. 81]. In the present case, oxidation proceeds in the polymer melt, i.e. molecular movements are unfrozen. Moreover, macroradical
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
119
recombination with a small HO2 radical but not recombination of two peroxy macroradicals [7, p. 85] is considered. Therefore, the assumption that −1 E a ~Q
seems to be true, i.e. Ea ~ Q. Similar approach was used in other investigations [11, p. 126]. Initiation is endothermic reaction. The heat of it equals the difference between breaking and forming bond strengths. This means that Q = DR-H⋅221 kJ/mol [11, p. 125]. As shown [10], CH2-H bond strength in linear alkanes equals 400 – 410 kJ/mol. The same bond strength in C6H5CH3 is decreased to 356 kJ/mol (nearly by 50 kJ/mol) [10] due to delocalization energy in benzene radical. Methylene group in isopropylidene bridge of PSF is located in β-position in relation to aromatic rings. The π-system impact is weakly transferred by σ-bond chain and attenuates on β- and γ-atoms [13]. This is illustrated well by the change of chemical shifts of methyl protons in ESR spectra of alkylbenzenes, from toluene to ndecanebenzene: 2.32, 1.25, 0.89, and then the same (0.89) ppm. The latter result is similar to chemical shift of methyl protons in hexane, which is 0.99 ppm [14]. As another example we may accept the rate constant of H atom detachment from methyl group in toluene by phenyl radical. It is by an order of magnitude higher than for tertbutylbenzene [15]. Therefore, let us assume that delocalization energy of alkyl radical with free valence on β-C atom is 4 times lower than for benzene radical. Moreover, additional bond strength decrease by 4 – 8 kJ/mol in alkyl chain branchings [10] should also be taken into account. Finally, the strength of CH2-H bond in the PSF isopropylidene bridge may equal 380 – 390 kJ/mol. The bond O-H is phenol is as strong as 351.5 kJ/mol, whereas D(O-H) strength in 2,6-ditert butylphenols is about 320 – 340 kJ/mol [15]. The strength of O-H-bond in unshielded and shielded para-substituted phenols is defined by electron effects of substitutes. This is shown up by the empirical D(O-H) dependence on the Hammett constant: for example, for shielded phenols D(O-H) = 343.5 – 23. As accepted for the end hydroxyl group in PSF, σpara = 0.197 [83]. Then applying the mentioned dependence, we get: D(O-H) = 351.5 + 23×(-0.197) = 347 kJ/mol. Since we consider competing, unitypical reactions of the same macromolecule, preexponential terms of the rate constants may be equal. As a consequence, the competition between elementary initiation acts at the end hydroxyl groups or side CH3-groups is ruled by the relation of activation energies of competing reactions, which according to
120
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
Ea = Q and Q = D(P-H) – 221 equal 126 and 159 – 169 kJ/mol, respectively. As already shown empirically [2], end hydroxyl groups negatively affect the quality of PSF. Therefore, an excess chlorine-containing monomer is used in the synthesis. This allows a decrease of end OH-group amount in PSF to 0.02 – 0.15% at the mean molecular mass of 8,000 – 15,000. Let us estimate the ratio of side CH3- and end OH-group concentrations under the most “unfavorable” conditions for OH-groups: Mn = 15,000 and OH-group concentration 0.02 wt.%. It may be simply calculated that
[CH 3 ] ~ 400. [OH] At 350°C the ratio of competing initiation act rates equals:
vCH3 v OH
=
OH
CH 3
[CH 3 ] exp E a − E a = RT K 0OH [OH ] CH 3
K0
⋅
[CH 3 ] = 0.1 ÷ 0.7. [OH]
Figure 1. TGA (1, 2) and DTA (1’, 2’) curves for blocked (1, 1’) and unblocked (2, 2’) PSF in air, the heating rate of 6°/min
Therefore, the calculation performed with assumptions of maximum favorable conditions for the main CH3-group main structure in initiation of high-temperature oxidation of PSF already indicates much higher activity of end hydroxyl groups in initiation of PSF thermal oxidation. Hydroxyl end groups are labile elements of the PSF structure. Therefore, they should be blocked, for example, by treating PSF with methyl chloride which substitutes OHgroups by OCH3-groups. Other monofunctional agents (PhCH2Cl, C2H5I, alkylarylchlorosylanes) are also used for blocking PSF. Unfortunately, blocking may not fully
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
121
deactivate OH-groups. In marketable PSF their concentration reduced by an order of magnitude, but still remains at a level of 0.005 - 0.007 wt.%. Nevertheless, according to TGA the degradation initiation temperature of blocked PSF in air is by 20 - 25°C higher than for unblocked one (Figure 1). The run of two-stage TGA curves of the above-mentioned samples is similar. Effective activation energies of degradation (dynamic TGA data) equal 90 and (96 ± 20) kJ/mol. DTA curves are of similar type, except for the area corresponded to the initial degradation stage. For blocked and unblocked PSF, the one-stage degradation type in the absence of O2 with the degradation start at 300 - 400°C, coke residue formation up to 30 wt.% at 700°C with equal Ea = (192 ± 20) kJ/mol is also similar, whereas in this case blocked PSF is higher heat resistant, though not so high as in thermal oxidation. As improving the quality of Russian marketable PSF, thermal behavior of blocked and unblocked PSF was compared by analysis of both TGA data and other, higher informative degradation signs, for example, changes in molecular mass characteristics. In all cases, it was observed that at similar type of degradation, thermal oxidation damage kinetics effective kinetic constants of unblocked PSF samples degradation are greater (at similar values of effective activation energies). It is desirable to suggest that PSF thermal oxidation mechanism is independent of the end group origin. Labile hydroxyl end groups define higher degradation initiation rate, and the main process is then developed in the macrochain according to the same scheme. Similar situation is observed for PVC dehydrochlorination, when chain process initiation is defined by the type and content of allyl, ketoallyl and other labile end groups [16]. The change of the degradation mechanism proceeding via depolymerization with respect to the end group origin [17] is known for polyacetals only. PSF is not the depolymerizing polymer. Therefore, preservation of thermal oxidative degradation mechanism in samples with end groups of different heat resistance is quite clear. Though the above calculation indicates 0.02 wt.% content of labile hydroxyl groups as the boundary of the initiation mechanism change (equality of initiation rates at end OH- and side CH3-groups), one should take into account the approximate type of calculations , i.e. interlocking of hydroxyl groups up to their content of 0.005 – 0.007 wt.%, apparently, provides for preferable initiation of random thermal oxidation. As a matter of principle, substitution of OH-groups by CH3Ogroups is not unambiguous because of reduced C-H-bond strength in methoxy group as a result end ArOCH2-radical delocalization. This radical is formed after the bond break at thermal oxidation initiation. However, any empirical assessments do not conform to experimentally determined independence of thermal oxidation of PSF with end OCH3-groups on molecular mass of the polymer in the range Mw = 17,000 – 70,000 [94], i.e. thermal oxidation of interlocked PSF is initiated statistically on side CH3-groups. Instability of hydroxyl end groups is typical of all polysulfone types. Polysulfone thermal stability regularly decreases with OH-group content increase in samples with similar molecular masses. For instance, the initial degradation temperatures for PES derived from 4,4’-dioxydiphenyl with reduced viscosity equal 0.65 at hydroxyl end group content of 0.018 and 0.9 wt.% equal 425 and 330, respectively. Another example is shown by copolymer polysulfone (PSB-230 trademark, derived from bisphenol A and a mixture of 4,4’dichlorophenylsulfone and bis-(4-chlorophenylsulfonyl)bisulfone), in which end OH-group content decrease from 0.24 – 0.28 to 0.15 wt.% at close values of reduced viscosity (0.4 – 0.5) three times reduces the gross degradation rate at 400°C. Similar to PSF, the effective activation energy of mass loss in PES at dynamic heating is low-dependent on the
122
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
concentration of hydroxyl end groups. The determining factor for this parameter is the presence of the absence of isopropylidene e.g. aliphatic group in the aromatic structure of polysulfones. Polysulfones derived from bisphenol A (PSF and PSB-230) degrade both in the absence and in the presence of O2 with Ea equal 90 - 100 and 190 – 205 ± 20 kJ/mol, respectively. Degradation of fully aromatic PES under the same conditions is characterized by higher Ea values: by 20 and 40 kJ/mol, respectively. Experiments with injection of additives [18] show that inorganic and organic increments cause some negative effect on PSF thermal stability. The analysis of various PSF samples performed by chemical techniques, GLC, ion chromatography, atom-absorption and emission spectroscopy indicated the presence of various admixtures in PSF (Table 1). Admixtures of bisphenol A (DPP), 4,4’-dichlorodiphenylsulfone (DCDPS), dimethylsulfoxide (DMSO) and chlorobenzene (CB) represent residues of monomers and reaction mixtures in PSF polycondensation and extraction technology. Oxychlorodiphenylsulfone (OCDPS) and, apparently, dioxydiphenylsulfone (DODPS) traces represent DCDPS hydrolysis products at the polycondensation stage as a result of deviations from stoichiometric relation between 2alkaline and DPP and at water presence in the reaction mixture [18]. Anions Cl- and SO 4 form secondary products of both DCDPS hydrolysis and decomposition. Among inorganic additives, Na+ and K+ additives only may be associated with participation of alkaline agents during PSF production. The rest metals (cations) occur in the polymer from raw materials and the equipment. With respect to end OH-groups and additive content, PSF thermal stability represents a multifactor reflex surface with direct and interrelated contributions of every admixture. Analysis of data from Table 1 shows that the sample No. 1 possessing optimal thermal oxidative stability is similar to other PSF samples by concentration of organic admixtures (metals and anions). A significant difference (an order of magnitude or higher) is observed for hydroxyl end group content (blocked and unblocked samples) and organic admixtures, as well. From positions of quality, the maximum permissible content of admixtures, determined in experiments with polymer filling and further regression analysis [18], equals: DPP – 0.005 wt.%, OCDPS – 0.1 wt. %, DCDPS – 3 wt.%, NaCl – 0.005 wt.%, CB is practically inert. Experiments with DMSO additives show that concentration MFI and extrudate light transmittance dependence (320°C) is characterized by a plateau up to DMSO content of 0.05 wt.%. Further increase of DMSO content leads to MFI increase and yellowing. Degradation changes become catastrophic at DMSO content above 0.5 wt.%. As DPP content is that mentioned in Table 1, concentration of its active hydroxyl groups is, approximately, two orders of magnitude lower than at macromolecule ends. Extension of the above reactivity assessment at oxidation initiation on end OH- and side CH3-groups in PSF macromolecule leads to the border concentration of end hydroxyl groups defined by the equality of rates on the mentioned structural elements: 0.002 – 0.01 wt.%. Tests show full identity in thermal behavior of interlocked PSF samples (No. 1 and 6) with equal content of additives (Table 1). They differ by concentration of hydroxyl end groups only: 0.006 - 0.009 wt.%. These samples possess the elemental composition (C – 73.7%; H – 5.4%; S – 7.5%; O – 13.4%) approaching
Table 1. PSF sample characteristics Sample 1 2 3 4 5 6
Organic admixture content, wt.% DPP DHDPS OHDPS DMSO <10-3 <10-3 <10-3 0.005 0.08 0.063 0.15 0.06 0.06 0.049 0.06 <10-3 0.05 0.03 0.02 0.009 0.05 0.058 0.03 0.008 <10-3 <10-3 <10-3 0.003
Metal cations (10-5) wt.% Sample
Mg
Fe
Cu
Ba
CB 0.017 0.012 0.01 0.1 0.01 <10-3
Metal admixture content, cations (10-5) wt.% Na K Ca Cr Ni 260 5 57 <10-1 3 900 4 50 2 4 600 100 10 <10-1 <10-1 400 10 80 4 4 240 4 50 <10-1 -
Anions (10-3), wt.% Cl2− SO
End OHgroups, wt.%
MMD (103) Mw
Mn
Mz
O2 absorp. *
6 7 100 100 7 6
8 8 8 10 40 7
6 <10-1 <10-1 <10-1 24 <10-1
0.5 <10-1 14 1 0.23 <10-1
2.2 440 180 5.6 35 2.1
0.006 0.096 0.087 0.063 0.067 0.0061
38.3 38.5 36.8 40.7 39.2 41.0
14.7 12.6 15.1 16.2 13.8 17.0
60.8 80.4 64.9 69.1 68.1 73.1
0.35 1.1 0.85 0.45 0.42 0.32
3.1 2.7 1.7 3.1 3.0 2.0
Mn 2 2 2 15 2.4 2
Thermal stability
4
1 2 3 4 5 6
Zn 4 2 1 3 5 3
Notes: * O2 absorption (1 h, at 350°C), mol/base-mol; ** Light transmittance at 425 nm, %; *** MFI10 min/MFI20 min at 320°C.
Light transmit. ** 89 27.1 38 78 80 92
MFI ratio *** 1.0 0.88 0.9 0.98 1.0 0.99
124
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
theoretical one (C – 73.3%; H – 4.98%; S – 7.34%; O - 14.48%, respectively). 1H and 13C NMR-spectroscopy data fully confirm the main polymer structure. These samples also display the highest thermal stability.
Polyesterimide (PEI) Polyesterimide (applied to marketable products) is produced by dianhydride A and mphenylene diamine nucleophilic substitution with further thermal cyclization. The first stage of the synthesis is obtaining polyesteramido acids (PEAA), performed in methylene chloride mixed with water, and the second stage is performed in melt. To increase thermal stability, macromolecular structure of PEI is controlled in two ways: end group interlocking by phthalic anhydride (PA) and varying cyclization conditions. Comparison data on PEI with different admixture content, MMD, end groups and, correspondingly, thermal stability are shown in Table 2. All studied samples displayed actual 100% cyclization degree (IR-spectroscopy data). Introduction of phthalic anhydride (PA) as the interlocking agent to PEI synthesis causes a decrease of carboxylic end group content, and the polymer obtains narrower MMD (the polydispersion index decreases). Decreasing optical density, mass losses and insoluble fraction content in the polymer after thermal processing testify about thermal stability increase in interlocked PEI. Another way of thermal stability increase is polymer synthesis with equimolar ratio of monomers (PEI 4, Table 2). Thermal stability of PEI is significantly deteriorated by the use of unpurified monomers. PEI obtained using unpurified dianhydride A possesses poorer molecular-mass characteristics even if all production conditions are maintained (PEI 7, Table 2). Mass-spectrometry analysis of dianhydride A allowed detection of three admixtures: bisphenol A, nitrophthalic anhydride (initial monomers for dianhydride A synthesis), and phthalic anhydride. Moreover, PEI thermal stability may be definitely reduced by solvent traces (PEI 8): increased Cl- ion content at insufficient washing off of methylene chloride. As known, inorganic admixtures (metal ions) may occur in the polymer both from raw materials (monomers and solvents) and directly from the equipment. In case of iron increments, PEI thermal stability is decreased by its 10-fold exceeding of the permissible level only (PEI 3 compared to PEI 2). Thus, analysis of data shown in Table 2 allows the following conclusions about PEI thermal stability. The ways of thermal stability increase must include the following stages: purification from organic and inorganic admixtures, end group interlocking and stabilization. Problems of stabilization will be discussed in detail in the following section.
Polyphthalamides (PPA) To understand reasons for thermal stability change, a complex study of pilot PPA-1 and PPA-2 series was performed. The studies were performed in several directions: 1. The study of humidity effect on PPA thermal stability. 2. The study of molecular-mass characteristic effect.
Table 2. PEI sample characteristics
Sample 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
Elemental composition, % С N H 74.78 4.58 4.11 75.27 4.46 4.27
Sample 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8.
End groups, % COOH NH2 0.2 0.15 0.1 0.24 0.36
0.07 0.03 0.06 0.07 0.2
0.35
0.32
Metal additives (10-3), wt.% Co 2.5 0.57 0.54
Ni 1.3 0.38 0.5
Ca 1.3 26 12
Fe 12 4.4 40
Thermal stability Mass loss at 500°C during 30 min in air, % 25.5 17.0 27.0 12.0 22.0 39.0 44.0
MMD (10-3) Mg 8.7 2.0 3.0
Na 5.0 5.2 5.0
K 1.5 1.4 1.2
Cr 0.3 6.4 6.0
Mw 43.1 48.3 42.6 46.3 52.6 88.8 28.3 107
Mn 18.8 20.1 18.2 20.9 20.3 22.2 13.4 30.5
Note: * Optical density at 425 nm, after thermal processing at 320°C during 20 min in air; ** Gel fraction after thermal processing at 320°C during 20 min in air, %; *** Anion content (Cl-), ×10-3 wt.%.
Mw/Mn 2.28 2.03 2.0 1.76 2.59 4.0 2.1 3.51
Gel fraction **
Anion content ***
0 0 42 41 49
2.0 2.5 3.0 500
Optical density* 0.17 0.14 0.32 0.37 0.45
Mz 86.2 97.9 85.4 81.6 111.5 225.5 59.8 256.0
Table 3. PPA sample characteristics Sample PPA-1 (theor.) 1. 2. PPA-2 (theor.) 3. 4.
Elemental composition C N H
Metal additives (10-2), wt.% Cu Ni Ca Fe
Al
Na
K
MMD×103 Mw Mn
Mz
Mw/Mn
Thermal stability Mass MFI ratio** loss*
67.85
11.48
7.56
66.54 67.25 68.29
12.23 11.86 11.38
13.33 13.03 7.32
0.013 200
0.01 2/0
4.0 40
13 1.2
1.4 14
22 2000
230 220
39.7 21.6
6.7 4.5
196 75
5.9 4.8
390 350
8/0 16/0
67.25 68.02
12.42 11.94
7.42 7.46
13 200
10 200
4 40
1.3 13
1.4 14
30 480
640 600
25.5 25.0
8.0 8.4
43.1 42.0
3.2 2.9
380 350
6/0 10/0
Note: * Temperature of 10% mass loss according to dynamic TGA (5°/min rate) in air, % ** MFI10 min/MFI20 min at 310°C.
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
127
3. The study of low-molecular organic admixture effect (residues of non-reacted monomers). 4. The study of inorganic admixture effect (metals occurring in the polymer with raw materials and from the equipment). The results are generalized in Table 3. Table 4 shows data on humidity effect on thermal stability of the material. Table 4. PPA mass losses during 15 min at 300, 325 and 345°C
Sample PPA-1 with 0.005% residual humidity PPA-1 with 2.5% humidity PPA-2 with 0.005% residual humidity PPA-2 with 2.5% humidity
Mass loss(wt.%) during 15 min at temperature 300°C 325°C 345°C Ar Air Ar Air Ar 0.8 1.8 0.9 2.0 1.0
Air 2.2
2.1
3.0
2.2
3.5
2.6
5.2
0.98
1.2
1.15
1.45
1.2
1.90
2.97
3.03
3.0
3.5
3.15
5.82
The data show effect of, at least, two factors on the degradation behavior of PPA: sorptive humidity and air oxygen additives. Obviously, humidity may be easily removed by drying. The oxidation effect was discussed in detail in [1 - 6]. Changes in molecular-mass characteristics of PPA-1 and PPA-2 during material processing were studied. The MMD change during thermal processing to the gel formation stage was described before. Analysis of the data obtained indicates actively proceeding branchiong and crosslinking reactions at PPA-1 and PPA-2 processing temperatures. Note that any thermal treatment leads to a significant increase of all molecular mass moments and MMD chromatogram shift to the high-molecular zone. In polymer with low molecular mass, gel-fraction is accumulated at much lower rate – the gel amount in two studied samples (with Mw = 39,700 and 21,600, respectively) differ by an order of magnitude. However, their tendency to decrease light transmittance with increase of gel-fraction content is the same. The change of all MMD moments in PPA-1 (Mw = 21,600) proceeds at lower rate than in PPA-2 (Mw = 39,700). Though thermal processing induction of the polymeric matrix crosslinking is obvious, proceeding of purely degradation processes may not be eliminated. The composition and content of organic admixtures in PPA-1 and PPA-2 were studied with the help of thermal mass-spectrometry analysis by heating PPA-1 and PPA-2 samples placed directly to ionization chamber (“at direct injection” method of analysis). Easily volatile products with molecular ions, m/z = 77, 92, 127, released from the samples below 100°C, were identified according to MS database:
128
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G .E. Zaikov m/z = 77 ÷ 78 – benzene; m/z = 91 ÷ 92 – phenol; m/z = 127 – cyclic aliphatic amine of (СН2)5-СН-NH-CH2-CH3 type. As heated above 100°C, heavier products are released from the samples:
Detected compounds represent low-molecular fragments of PPA-1 and PPA-2 structure. Of importance is that these oligomers possess both carboxylic and amine and carboxylic end groups. The experimental results reliably demonstrate imperfection of PPA-1 and PPA-2 chemical structures. According to elemental analysis, empirical and experimental data on H/C/N/O contents are significantly different. Compared with the empirical value, increased nitrogen content in the element composition of PPA testifies about amine end group dominance over carboxylic ones. The effect of end (amine or carboxylic) groups on thermal stability of polyamides and polyimides was studied in detail [16, 19, 20]. In case of amine end groups dominance all studied polymers displayed a decrease of thermal stability and viscosity increase of the melt, and approach of processing and degradation initiation temperatures. In the present case, analogous effect of amine end group concentration on PPA thermal stability is also observed. The content of amine end groups was assessed using nonaqueous pH titration technique. Four PPA-1 samples with equal MMD were tested. The content of end amino groups varied from 0.166 to 0.198 wt.%, which is quite significant. The atomic emission spectroscopy method was used in the study of inorganic admixture composition in PPA-1 and PPA-2, usually occurring from the equipment. The effect of metal increments on thermal stability was assessed by isothermal TGA, MFI and melt thermal stability data. Besides serial samples, model PPA species were studied, to which additional increments of inorganic salts of corresponded metal were injected. The data are generalized in Table 3. The studies show different effects of metal increments on thermal oxidation stability of PPA. Alkaline metals (Ca, Na, K) and Al do not actually affect thermal stability in the studied range, whereas Fe causes an adverse effect, And Cu and Ni in concentrations below 10-2 – 101 wt.% significantly increase thermal stability of PPA. The analogous situation was already observed for aliphatic polyamides.
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
129
Summing up the performed studies, one may conclude about imperfection of PPA-1 and PPA-2 chemical structures and about insufficient purity of the polymers. This causes an adverse effect on thermal stability of the polymers at processing and, consequently, on operation properties of the articles.
Poly(Alkane Imide) (PAI) Dynamic heating of PAI in pure argon flow and in air causes the mass loss (for samples, preliminarily heated up in vacuum at 120°C for the purpose of removing solvent traces and drying) at 400 and 320°C, respectively (Figure 2). At the initial stage, thermal and thermal oxidative degradation of PAI (mass losses are below 20%) fit kinetic order one law with the rate constants equal, respectively:
232 ± 20 ; RT
KAr = 3.9×1015exp −
202 ± 20 K O2 = 1.8×1014exp − . RT
Figure 2. TGA of powder-like (1, 1’), granular (2, 2’) and molded (article) (3, 3’) PAI samples at the heating rate 5°/min in air (1 – 3) and argon flow (1’ – 3’)
Though corresponded recalculation shows absence of mass losses in PAI under processing conditions (temperature and treatment duration), degradation is observed even visually by polymer yellowing: resulting the two-stage processing (powder – granules – article) the yellowing index of PAI is increased from 24.9 to 42.3 (measured on threecoordination colorimeter Pulsar) Melt Flow Index (MFI) is also sensitive to thermal load. It
130
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G .E. Zaikov
gradually increases at two stages of PAI processing (granules, mold sample) from 0.6 to 2.5 g/10 min. TGA data (Figure 2) indicate a decrease of PAI thermal stability at transition from granules to the article. Table 5. PAI sample characteristics Sample
Composition C N
H
Metal additives (10-2), wt.% Ca Fe Mg Na
K
MMD (10-3) Mn Mw
Mz
71 73 73 71.9 69.0
6.9 7.2 7.3 7.1 7.5
1.6 1.6 0.76 1.0 0.51
0.33 0.29 0.24 0.18 0.24
105 126 87 158 120
201 241 167 409 150
Mw/M n
1. 2. 3 4. 5.
Sample
1. 2. 3 4. 5.
ηspec 0.98 1.42 1.13 1.31 0.92
7.36 7.6 7.4 7.5 7.1
Gel fraction, wt.% 5.0 10.0 6.0 5.5 5.1
0.67 3.6 0.14 0.39 0.06
2.4 2.6 1.2 1.5 0.8
0.8 0.9 0.35 0.18 0.8
31 36 25 26 50
3.4 3.5 3.5 6.1 2.4
Thermal stability Mass loss *
Mass loss **
O2 absorption ***
MFI ratio ****
3.5 6.0 6.0 5.0 3.0
0.7 1.1 1.3 1.0 0.5
0.48 0.62 0.5 0.5 0.45
1.11/1.12 = 0.99 0.04/crosslinked 5.63/5.85 = 0.96 1.93/1.65 = 1.17 1.62/1.43 = 1.13
Note: * Mass loss according to dynamic TGA (5°/min rate) at 350°C, %; ** Mass loss according to TGA during 1 h at 320°C, %; *** Oxygen absorption during 60 min at 250°C, mol/base-mol; **** MFI10 min/MFI20 min at 310°C.
To understand the reasons effecting thermal stability of PAI, a complex study of serial lots were performed. Metal increments, elemental composition and molecular-mass characteristics were analyzed. The results on several most demonstrative samples are shown in Table 5. Current studies indicated significant difference in elemental composition of PAI. Compared with calculated values, increased nitrogen concentration testifies about amine end group predominance over carboxylic groups. In turn, this reduces thermal stability of the melt, increases melt viscosity and causes approach of processing and degradation initiation temperatures [21]. All samples displayed very high content of metal admixtures. For example, they contained Mg. Fe and Ca by two orders of magnitude higher than PSF. A dramatic scatter of molecular-mass characteristics in studied serial lot should also be mentioned: Mw range equals 70,000, and Mz – 150,000. There were samples observed, possessing up to 10 wt.% gel in the primary state (before thermal processing). The interrelation between defect structures, admixtures and thermal stability is illustrated well on the example of sample No. 2, in which 10 wt.% gel-fraction was detected. The calculated nitrogen content in the composition was exceeded, and high amounts of Mg and, specifically, Fe were observed. These drawbacks affect thermal stability. At short-term heating in IIRT channel the polymer is crosslinked: MFI10 min = 0.04 g/10 min. Further exposure causes “complete crosslinking”, and the material may not be processed. According
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
131
to isothermal, dynamic TGA results in air and oxygen absorption data, this sample also displays low thermal oxidative stability. The experimental data are convincing that chemical structure of studied PAI lots is imperfect and polymer purity is poor. This makes processing more complicated and adversely affect the quality of marketable products, including material behavior during operation.
STABILIZATION Polysulfones (PSF) As is obvious, this problem is primarily associated with PSF high-temperature oxidation. The initial prerequisite to screening of admixtures was the experience obtained by the authors [22, 23] on thermal stabilization of polycarbonates by phosphite increments. This experience was transferred to polysulfones at the early stage of their development [24]. The idea of polysulfone stabilization using phosphorus-containing additives (PCA) is also present in international patents [25, 26]. Besides PCA, all types of classical antioxidants and substances, considered in the literature as high-temperature stabilizers for polymers (boron compounds, metal salts and complexes, organoelemental compounds) were used in the screening [27]. The empirical experience on antioxidant stabilization [28] concerning the efficiency of extremely unexpected substances, the structure of which is often different from the notions of antioxidants, was also used. The important part of screening is selection of an optimal method for admixture tests. It should be highly informative and require minimal experimental costs for tests a mass of compositions. Since degradation damages in PSF under processing conditions are caused by oxidation, O2 absorption kinetics is the most informative for screening. However, these experiments are rather complicated and require long-time performance which eliminates the full-scale application of the method to test of about a hundred of admixtures with varying concentrations. The assessment of thermal stability of PSF laboratory samples and production lots (both Russian and foreign) showed almost linear dependence of oxygen amount absorbed
Mz ratio: at 320°C, Mw
by the polymer (mol O2) and light transmittance change (abs.%) on
Mz . Therefore, these two parameters which are ∆[O2] ~ 0.005∆T; ∆[O2] = 0.012 Mw determined technically quickly (the first permanently, and the second and TGA by case) were used for screening. Among the abundance of tested classes of substances, PCA is the only additive reliably protecting PSF from oxidation in concentrations below 0.3 wt.%. As expected, by analogy with polycarbonate and other heterochain polymers processed at temperatures about 300°C, classical primary antioxidants (hindered phenols and aromatic amines) are at most neutral (amines catastrophically color PSF), which proved existence of the effective inhibition temperature limit (120 - 125°C) [11, p. 218]. It is stipulated by activity of phenoxyl radicals in reactions with hydroperoxides. Commonly, all so-called “non-chain inhibitors” intensify
132
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G .E. Zaikov
PSF degradation, though a combination of transition metal and phosphorus atoms in the same molecule, for example, (PhP(O)O)2Cr, is quite effective. An abrupt shortening of the list of potential stabilizers allowed, using all methods of degradation behavior assessment, detection of organic phosphates as the most effective additives among PCA. At high temperatures, alkylphosphites and non-substituted in ortho-position arylphosphites are extremely sensitive to humidity and foam the polymer up when hydrolyzing. Only in laboratory, at intimate drying of PSF, injection of additives in a “dry” atmosphere with immediate processing of the composition gives a stable effect. Similar situation is known for polycarbonate stabilization [23]. Only since 1980’s the so-called “sterically hindered” or low-hydrolyzing arylphosphites (SHP), discovered at that time, may be used for real thermal stabilization of PSF at processing temperatures. By analogy with hindered phenols, these newly discovered compounds contained volumetric tert-butyl groups in ortho-position at the ester bond. Among this class of phosphates, cyclic hindered phosphates, including ones derived from pentaerythritol, are the most effective. They are known under trademarks: Ultranox 626 (Borg Warner), Irgafos 126 (Ciba) and dibenzospiroarylphosphite Stafor 11 (NIIKhIMPolymer). The optimal concentration of additives to PSF is 0.1 – 0.8 wt.% (1.5 - 5 mmol/kg). Such a broad range of concentrations is caused by the individuality of approaching stabilization of particular PSF samples. Similar to the scale of degradation transformations, the stabilization effect possesses the inverse dependence on PSF sample purity. The higher concentration of additives and labile structures in the polymer is, the more noticeable the stabilization effect is. Unfortunately, "impure" sample may not reach the quality of pure PSF even by means of stabilization. The mentioned compounds in concentrations 0.1 – 0.3 wt.% slow down hightemperature degradation of samples with the minimal impurity degree, 1.5-2-fold decrease O2 absorption (Figure 3) and CO2 release rates. Degradation changes observed by IR-spectra occur much slower (C=O-group occurrence and accumulation is observed by 1660 and 1737 cm-1 bands).
Figure 3. Oxygen absorption kinetics (T = 320°C; P(O2) = 399.9 kPa) for PSF: (1) initial, stabilized by (2) 0.3% Ultranox 626 and (3) Stafor 11
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
133
In tests simulating processing conditions, SHP injections promote MFI increase, increase thermal stability index, decrease coloring degree, and prevent Mz increase induced by degradation branching and crosslinking of macromolecules (Figure 4). SHP stabilizing effect on branching was determined by direct GLC analysis. At solid-phase aging (180°C) of films during 75 days no changes in G-factor of stabilized (0.3 wt.% AO-118) sample (G = 1), whereas in nonstabilized PSF G-factor decreases to 0.8 by the aggregate stabilizing effect (O2 absorption kinetics, coloring, MFI thermal stability and MMD moment changes were studied). For PSF processing, cyclic SHP are optimal stabilizing additives, pentaerythritol diphosphites, above all. SHP with open chain, for example, tris-(2,4-di-tertbutylphenyl)phosphite, are much less effective.
Figure 4. Concentration dependence of SHP effect (Ultranox 626) in PSF tests on IIRT device (T = 320°C; 2.16 kg load): MFI (1), light transmittance (2), and Mz (3)
a
b
Figure 5. Microphotoes (× 15,000) of initial (a) and thermosabilized PSF, after 2 days of aging at 150°C (b)
Note also positive effect of SHP additives at PSF aging. According to scanning electron microscopy data (Figure 5), injections decrease domain size from 1,000 to 500Å and significantly increase their disposition density (compare with Figure 1). Contrary to
134
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G .E. Zaikov
nonstabilized PSF (Figure 5), thermal processing of stabilized PSF at exposure critical for operation properties (2 days) does not destroy the permolecular structure, but even promotes its further improvement: the domain size is reduced to 300 - 400Å, homogeneity and packing density increase. Obviously, chemical stabilization at processing also affects physical aging of PSF. One more circumstance should be mentioned. PSF thermal processing in vacuum, at temperature above 300°C causes degradation changes, insufficient as compared with thermal oxidation effect, but also noticeable. Similar to thermal oxidation, degradation change degree depends on the additive content in PSF. SHP increments slightly slow down thermal transformations in PSF. Unfortunately, this effect is much lower than similar effect of the same increments in thermal oxidation process. For example, after tests in vacuum at 350°C injections increase PSF light transmittance by 3 – 5 units. In the presence of oxygen, under the same conditions, the effect reaches 20 units or more. As a consequence, the contribution of direct deactivation of additives via complex formation is, apparently, not the decisive one, and the main role of SHP is activity of high-temperature antioxidants. Thus, high-temperature antioxidant stabilization of PSF by SHP (and possibly other phosphorus-containing compounds) injections is realized via inhibition of the radical-chain oxidation process and deactivation of additives activating these reactions. However, unexpected stabilizing effects, for example, a noticeable color stabilizing effect of negligibly small injection of copper sulfate or patent data on efficiency of tin-organic compounds in PSF [29] indicates the possibility of additional contributions and other stabilization mechanisms, for example, deactivation of electron-excited compounds or interlocking of a charge transfer complex with O2 (refer to [1 - 11]for detail). High-temperature oxidation and stabilization of aromatic heterochain polymers are complex processes which differ from the known lowtemperature oxidation and inhibition of hydrocarbon polymers. To some extent, these processes are closer to combustion, and stabilizing activity in them is obtained by substances which, at first glance, are not antioxidants, but, most likely, fire retardants. To discover new mechanisms of high-temperature stabilization, more comprehensive studies of behavior of these substances are required, for example, metal compounds in degrading polymer. In this case, the additive screening is aimed at searching for effective stabilizers to be used in PSF processing. The highest efficiency and raw material availability are the factors that defined our selection of SHP for industrial tests and selection of additive injection techniques. Development of thermal stabilizers for construction PSF trademarks was required for increasing quality of Russian-produced materials, namely, their physicomechanical and heatphysical properties, optical characteristics and thermal stability. The efficiency of stabilizers conforms to laboratory test data and their concentration in marketable product. According to laboratory assessments, the efficiency of trisnonylphenylphosphite (a moderate stabilizer), was found low due to high volatility: only 30% of injected phosphorus remained in granules. The stabilizing effect is manifested in melt viscosity decrease and increase of melt thermal stability, physicomechanical characteristics, heat resistance and light transmittance. Comparison results of stabilized and nonstabilized PSF quality within the same lot are shown in Table 6.
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
135
Table 6. Polysulfone pilot lot properties Sample
MFI*
MFI**
ε, %
14.4
Tensile strength, MPa 68.0
PSF without additives PSF + AO118 PSF + Ultranox 626 PSF + Stafor11
2.6
0.86
2.9
Heat resistance Vick Deform. 175
153
Light transmittance (426 nm), % 45.8
1.08
54.0
72.0
180
164
54.0
2.9
0.96
64.0
74.0
184
168
64.0
3.2
0.98
44.0
76.0
180
162
52.0
The above results indicate that injection of thermostabilizing additives improves quality of PSF.
Figure 6. Tensile strength change for PSF: nonstabilized (1) and stabilized by additives Stafor (2) and Ultranox 626 (3). Thermal aging in air, T = 160°C
The behavior of test stabilized and nonstabilized PSF lot was studied during aging at (160 ± 5)°C up to 1 year. Figure 6 shows dynamics of the tensile strength change in stabilized PSF during aging. In initial two days, resulting purely physical changes in permolecular PSF structure, the material becomes much stronger, by 35 – 40% above the initial value. However, already on the fifth day, the strength of nonstabilized PSF decreases by 10%. A year after this index decreases to the value of the primary PSF. In initial two days, stabilized PSF behaves itself similar to nonstabilized PSF. However, further aging does not cause so quick decrease of strength characteristics: an insignificant strength decrease is observed after 250 days only, and reaches 10% after 1 year of aging.
Table 7. Polyesterimide stabilization Stabilizing compoun-ding
Light transmittance, % * -248 49 54-33 53-48
Mass loss ratio **
MMC for PEI **** Mw Mn
Mz
Mw/Mn
Mz/Mw
-31.2 3.5-2.2 1.0-1.5
Melt viscosity *** 242 с-1 2912с-1 (104) (103) -4-51.3 3.2 1.3 3.2 1.6-1.9 2.9 1.2-1.6 2.8
-646.9 46.9 42.2 41.4
-718.2 18.2 17.3 18.0
-894.0 84.7 76.2
-92.58 2.44 -
-102.0 2.0 -
54
2.2
1.4
-
-
-
-
-
-
44 51-22 58-49
1.5 1.0-0.5 0.6-0.5
1.1 0.11-0.85 0.1-0.77
2 3.2 2.8-2.0
40.3 46.9 43.2-35.3
17.6 18.4 17.7-14.6
74.3 82.0 86.3-70.8
2.44-2.42
2.0
-10.05% MKS21 0.05% CuSO4 0.1% KI
-244
-30.9
-41.0
-53.0
-643.2
-717.9
-878.0
-9-
-10-
45
1.1
1.1
3.0
44.1
18.2
72.0
-
-
60
-
1.0
-
-
-
-
-
-
0.1-0.5% NaHPO4 1.0% Na5P3O10 0.5%TiO2
62
0.8-0.7
2.8
41.1-40.9
17.2-17.1
80.2-79.8
2.4-2.38
1.95
58
0.7
3.2
46.5
18.9
92.9
2.46
2.0
-
1.2
2.9
40.3
17.0
78.4
2.37
1.95
-1PEI without additives 0.05% Irganox1076 0.1-0.5% Irgafos 126 0.1-1.0% Irgafos 168 0.5% Irgafos 126/0.05% Irganox 1076 0.5% BT5 0.1-5.0% TNPP 0.1-1.0% benzoin
Note: * Light transmittance (in %) at 425 nm, after thermal processing in rheoviscosimeter at 340°C and 242 s-1 shear rate during 30 min; ** The ratio of mass losses for PEI (initial to stabilized) after thermal processing in rheoviscosimeter at 340°C and 242 s-1 shear rate (TGA data at 450°C during 60 min in air); *** Effective melt viscosity (pz) during 30 min at shear rates mentioned; **** Molecular mass characteristics (103) of PEI after thermal treatment in rheoviscosimeter at 340°C during 30 min at the shear rate of 2912 s-1.
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
137
Tests of thermal stabilizers under production conditions indicated efficiency of PSF stabilization by additives. They improve processing and initial properties of PSF, and increase operation time of polysulfone materials.
Polyesterimides (PEI) To increase PEI thermal stability during production (unloading from the device and extrusion), a broad list of additives was screened, including compounds from different chemical classes (phenols, phosphates, alternating valence metal compounds, etc.). According to mass losses obtained, the highest and the most stable antioxidant effect is displayed by phosphites (Table 7), though metal salts are quite stable, too. Moreover, among phosphates, hindered aromatic cyclic phosphates of Irgafos 126 should be outline. Their injection increases light transmittance of PEI by 10 – 15%, decreases mass losses by 20 – 50%, and significantly increases stability of the melt viscosity. Note also that SHP are the most effective antioxidants for PEI, too.
Aliphatic-Aromatic Polyamides and Glass-Filled Composite Materials Derived from Them There is a wide material in the literature on stabilization of aliphatic PA [6 – 8, 16]. However, at present, there are no data on optimization of the stabilizing system for aliphaticaromatic PA. Therefore, until now PPA were stabilized as aliphatic PA, using the traditional Cu2+/I- system. Basing on the data obtained for the degradation mechanism, it should be taken into account at stabilizer selection that injected additives must inhibit degradation reactions during processing and operation. As a consequence, the additives must: -
-
fully suppress or significantly decelerate initiation reactions of PPA high-temperature degradation which, as already suggested, develop untraditionally, via formation of “molecular complexes with oxygen” or “electron-excited states”; inhibit radical-chain process of solid material degradation in the operation temperature range. Moreover, obtaining of the required quality of polymeric material necessitates:
-
maximum possible elimination of hydrolytic reactions at all stages of polymer “life”; inhibition or maximum possible suppression of post-crystallization processes.
Various compounds were injected to PPA both individually and as complex mixtures, and their effects on the following indices were studied: oxygen absorption, MFI and melt thermal stability, gel-fraction content and sol-fraction color change.
138
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov Table 8. The effect of stabilizers on O2 absorption, CO2 release (180°C) and mass losses (330°C) at PPA-1 thermal oxidation in air
Composite PPA-1 without additives PPA-1 - Irganox 1098 (0.5%) PPA-1 – Cu/I (0.2%) PPA-1 - Irganox 1098 (0.08%)/Irgafos 168 (0.08%)/HALS 944 (0.2%) PPA-1 - Irgafos168 (0.08%)/CuSO4 (0.2%) PPA-1 - CuSO4 (0.2%)/Irgafos 168 (0.08%)/HALS 944 (0.2%) ПФА-1 - Zn acetate (0.2 %)/ Irganox1098/ Irgafos 168 (0.16%)
O2 absorption, mol/monomeric unit 0.21 None 0.16
CO2 release, mol/monomeric unit 0.029 0.09
Mass losses, % 5.4 3.8 3.5
0.07
0.014
4.2
0.20 0.10
0.024 0.01
4.1 3.6
0.16
0.02
4.3
Phenol antioxidants, thioesters, thiophosphates, ester fluorides, sterically hindered amines (HALS), carbodiimides, alternate valence metal complexes and salts, phosphates, phosphites, etc. were studied. Copper and Nickel salts are the most effective compounds. Injection of these compounds increases MFI at quite high stability of the melt viscosity, the strand is strong and elastic, O2 absorption and gel formation are suppressed, and the polymer becomes lighter colored. The known Cu2+/I- mixtures are also highly effective for MFI increase and oxygen absorption suppression. However, they do not practically improve thermal stability of the melt. A mixture Irganox B1171 (Ciba, aminophenol Irganox 1098 with phosphite Irgafos 168) is lower effective compared with transition metal compounds (Cu and Ni). Table 8 shows effects of stabilizers on the amount of absorbed oxygen and released CO2, and PPA mass losses at thermal oxidation (180°C) in air. The decrease of oxygen absorption and CO2 release (the main thermal oxidation product) was observed at Irganox 1098/Irgafos 168 or CuSO4/Irgafos 168/HALS 944 mixture injection. Analysis of the results obtained show that PPA may not be processed and material with required operation parameters obtained without injection of any stabilizer. Therefore, further investigations were targeted at comparison assessment of PPA inhibited oxidation in the operation temperature range of 150 - 200°C. Thermal oxidation solid degradation (at the operation temperature) mostly proceeds on the surface and is limited by the oxygen access deep in the polymer matrix. As aged, PPA becomes yellow. The lower yellowing degree is observed for application of HALS Chimassorb 944/Irganox B1171 and Irganox B1171/Zn acetate mixtures.
Stabilization of Glass-Filled Composite Materials Derived from PPA Compounding of the most effective glass-filled (glass fiber content 30 and 35%) thermostabilized PPA composites are the following:
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
139
Compounding 1: PPA-2 + 35% glass fiber + Cu acetate/KI (0.4%) + talcum (0.35%); Compounding 2: PPA-2 + 35% glass fiber + Zn acetate (0.1%) + Irgafos 168 (0.2%) + talcum (0.35%); Compounding 3: PPA-2 + 35% glass fiber + Zn acetate (0.1%) + Irgafos 168 (0.2%) + HALS 944 (0.3%) + talcum (0.35%); Compounding 4: PPA-2 + 35% glass fiber + Irganox 1098 (0.2%) + HALS 944 (0.3%) + talcum (0.35%); Compounding 5: PPA-2 + 35% glass fiber + Irganox 1098 (0.2%) + Irgafos 168 (0.2%) + talcum (0.35%); Compounding 6: PPA-1 + 30% glass fiber + CuSO4 (0.1%) + Irganox 1098 (0.1%) + Irgafos 126 (0.1%) + talcum (0.35%); Compounding 7: PPA-1 + 30% glass fiber + Na hypophosphite (0.2%) + HALS 944 (0.3%) + talcum (0.35%). As described in [1 - 11], the solid-phase oxidation is developed from the surface with oxygen penetration inside the sample. Table 9 shows assessments of oxidized layer thickness at application of various stabilization systems. The results obtained show that stabilizers affect both formation of the initial polymer material morphology and its change during aging. It should be noted that at thermal oxidation of compoundings stabilized by metal compounds, specifically by copper compounds, a rigid film is formed on the sample surface (samples become dark quickly), which loosens with exposure. As phenol antioxidants (SHP or HALS) are used, this rigid film is not formed, and the sample color becomes darker (from light yellow to brown and, finally, black) much slower. It is known [19, 20, 30 - 34] that yellowing is associated with formation of conjugated structures, carbonyl groups, and quinoid-type structures in the polymer. The MIIR method was used in the study of the sample surface structure. New absorption bands at 1700 cm-1 (C=O group oscillations) and 1400 cm-1 occur in spectra already 100 h after the aging beginning. After 3,000 h more bands at 2750 – 2500 and 1950 cm-1 (H-substitutions of aromatic nuclei) occur in the spectrum. Table 38 shows calculation results for optical density relation of newly occurring absorption bands to the absorption band of CH2-group oscillations at 2960 cm-1. Table 9. The change in oxidized layer during aging at 175°C of glass-filled stabilized PPA-1 and PPA-2 samples
Composite/time (h) 1. Cu2+/I- (0.4%): 120 288 500 2. Zn acetate (0.1%) + Irgafos 168 (0.2%) 120 288 500
Layer thickness (mm) and appearance Surface layer Intermediate layer
Total oxidation layer
0.15, strong 0.15, strong 0.13, friable
0.14, friable
0.15 0.15 0.27
0.05, strong 0.07, strong 0.1, friable
0.1, strong 0.1, friable 0.1, friable
0.15 0.17 0.2
140
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov Table 9. Continued
Composite/time (h) 3. Zn acetate (0.1%) + Irgafos 168 (0.2%) + HALS 944 (0.3%) 120 288 500 4. Irganox 1098 (0.2%) + HALS 944 (0.3%) 120 288 500 5. Irganox 1098 (0.2%) + HALS 944 + Irgafos 168 (0.2%) 120 288 500 6. CuSO4 (0.1%) + Irgafos 126 (0.1%) + Irganox 1098 (0/1%) 120 288 500 7. Na hypophosphite (0.2%) + HALS 944 (0.3%) 120 288 500
Layer thickness (mm) and appearance Surface layer Intermediate layer
Total oxidation layer
0,04, strong 0,13, strong 0,13, friable
0.06, strong -
0.1 0.13 0.13
0.13, friable 0.18, friable 0.18, friable
-
0.13 0.18 0.18
0.13, friable 0.18, friable 0.05, friable
0.15, friable
0.13 0.18 0.20
0.15, strong 0.18, strong 0.05, friable
0.15, strong
0.15 0.18 0.20
0.14, strong 0.18, strong 0.05, friable
0.15, strong
0.14 0.18 0.20
Of importance is the observation of changes in the structure of surface layers in different compoundings. In case of compounding 1 and 6 aging, already at initial stages a rigid film was formed on the sample surface, which loosens with exposure to aging. Compounding 1 and 6 composites becomes yellow quicker: at 150°C coloring approaches the “absolute black body” after 2000 h exposure, at 175°C – after 1000 h, and at 200°C – already by 500th hour of aging. In other compoundings, coloring becomes darker at lower rate, and the surface layer becomes friable. The results obtained show the highest efficiency for complexes with transition metal compounds, specifically Cu, in the composition. Possible mechanisms of transition metal compounds were discussed before [18, 19] and will be discussed in more detail here a bit later (Table 10). In the above-shown experiment with PPA, apparently, the ability of copper to complex formation is displayed. Macrochain crosslinking results in formation of a dense structure preventing oxygen access inside the polymeric matrix. In other compoundings containing no transition metal compounds, crosslinking reactions were not observed on the sample surface: oxygen gradually, layer by layer, destroys the polymeric matrix that makes the sample friable by the surface. MMD of the layers were studied by the GPC technique. For compoundings containing no copper compounds, it is shown that if degradation processes mostly proceed in the surface layer, accompanied by gradual, though insignificant molecular mass decrease, then macrochain branching processes dominate in the intermediate layer. Compoundings 4
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
141
and 6 contain only traditional additives: aminophenol, phosphite and polymeric HALS. Phenol antioxidant reacts with free radicals, and prosphite destroys hydroperoxides. HALS was injected in order to “extinguish” electron-excited molecules. Table 10. The relation of optical densities in IR-spectra Compounding
175°C #1. Cu/I 0.4% #2. Zn acetate (0.1%) + Irgafos 168 (0.2%) #3 Irganox 1098 (0.2%) + Irgafos 168 (0.2%) + HALS 944 (0.3%) #4 Irganox 1098 (0.2%) + HALS 944 (0.3%) #5 Na hypophosphite (0.2%) + HALS 944 (0.3%) 200°C #1 #2 #3 #4 #5
Exposure, h D1720/D2960 100 1000
3000
D1400/D2960 100 1000
3000
0.29
0.77
0.49 0.7
0.53
0.97
0.54 1.09
0.34
0.99
1.54
0.67
1.03
1.00
0.43
0.78
159
0.76
0.8
1.21
-
1.03
1.74
-
0.87
1.09
0.3 0.3 0.37 0.48 0.35
0.66 0.69 1.3 0.69 1.03
0.5 0.68 0.53 0.7 0.51
0.66 1.24 1.24 0.74 0.9
-
The structure of three compoundings of glass-filled PPA-2 differing by stabilization systems, were studied by the mercury porosimetry technique. Physicomechanical properties of the materials prior to aging are shown in Table 11. Table 11. Physicomechanical characteristics of stabilized glass-filled PPA-2 Stabilization compounding: As a nucleating agent, 0.5% low-dispersion talcum powder was injected, the filler is 35% glass fiber Cu/I stabilizer Na-hypophosphite Na-hypophosphite, HALS 944
Tensile strength, MPa
Relative elongation, %
Statistical treatment data Max/min Standard strength values deviation
Variation coefficient
207.0 177.4 192.8
4.5 3.7 3.8
193.3/211.9 163.0/193.8 174.5/206.7
1.2 2.0 2.0
6.87 10.37 11.2
According to Hg porosimetry data, more dense structure is formed in the compounding with Na hypophosphite. It possesses surface pores of 2.917⋅102 Å. In compoundings with Cu/I and Na hypophosphite + HALS 944 larger surface pores were detected: (5.698 6.267)⋅102 Å. The compoundings also differ by the pore shape, which is indicated by the amount of Hg remained in the composition after pressure relief. It is believed that if Hg flows off the sample completely, the pores are of “proper”, cylindrical shape, whereas if some amount of Hg remains in the sample, it has pores of “improper” shape, for example, a bottle-
142
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
like one [35]. In this case, it is assumed that Hg is pressed to a thing “bottle neck”, and at pressure relief it poured out incompletely through a narrow mouth. The most proper pore shape was detected for the compounding with Na hypophosphite, where residual Hg pressure equaled 3.5% versus 6.29 and 15.02% in compoundings with Cu/I and Na hypophosphite/HALS 944, respectively. In the heat aging during 2000 h at 175°C, the following parameters were detected: mass loss of the samples (∆m), yellowing index (YI) change, total thickness of oxidized layer (h) (Table 12), changes in physicomechanical properties and structure density (Table 13). Table 12. Color change, mass loss and oxidized layer thickness at aging of glass-filled, stabilized PPA-2 compoundings Compounding Cu/I stabilizer Na-hypophosphite Na-hypophosphite Chimassorb 944
YI before aging 5.752 1.105 7.199
1000 h YI 90.28 11.25 9.90
∆m,% 0.217 0.177 0.112
h, µ m 40 30 15
2000 h YI -511* 48.58 13.63
∆m,% 0.242 0.817 0.501
h, µ m 45 32 20
* This YI value is determined for absolutely black body.
Sample density changes differently during aging. Table 13. Tensile strength change during aging of glass-reinforced, stabilized PPA-2 compoundings Compounding
Cu/I stabilizer Na-hypophosphite Na-hypophosphite/ Chimassorb 944
1000 h Tensile strength, MPa
Relative elongation, %
Strength preservation, % of initial
2000 h Tensile strength, MPa
Relative elongation, %
Strength preservation, % of initial
172.5 136.5 156.0
3.5 3.0 3.3
83.3 76.9 80.9
170.1 121.3 125.6
3.1 2.5 2.4
82.17 68.38 65.15
In the compounding with Cu/I, kinetic dependencies of maximal pore volume and square on aging time are almost linear: maximal volume and square of pores decreases with exposure increase (Figure 7). In the compounding with Na-hypophosphite, these curves are of the extreme type (Figure 7), e.g. loosening of surface layers is observed at the initial stages of aging, and then some increase of the structure density. Note also that at 2000 h exposure samples are already somewhat friable, and layers are quite loose. In the compounding with Na-hypophosphite and HALS 994, the dependence of pore maximal volume has a maximum at practically linear increase of maximal porosity (Figure 7). Hence, a change of pore shape is also observed: in compoundings with Cu/I and a mixture of Na-hypophosphite and HALS 944 pores become almost cylindrical with the exposure increase, which is testified by almost complete Hg drain. Vice versa, in the compounding with Na-hypophosphite pores are deformed, and the amount of Hg remaining in the samples after 1000 and 2000 h of aging equals 16.49 and 21.18%, respectively. Of importance is that current observations display the
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
143
effect of the stabilizer type, its chemical structure and, as a consequence, the action mechanism on the physical structure formation of the composite. E.g. we observe a relation between chemical reactions and morphology of polymeric composites. The change of composite morphology is directly related to the change of physicomechanical properties (Tables 41 and 42). This problem has not yet been comprehensively discussed in the literature and remains practically uncovered still.
Figure 7. Kinetic curves of pore maximal volume (1 - 3) and maximal surface (1’ – 3’) change for PPA samples, stabilized by Cu/I (1, 1’), Na-hypophosphite (2, 2’) and Na-hypophosphite/Chimassorb 944 (3, 3’) during aging at 175°C
Current investigations allow optimization of PPA stabilization compounding as a mixture of copper compounds with phosphorus-containing antioxidant and phenol or HALS. The use of such compounding causes the following effects: -
PPA processing becomes easier due to the melt index increase; The obtained polymer possesses higher physicomechanical properties; Strength properties are preserved at quite high level during aging in the temperature range of 150 - 200°C.
Table 14. The change of physicomechanical properties of glass-reinforced PPA-2 (after 5000 h of aging) Temperature/ compounding
Prior to aging #1 Cu/I 0.4% #2 Zn acetate 0.1%+Irgafos 168 0.2% #3 Irganox 1098 0.2%+HALS 944 0.3% #4 Irganox 1098 0.2%+Irgafos 168 0.2%+HALS 944 0.3% #5 Na hypophosphiote 0.2%+HALS944 0.3% 150°С #1 #2 #3 #4 #5 175°С #1 Cu/I 0.4% #2 Zn acetate 0.1%+Irgafos 168 0.2% #3 Irganox 1098 0.2%+HALS 944 0.3% #4 Irganox 1098 0.2%+Irgafos 168 0.2%+HALS 944 0.3% #5 Na hypophosphite 0.2%+HALS 944 0.3% 200°С #1 #2 #3 #4 #5
Tensile stress, MPa
Preserved strength, % of initial
Elongation, %
Preserved elongation, % of initial
Bending strength, MPa
Preserved strength, % of initial
Blow viscosity, kJ/m2
Preserved blow viscosity, % of initial
207 191
-
2.85 2.95
-
278 253
-
57.4 52.8
-
181
-
2.85
-
256
-
55.9
-
207
-
3.05
-
278
-
52.1
-
193
-
2.85
-
281
-
63.1
-
138 137 127 139 149
69.9 71.7 67.9 67.1 80.1
2.5 2.65 2.7 2.8 2.85
87.7 93.0 98.0 90.3 99.1
200 143 124 156 148
71.9 56.5 48.4 56.1 52.7
26.2 28.6 27.2 23.8 31.1
45.6 54.2 48.7 45.7 49.3
140 115
67.0 60.2
2.5 2.65
87.7 93.0
183 130
65.8 51.4
25.4 27.3
44.2 51.7
116
62.0
2.5
95.0
135
52.7
26.0
46.5
129
62.3
2.65
85.5
125
45.0
24.9
47.8
141
75.8
2.75
98.2
144
51.2
31.0
49.1
85 91 103 98 105
50.2 47.6 55.1 47.3 56.5
1.6 2.1 1.95 1.90 2.2
56.1 73.7 75.0 61.2 81.5
98 70 76 72 86
35.3 27.7 29.7 25.8 30.6
8.4 10.0 9.6 8.4 13.6
14.6 18.9 17.1 16.1 21.6
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
145
Glass-Filled Composite Materials Derived from Poly(Alkane Imide) (PAI) Thermal stabilization of fatty-aromatic polyimides at operation temperatures with the help of additives is suggested in patents [36, 37] on materials derived from PAI. The use of transition metal compounds as additives to PAI, to some extent based on the analogy to aliphatic PA, is not confirmed in the literature, i.e. it falls apart from traditional antioxidant stabilization and, therefore, requires additional study. As shown above, thermal oxidation of PAI at moderate temperatures, close to the operation range, possesses some signs of usual radical-chain process with branchings on hydroperoxides. After the specific act of initiation, thermal oxidation continues developing in fatty chain by the well-known radical-chain scheme with the known approaches to inhibition. Similar to additive screening in PPA, it is shown that classical antioxidants of phenol and amine types are not effective enough, though they slow down the low-temperature oxidation. Organic phosphites, both mixed with phenols and individual, are quite effective in hydroperoxide degradation reactions [11, p. 202]. However, by effectiveness in PAI all studied phosphites abate phosphate – diphenyl ether of anilidophosphoric acid (BT5), which is the high-temperature stabilizer for polyheteroarylenes [23]. As used in quite high concentrations (up to 2 wt.%), BT5 effectively inhibits O2 absorption (more than two-fold) during PAI oxidation in the solid phase and in melt. Antioxidant action of BT5 is displayed in elimination of exothermal peak on the DTA curve. A mixture of BT5 with phenol antioxidant gives a synergic effect for solid-phase oxidation of PAI. This blend possesses the highest stabilizing activity among all organic additives to PAI: the initial rate of O2 absorption is more than 3-fold reduced. The action of BT5 and other PCA in heat resistant polymers will be discussed below. Similar to PPA, good thermostabilizing efficiency in PAI is displayed by transition metal compounds, specifically, mixed with PCA. Table 15. PAI-S-EK-1 properties MFI, g/10 min, at 10 kg load
Sample Without additives CuSO4 (0.1%) + ВТ5 (2%) Irganox 1010 (0.2%) + Stafor 11 (0.5%) CuSO4 (0.1%) + ВТ5 (2%) + HALS 944 (0.2%)
Physicomechanical properties Tensile Blow strength, viscosity, MPa kJ/m2 13.0 85.5
Dielectric properties Dielectric constant at 106 Hz 3.2
Breakdow n voltage, kV/mm 24.5
20.0
93.5
3.4
24.9
Maximum squeezing effort, kgf 40-45
10 min 10.0
18-20
10.7
30 min Crosslinking 9.5
36-39
24.2
23.3
19.0
92.0
3.4
28.3
18-20
15.3
14.4
22.0
95.0
3.4
25.7
146
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
Figure 8. Relative changes of strength (a) and blow viscosity (b) of stabilized (1) and nonstabilized (2) PAIS-EK during heat aging in air at 200°C
The difficulty in PAI processing is associated with branching and crosslinking processes, intensively proceeding at high temperature. Under real conditions without stabilization, total presence of the material in melt during 30 min (total effect of extrusion and molding of articles) may cause full crosslinking. Table 15 shows properties of stabilized and nonstabilized composite, glass-filled PAI. At long-term thermal aging in air in the temperature range of 200 - 250°C, stabilized materials preserve higher strength properties longer than nonstabilized ones (Figure 8). Therefore, effective thermostabilizing systems were determined, which improve quality of composite materials derived from PAI simultaneously with endurance of the articles.
On the Mechanism of Transition Metal Compounds Inorganic and organic alternate valence metal salts and their complexes inhibit O2 absorption and mass loss in PAI at heating in the presence of O2 at high temperature (for example, Figure 9). Under these conditions, non-transition metal compounds are inert. The effect of 0.05 – 1.0 wt.% additions of transition metal compounds on PAI thermal oxidation is
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
147
also traced by heat patterns as full elimination of exothermal DTA peak corresponded to oxidation. The origin of this peak is discussed in detail in the previous Section. The gross effect of molecular-mass characteristic stabilization in PAI under conditions that simulate processing may be assessed using the melt flow index (MFI). This parameter is more stable in the presence of additives and shows no tendency of the polymer to crosslinking, which is specifically typical of PAI and makes the processing more difficult (Figure 10). In case, if an additive is colorless, stabilization is observed by PAI yellowing decrease after tests in IIRT device.
Figure 9. Kinetic curves of O2 absorption by pure PAI (1) and PAI stabilized by 0.05 wt.% CoCl2 (2), FeSO4 (3) MKS-21 (4), and copper acetate (5) (T = 250°C; P(O2) = 266.6 kPa)
Figure 10. MFI change for PAI at 320°C: initial (1) and stabilized by 0.05 wt.% FeSO4 (2) and copper acetate (3)
148
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
Addition of transition metal compounds reduces the rate of carbon oxides and heavy product release during PAI thermal oxidation (Figure 11), and, as shown by IR-spectra, increase of C=O and OH-group contents in the polymer residue. Stabilizing activity of additives is preserved after simulation of PAI processing and manifests itself in mass loss and O2 absorption kinetics during accelerated thermal oxidation.
Figure 11. Oxygen absorption (1, 3) and CO2 release (2, 4) in thermal oxidation of PAI: initial (1, 2) and CuSO4 (0.05 wt.%) stabilized (3, 4); T = 200°C, in air
Figure 12. TGA patterns for PAI: pure (1) and stabilized by 0.05 wt.% portions of Sn-X (2), Cr-X (3), Co-X (4), Ni-X (5), and Cu-X (6), where X is diphenylphosphonic acid residue; T = 350°C, in air
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
149
Generally, transition metal compounds display clear antioxidant effect, inhibiting PAI degradation in the whole processing and operation temperature range. Usually, inorganic salts are less effective than organic salts. The effect of cation on organic salt effectiveness is traced on the example of bivalent copper, nickel, chromium and tin diphenylphosphonium salts. As shown by mass loss (Figure 12) and O2 absorption (Figure 13), the additive effectiveness reduces in the sequence as follows: Сu2+ > Ni2+> Со2+ > Cr2+ > Sn2+.
Figure 13. Oxygen absorption kinetics for PAI: pure (1) and added by 0.05 wt.% portions of Sn-X (2), Cr-X (3), Co-X (4), Ni-X (5), and Cu-X (6), where X is diphenylphosphonic acid residue; T = 250°C, P(O2) = 266.6 kPa
Similar sequence may be composed for metal phthalocyanines. The effectiveness of additives also depends on the valence state of metal. As shown on the example of copper, metals in the highest valence state are more effective, e.g. C2+ > Cu+. The effectiveness sequences of transition metal additives generally correlate with the sequence of their electronegativity values [38]: Cu+2 – 2.1; Cu+ - 1.8; Ni+2 – 1.9; Со+2 – 1.9; Cr+2 – 1.6; Sn+2 – 1.6, which is reverse to the sequence of effective ion and covalent radii. For example, covalent radii increase in the sequence from Cu+2 (1.25) to Sn+2 (1.4). The effect of anion on the additive effectiveness is relatively low, and no regularities (acetate, sulfate, silicate) are observed in it (acetate, sulfate, silicate), except for anions with suggested self reactivity in degradation reactions. For example, MFI data show that Ni+2 salt effectiveness changes in the following sequence: -
S HO
O
P 2
S
-
S >
HO
OCH P 2 2
S
>
Ph - P-O2 O
150
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
whereas mass losses at 350°C indicate equal average effectiveness for all three additives, despite the presence of a hindered phenol fragment in two of them. Nevertheless, a combination of elements in the mentioned phosphonic and dithiophosphonic acids provide for self stabilizing activity, displayed in O2 absorption and mass loss of both acids themselves and their salts of non-transition (inactive) metals, zinc, for example.
Figure 14. Concentration dependence of diphenylphosphonic acid salts (X) additions on MFI10 min for: Sn-X (1), Co-X (2), Cr-X (3), Ni-X (4), and Cu-X (5)
Figure 15. Concentration dependence of diphenylphosphonic acid salts (X) additions on mass losses in PAI with additions: Sn-X (1), Co-X (2), Cr-X (3), Ni-X (4), and Cu-X (5); T = 350°C, in air
The presence of additions of phosphorus or combinations of phosphorus with sulfur, shaped as salts, acids or even sulfides, in the structure causes an original placticizing effect on PAI, MFI of which increases by 50 – 500% and reaches (for example, in the case of Ni
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
151
dithiophosphate addition) 8 g/10 min, whereas MFI of pure PAI equals 1.62 g/10 min. However, the whole stabilizing effect and its universality for different temperature ranges is only realized in phosphorus (or phosphorus and sulfur) combination with alternate valence metals, shaped as compounds and, apparently, admixtures. Concentration dependencies of the additive stabilization effect possess peaks at 0.001 – 0.005 g-atom/base-mol cation content in PAI (Figures 14 and 15). Therefore, additions of transition metals display the antioxidant activity in PAI in concentrations approximately equal one metal ion per one macromolecule. Stabilizing efficiency of metal ions in PAI correlates with their electronegativity, ionic and covalent radii, soft-hard interaction type [39], i.e. the complex forming parameters of these ions. As mentioned in the literature, transition metals may form complexes with polypyromellitamido acids (PAA) as a stage of obtaining metal-containing polyimides, which are polymers with specific properties [40]. In particular, solid-phase complex formation between PAA and disperse transitions metals (Cu, Fe, Ni, Co) is detected in the X-ray analysis by elimination of the metal phase [41]. Using the ESR method, changes in the polymeric complex (PAA⋅Cu+2) were traced. These changes happen at PAA heating up and its transformation to polyimide. Simultaneously, Cu+2 is restored to Cu+ or even to pure metal [40]. Besides existence of the complex, changes in ESR spectra with respect to copper compound concentration indicate the existence of exchange copper clusters. It is believed [40] that the polymer complex is formed due to ionic exchange by ligands and valent bond formation between copper and PAA acid groups. Hence, the complex is thermally decomposed and, therefore, polyimide contains metal and metal oxides heterophase. A suggestion about complex formation is also confirmed by the following reasons. The well-known is the problem of deactivation of transition metal admixtures, specifically copper, in polyolefin materials used in production of cable insulation [42]. Admixtures abruptly decrease thermal and weather resistance of polyolefins. Thermal stability and weather resistance of polyolefins, especially polypropylene, are increased by adding up to 0.5 wt.% chelating agents, therefore, the thermal stabilization effect correlates with the stability constant of forming copper complex, for example, by the induction period of O2 absorption [43]. Among copper deactivators, aromatic amides and imides are the strongest. Marketable deactivators, produced by Van-der-Bilt, Monsanto, and American Cyanamide companies, contain mentioned groups in their structure [43]. Thus, the current question appears somewhat turned inside out but, nevertheless, the complex formation is quite strictly proved. It is believed that a complex is formed during processing, e.g. it resists high temperatures up to 240°C (polypropylene extrusion, for example). The PAI-copper compound system (or a model) was studied by ESR and magnetic susceptibility methods. The model – didodecylpyromellitimide has no ESR signal, and another model – Dodecane diphathalimide and PAI, is paramagnetic and display singlets with gav = 2.183. The effective thermal stabilizer of PAI, which is CuSO4, is characterized by the effective signal of mixed shape (Figure 16) with gn = 2.077 and gl = 2.27. This indicates the presence of crystal-hydrate water in the additive (CuSO4·nH2O). The signal intensity, its shape and value are preserved in the additive subject to thermal processing in air at 300°C. Thermal processing in vacuum and, apparently, crystal-hydrate decomposition change the signal shape, which now represents a wide distorted singlet with gave = 2.208. Mechanical mixing of
152
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
PAI or models with CuSO4 specifically changes the copper signal shape (Figure 16). Thermal processing of PAI or models mixtures with CuSO4 at 300°C in air most abruptly reduces the intensity (down to its absolute absence). Note that analogous thermal processing of CuSO4 without PAI causes no changes in spectra, e.g. Cu+2 is spent in thermally oxidizing PAI.
Figure 16. ESR spectra for CuSO4 before (1) and after (2) thermal treatment (T = 320°C, 30 min, in vacuum) and CuSO4 mixture with dodecamethylene diphthalimide (3)
Magnetic susceptibility measurements performed by the Faraday relative method on the device, constructed by specialists of IONCh, AS USSR, indicated paramagnetic properties of PAI. Hence, the effective magnetic moment, µeff, equals 0.77 – 0.94 B.M. (Bor magneton) at 287 K. As temperature decreased to 79 K, the value monotonously decreased to 0.39 - 0.63 M.B. (the whole massif of serial and laboratory samples was analyzed). Such behavior is typical of the so-called cluster states, in which paramagnetic centers realize exchange interactions, described by the Haisenberg-Dirac-Van Flick Hamiltonian (the HDVF model): H = -2
∑J
ij
Si S j ,
i, j
where Si and Sj are spin operators; Jij are exchange parameters. Computer calculation of exchange parameters by dimer, trimer and polymer cluster software [44] shows that magnetic susceptibility of PAI is described well within the framework of HDVF antiferromagnetic linear model with the exchange parameter Jij = 226 cm-1, which corresponds to high conjugation degree, usually, along the polymeric chain by the π-system or between chains, for example, by defect structures. Chemical structure of PAI, in which pyromellitic fragments are
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
153
separated by long methylene chains, does not provide such type of conjugation. The unique possibility to realize conjugation is formation of intramolecular (A) or intermolecular (B) complexes: CH
2
N
OC OC
CO N CO
CH 2 CH 2
OC CH N OC 2
CO N CH 2 CO
CH 2
CH 2
N CO
OC CH N 2 OC
CO
N CH 2
OC OC
CO
OC
CO N CO
N
CO
OC
N
CH 2
CH
2
B
A
Intramolecular conjugation similar to complex A, may be hardly realized for PAI, because in this case, the distance between conjugation centers must not exceed 4 Å, and the identity period for PAI (X-ray analysis data) [45] equals 18 Å, which is much above the maximum value [44]. At thermal processing of PAI in air at 320°C, the its magnetic behavior does not generally change, however, exchange parameters decrease to -110 and -150 cm-1, respectively, that may happen with the conjugation decrease. As a result of thermal processing at 320°C during 0.5 h and even in the presence of oxygen, degradation changes in PAI are insignificant. X-ray structural analysis data [45] testify that the initial powder-like PAI, synthesized in solution, is characterized by methylene-chain convolved conformation of macrochains. As annealed at temperatures 10 - 15°C below the melting point, the period along PAI chain axis changes jump-like, and convolved conformation changes to stretched one. This is irreversible change – the reverse phase change is not observed. After phase transition, the initial monoclinic crystallite structure transforms to a new monoclinic structure of higher density, crystal density in which increases from 1.302 to 1.398 g/cm3. Temperature dependence of PAI conformation correlates well with that of exchange interactions in PAI clusters. Since an increase of intermolecular interaction and, consequently, contribution increase of hypothetic intermolecular π-complexes into conjugation with the packing density might be expected, the experiment displays the inverse effect – it is desirable to interpret the conjugation decrease caused by thermal processing and associated stretching of macrochains as a result of intramolecular complex degradation. Thus, PAI is the example of yet unknown realization of polymer conjugation not by the chain, but in the cluster. The study of copper sulfate magnetic susceptibility shows the island structure of this complex. The effective magnetic moment µeff equals 1.86 B.M. does not vary with temperature in the range of 78 – 291 K. Thermal processing of the additive without polymer at 320°C in air and in vacuum causes partial loss if combined water, and µeff value increases to 1.87 – 1.88 B.M. The values of µeff for initial and thermally processed sulfate are somewhat higher than µeff spin values (1.73 B.M.). It is typical of copper complexes and is explained by the contribution of spin-orbital component.
154
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
Magnetic susceptibility of non-reacting mechanical admixtures is the additive value, i.e. molar magnetic susceptibility of polymers with inclusion of any coordination compound equals: ψmix = αψn + (1 - α)ψc, where ψn and ψc are molar susceptibilities of polymeric matrix and complex compound incorporated in this matrix; α is the molar part of the polymeric matrix. If the immediate surrounding of paramagnetic center is restructured chemically or even sterically, the additivity rule is disturbed. For equimolar mixtures of PAI and copper sulfate, the additivity rule is not observed: ψr values of initial complexes and the mixture equal 5.78×10-6; 6.43×10-7 and 6.86×10-7, respectively. Deviation from additivity is much clearer for thermal processed mixture, for example, magnetic susceptibility of the mixture, heated in air at 320°C during 0.5 h, equals 1.05×10-5. This significantly exceeds the totality of parts of similarly processed copper sulfate and PAI: 8.78×10-6 and 1.46×10-6, respectively. Thermal processing in any atmosphere leads to a significant increase of magnetic susceptibility and effective magnetic moment of PAI and PAI mixtures with copper sulfate, and the effect is higher for thermal processing in air (Figure 17).
Figure 17. Changes in molar magnetic susceptibility (X) of samples before (1 – 4) and after (1’ – 4’) heating of pure PAI (1, 1’), PAI added by CuSO4 (2, 2’), BT-5 (3, 3’), and CuSO4 and BT-5 blend (4, 4’)
Thus, studies of magnetic properties clearly indicate the interaction of PAI macromolecules and a transition metal compound even at mixing. This interaction restructures the coordination additive sphere, apparently, by means of the ligand exchange. At high temperatures, especially in the presence of oxygen, the system remains labile. As a result of all transformations, apparently, Cu+2 is reduced to Cu+. The reduced results of magnetic property study of the system and correlation of the stabilizing efficiency with electronegativity of additives do not counter the hypothesis of complex formation as the stabilization mechanism. If we base on the competition between the
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
155
additive and O2 in the complex formation with pyromellitic fragment structure elements, even at maximal coordination numbers 6 – 8 (unreal for PAI with respect to bulkiness of pyromellitic fragment, interlocking of all pyromellitic fragments requires 0.1 – 0.2 g-atom of metal/base-mol of additive. One may assume that thermal oxidation develops in the amorphous phase of the polymer only, and regular and O2 hardly accessible structures in the melt are preserved, and other, various assumptions can be made, but this mechanistic way does not allow approaching the empirical concentration of the additive to experimental optimal values (0.001 – 0.005 g-atom of metal/ base-mol) even by an order of magnitude. Therefore, the model of stabilization act must be replaced. Two alternatives are possible: -
The first alternative represents an old idea [46] about chain inhibition in additive reaction with peroxy-radical, but with participation in the complex of peroxy oxygen and neighboring imide fragment of pyromellitimide residue simultaneously:
CH 2
CH
N
O O
O
O
C C
C
O
O
C
N
CH 2
Me
otherwise ineffectiveness, for example, of copper compounds at thermal oxidation of PE methylene chain at any temperatures may not be explained. For example, at 130°C the addition of 0.05 wt.% CuSO4 almost two-fold speeds up oxygen absorption. Basically, such inhibition mechanism assumes low concentrations of additives. For example, classical antioxidant concentrations in hydrocarbon polymers by the order of magnitude correspond to effective concentrations of transition metal compounds in PAI. However, the mechanism of oxidation chain inhibition suggests sufficient migration ability of the additive and synchronization of complex formation with two ligands - peroxide oxygen and, for example, carbonyl group in the neighbor imide cycle. Two facts contradict to this condition. Firstly, inorganic salts insoluble and, consequently, non-migrating in the polymer are effective in PAI. Secondly, if an imide group plays the role of the partner-ligand, the first alternative about imide cycle interlocking by the complex formation, i.e. about high additive concentrations, becomes actual. Thus, the first version of the stabilization mechanism insufficiently conforms to the experiment. Apparently, even if this mechanism is realized, it is not important for PAI stabilization. -
The second alternative suggests existence of any labile structures in PAI, at which thermal oxidation is initiated. The role of labile structures, or “defects”, or variety of units in determination of polymer thermal stability is known well [47]. For example,
156
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov common PE possesses much lower thermal oxidative stability compared with polymethylene due to the presence of unsaturated internal and end groups and branchings in macromolecules. Another known example is PVC, in which labile structures define both hydrochlorination and development of the thermal oxidation process [16]. In PAI, the polymer of the polycondensation type, labile structures are amidoacid units and, possibly, salt end groups [48].
The dependence of thermal oxidative stability on the end group origin was traced by O2 absorption kinetics and mass loss in PAI, synthesized with 5% excess of diamine or dianhydride, or with addition of an interlocking agent – phthalic anhydride (Figures 11 and 12). Degradation transformations proceed more intensively in the sample, synthesized with diamine excess. High thermal stability was observed in PAI with pyromellitic dianhydride excess and added interlocking agent. Therefore, experimental concentration dependence of additive efficiency may be explained, if it is believed that complex forming action of transition metal additives is realized via deactivation of defect structures, which content in PAI equals several percents. Generally, shortly studied phenomenon of thermal oxidation stabilization of amide polymers by transition metal compounds may not be unambiguously interpreted. The authors were lucky showing that the present stabilization method falls outside the framework of aliphatic polyamide class, for which it is already known, and may also be used for other polymers, for fatty-aromatic polymellitimide, in particular. Mechanical transfer of classical radical-chain oxidation scheme gives no explanation to some sufficient features of polyamide and polyimide thermal behavior and their thermal stabilization. Apparently, new models are required, which would include acts with participation of amide or imide groups. Studies of magnetic and paramagnetic properties indicate the interaction of transition metal additive with PAI, initiated already during mixing. Moreover, is degradation is intensive, this interaction is also intensified. Even at dry mixing and milling of absolutely diamagnetic polymer (PA-6) with a paramagnetic complex Cu+2 (compound MKS-21) changes in ESR spectra are observed. These changes may only be caused by the interaction between amide groups and additives, must likely by the ligand exchange mechanism. Apparently, the complex formation (or the ligand exchange) of macromolecule or its fragment with transition metal additive is the necessary prerequisite for performance of the antioxidant action. The role of this reaction in the general mechanism of inhibited thermal oxidation may not yet be shown, though different models, mentioned above, for example, may be suggested: labile group interlocking, prevention of molecular complex formation with O2, and, possibly, some new reactions with peroxy-radicals. This new area of stabilization (to be called hightemperature stabilization) requires further study and development, as well as the classical mechanism of hydrocarbon polymer inhibited oxidation. Studies of the latter were initiated in early 2000’s and are intensively developed still.
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
157
On the Mechanism of Degradation Transformations in Heat-Resistant Heterochain Polymers in the Presence of Stabilizers – PhosphorusContaining Compounds Analysis of data from the literature and the authors’ investigations indicate injection of phosphorus-containing additives (PCA) in polymers as the most perspective way of heatresistant polymer thermal stabilization [22, 27, 28, 35, 49, 64]. Tests of a wide PCA range in different polymer structures (aromatic and fatty-aromatic polyamides and polyimides, polyesterimides, polyamidoimides, polysulfones, liquid-crystal copolyesters, ets.) allowed selection of optimal thermostabilizing additives: aromatic esters and phosphorous and prosphoric esteramides. For pure aromatic polyimides, polyimidophenylquinoxalines and polybenzoxazoles, optimal concentrations are 3 wt.% PCA. At equal heat loads, properties of stabilized samples are 1.5 – 2.5 times higher compared with non-stabilized polymers. For aliphatic-aromatic polymers (bisphenol A-derived polysulfone and polyesterimide, polyalkane imide, and polyphthalimides), PCA optimal concentrations are two times lower: 0.3 – 1.0 wt.%. This is caused by lower temperature impacts during processing and operation of materials and articles. To develop the idea of heat resistant polymer stabilization, one must understand the mechanism of PCA stabilizing action in them. Simultaneously with applied stabilization, some studies were performed before on the example of aromatic polyimides. The inhibiting action of PCA on oxidation branch of degradation and pre-polymer cyclization rate increase in PCA presence were detected. It was also found that crosslinking processes are intensified on the initial stages of thermal oxidation. Experimental data indicate a complex mechanism of PCA action in heat-resistant polymers, which includes inhibition of radical chain reactions and catalysis of cyclization and crosslinking processes. The comparison data on kinetics of inhibited and non-inhibited oxidation of polypyromellitimide, PAI, PPA, PEI and PSF at high processing temperature and in solid oxidation show general tendencies. In both cases, kinetic curves of oxygen absorption and main oxidation products release (carbon oxides) may be conditionally divided into two stages: the initial stage obeying kinetic order one and the constant rate stage. Inhibition of thermal oxidation is observed at the first stage of heat-resistant polymer degradation. For example, rate constants of oxygen absorption by PI equal 7.5×10-7 - 1.6×10-8 and 1.9×10-6 - 7.4×10-8 s-1 for non-stabilized and stabilized PI, respectively. Gas products release demonstrates similar relations. A decrease of thermal oxidation solid product (pyromellitdiimide, PDI) yield was also observed – by 2.5 times for PI and 5 times for PAI:
158
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
Injection of PCA to polyphenylquinoxalines significantly decreases the yield of analogous (in relation to the polymer structure) product, which is N-phenylpyrazine:
Correspondingly, in PPA [35] the yield of tetraphthalic amide
is almost eliminated (during the studied time period up to 5,000 h). The amounts of PDI and analogous products (relative to polymer structures) [64, 65] indicate the conversion degree in oxidation transformations. The absence of these compounds in degradation products after reaction without oxygen testifies about exclusively thermal oxidation origin of their formation. Therefore, stabilization of heat-resistant polymers (HRP) displays clear antioxidant type, i.e. an additive is capable of interacting with radicals and other labile products of HRP thermal oxidation. High-temperature activity of PCA in radical reactions is additionally confirmed by stabilizing effect of anilidophenylphosphate (BT-5) on PE degradation at 300°C. Application of such a model system to this particular case is desirable, because the radical-chain type of PE thermal oxidation at 200 - 250°C is well-known. It is also forecasted well for higher temperatures and, therefore, at some chain branching degree is forecasted well for carbonyl structures. A significant contribution of the branching degree to polymer properties, including thermal stability, was shown by Korshak [66]. Non-cyclic units represent the main element of branching [65, 67]. The PCA effect on the cycle formation process was assessed using gaschromatographic analysis of water release from polyamidoacid films – PI and PEI prepolymers. Intensive water release was observed at initial cyclization stages at 150 - 200°C. Total water amount released from stabilized and non-stabilized PI and PEI at 250 - 300°C are nearly the same, i.e. in both cases, cyclization degrees are close. The PCA effectiveness for polyphenylquinoxaline – the polymer, in which cyclization proceeds easily, without any additional heat treatment – indicates that cyclization process acceleration in heat-resistant polymers (PI, for example) may not explain the protective action of PCA.
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
159
Figure 18. ESR spectra of spin probe in PI film without additives (a, c) and added by BT-5 (b); a, b – prior to thermal aging; c – after thermal aging at 300°C during 500 h in air
Another possible stabilization mechanism – the formation of more stable network polymer structure in the presence of PCA with hindered oxygen access – was checked using the spin probe technique [7]. The probe (nitroxyl radical) diffusion into PI matrix was traced by changes in ESR spectra from classical triplet of freely isotropic-rotating, stable nitroxyl radical to a triplet degenerate by boundary components, typical of a probe rotating in a viscous medium. The spectrum (Figure 18) is of superposition type and indicates the presence of slow (main) and fast probe motion zones in the polymeric matrix. Relaxation times for non-stabilized and stabilized PI films were determined from graphic charts [68] as follows: τ1 = 2×10-8, τ2 (~5%) = 10-9 s and τ1 = (2 ÷ 5)×10-8, τ2 (~10 ÷ 15%) = 10-10 s, respectively. These values indicate a definite plasticizing effect of the additive on PI film properties. After thermal aging of films at 300°C during 500 h, τ1 does not increase. Vice versa, for nonstabilized sample it decreases to 10-9 s, whereas for stabilized sample it remained practically unchanged. Apparently, the decrease of τ1 in non-stabilized film is associated with probe fixing on structure defects (various microcracks), but not with molecular mobility increase. Degraded non-stabilized PI possesses self paramagnetic properties (a singlet with ∆H ≈ 10 E), which superimposes on the central component of ESR spectrum of the probe. This contribution is negligible for stabilized sample. The behavior of paramagnetic probe definitely reflects molecular mobility of the solid. Moreover, rotational and translational diffusion of the probe correlates with behavior of other “small” molecules (oxygen, for example) in the solid matrix. As observed in the experiment, additional crosslinking does not cause a noticeable change in molecular mobility of the polymer and hindrance of O2 diffusion inside the sample.
160
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
Figure 19. Diffraction patterns for PI films without additives (1, b; 1, 2) and added by 2 wt.% BT-5 (b; 3, 4) prior to heat aging (a, b; 1, 3) and after thermal oxidation (b; 2, 4); T = 300°C; 700 h in air
The effective method for increasing thermal oxidation stability of polymers is control of the physical structure [7]. The additive effect on the physical structure of PI film was studied with the help of X-ray structural analysis. The film possesses mesomorphous regularity, of which the presence of an intrachain order in the absence of interchain packing regulation is typical. As shown on the diffraction pattern, such structure manifests itself by a single narrow peak of the intrachain order (5 – 6 deg) and wide amorphous halo (Figure 19). Diffraction patterns show high intrachain orderliness of the stabilized sample. This difference is
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
161
preserved still after 1,000 h of aging at 300°C at total reduction of the intrachain order. Similar situation is observed on diffraction patterns for liquid-crystal polymers (Figure 22), stabilized by cyclic phosphites derived from pentaerythtitol Irgafos 126. However, stabilization may just partly be associated with the intrachain order increase in the presence of PCA. PCA are also effective in amorphous polymers, such as PSF and PPQ (refer to [1 - 11) [65]. As shown by the experiment, crosslinking proceeding during aging of PI films, both stabilized and non-stabilized, does not cause any significant change in molecular mobility of the polymer and hindrance of oxygen diffusion deep in the sample. Crosslinking intensification by PCA injection is disproved by the data on PAI and PPA melt viscosity decrease in the presence of PCA.
Figure 20. Diffraction pattern for LCP derived from TPA, IPA, p-OBA and DODP without additives (1, 2) and added by 0.5% Irgafos 126 (3, 4): (1, 3) prior to heat treatment and (2, 4) after thermal processing; T = 300°C; 5 h in air
The studies performed with industrial and model PAI, PPA, PEI and PSF samples, aimed at determination of PCA action as deactivators of admixtures in heat-resistant polymers gained positive results. PSF high-temperature oxidation is slowed down by low PCA additions. Though organic phosphites, specifically SHP, are of the highest efficiency and their stabilizing action is spread upon the whole complex of degradation manifestations, other PCA classes, even red phosphorus, are positively active, mostly stabilizing color. Analysis of the literature data [51 – 63, 69] concerning phosphite activity at lowtemperature oxidation (initiated self-induced oxidation of hydrocarbons and polyolefins) and behavior of polymers with phosphorus-containing additives at pyrolysis in the sub-flame zone
162
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
indicates possible mechanisms of phosphorus stabilizing activity. These mechanisms are taken into consideration in the analysis of PSF stabilization during processing: -
phosphorylation or other chemical interactions between SHP and PSF macromolecules or labile and oxidized structures; inhibition of high-temperature oxidation radical reactions; transition metal admixture deactivation; other mechanisms, for example, deactivation of electron-excited states.
Feasibility of the stabilization molecular mechanism was estimated by NMR analysis of AO-118 mixtures with oligosulfones (the polymerization degree 5 – 7), 4,4’dichlorodiphenylsulfone, or bisphenol A at 280 - 300°C in vacuum and in air. Under the condition of interaction with phosphite, high content of end OH- and Cl-groups in the oligomer and monomers provides for high resolution observation of phosphorylation by spectral methods. 13C NMR spectra of heat treated mixtures preserve substrate reflexes and their relations that testify about the absence of molecular interactions. On the other hand, heating leads to phosphite decomposition, e.g. hydrolysis to corresponded monophenol and acid pentaerythritol diphosphite, signals from which at 64.5 and 63.4 ppm indicate dominance of tautomeric, four-coordinated shape:
Phosphite additives to preliminarily degraded PSF and further heat treatment do not make the polymer color lighter and, according to IR spectra, have no effect on intensity of absorption bands associated with oxidized structures, for example, carbonyl groups. To put it differently, phosphorylation, noticeable, as the heat stabilization mechanism in other systems, for example, at PET and PMMA combustion and pyrolysis inhibition [76] or thermal oxidation of synthetic rubbers and vinylchloride polymers [63], is not observed during inhibited high-temperature PSF degradation. SHP high-temperature stabilization by additives show signs of radical inhibition: low effective concentrations (optimally, 1 – 1.5 mmol/kg), the efficiency O2 pressure (in the absence of O2 the efficiency is negligibly low). SHP decelerate the homolytical process of PSF macromolecule branching during thermal oxidation. Higher efficiency of cyclic SHP, compared with open ones, in the high-temperature oxidation process is, apparently, the general rule, because analogous dependence is displayed at PE high-temperature oxidation (Figure 21). This may be considered as the model of really radical, high-temperature process.
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
163
Figure 21. PE oxidation kinetics in the presence of SHP: AO-118 (1, 2), Stafor 11 (3, 4) and its acid ester (5, 6) without water absorption (1, 3, 5) and with water absorption (2, 4, 6); T = 200°C, P(O2) = 399.9 kPa
The increase of SHP effectiveness with hydrolysis probability (see Figure 16), shown in experiments with water linking, indicate the significant role of acid esters in inhibition of SHP hydrolysis products. Cycl;ic SHP of AO118 type possess chemical shift on 31P nuclei equal 115 – 120 ppm, whereas low-effective SHP of tris-(2,4-di-tert-butylphenol)phosphite and common triarylphosphites possess chemical shifts of about 130 ppm, and trialkylphosphites – 137 – 139 ppm. Since in all cases P-O bond is observed, i.e. at the first glance any change in electronegativity of the partner is absent and changes in SHP chemical shifts (at obvious absence of steric hindrances effect on the chemical shift) are associated with the differences in values of O-P-O-bond valent angles in cyclic and open SHP, in accordance with the definition of 31P chemical shift [81]: ∆δ = -с∆χα + k∆nπ + А∆Q, where ∆χα is the difference in electronegativity values of P-X-bonds; ∆nπ is the change in πelectron overlapping; ∆Q is the change of σ valent angles. The change of valent angles causes changes in configuration of the electron cloud around phosphorus nucleus, i.e. the nucleus screening is changed. Formally, the effect is adequate to the change in electronegativity of partners bonded with phosphorus. Chemical shifts on 1H, 13C and, apparently, 31P nuclei is inversely proportional to electronegativity of the partner nucleus [83], i.e. electronegativity of P is somehow reduced in the phosphite sequence: cyclic alkylene-aromatic > aromatic > aliphatic. Poling’s electronegativity of atoms P, C and O equals 2.1, 2.5 and 3.5, respectively [84], e.g. P-C-bond is possesses much higher polarity than C-O-bond and is hydrolytically sensitive. Bulky groups of the tert-butyl type in the ortho-position at the ester bond makes steric hindrances to hydrolysis (kinetic mechanism). Changes in valent angles in the six-term steric phosphites reduce polarity of the ester bond and, as a consequence, its hydrolyzing ability (thermodynamic mechanism). For cyclic SHP, both mechanisms of hydrolytic
164
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
stabilization are realized. Therefore, it is proved experimentally that these phosphites, for example, AO118 and Ultranox 626, are most resistant to hydrolysis [82]. Finally, hydrolysis of open phosphites, including open SHP, leads to H3PO3, which is low-effective hightemperature stabilizer. At hyfrolysis of cyclic SHP alkylene-ester structure is preserved (NMR data), and the final product (acid cyclic phosphite) is the effective high-temperature stabilizer. This was shown by direct comparison of effectiveness of Stafor 11 and its acid analogue, specially synthesized for tests. For example, tests performed on IIRT device at 320°C, Stafor 11 makes PSF color lighter, increasing the light transmittance index by 3 – 5 units. For PSF acid ester, this index is increased by 10 – 12 units, though differences in other indices are not so great. Indirectly, the radical mechanism of SHP stabilizing activity is confirmed by additive elimination of active degrading effect on PSF from the side DMSO. As shown by the strength of C-S-bonds in (CH3)2SO2, equal 264 kJ/mol [78], and higher total reactivity of sulfoxides compared with sulfones [85], DMSO is not heat resistant compound. At low temperature (about 100°C) molecular thermal cis-splitting happens with an olefin formation, though at higher temperatures homolytical C-S-bond break is suggested [85, p. 261]. Actually, over sixteen main products of DMSO degradation at PSF processing temperature (the ampoule technique) were detected by the mass-spectrometric method. The highest yields are observed for dimethyl disulfide, methyl ethyl sulfide, methyl and ethyl mercuptanes, 3-hydroxypropyl methyl sulfide, methylethoxymethylsulfide, and similar substances, which formation may be explained with respect to alkyl and alkylthio-radical recombination, as well as labile oxygen exchange reactions in semipolar sulfoxide group. As PSF is processed, DMSO residues play the role of an original radical initiator of degradation, and SHP addition eliminates this effect. The idea to deactivate metal admixtures, first of all, iron compounds by SHP additives follows from extremely much higher efficiency of SHP in "impure" samples compared with almost pure ones (Table 16). Table 16. The dependence of SHP effectiveness on polysulfone purity Sample
PSF with [Fe] = 5×10-5 wt.% The same sample after IIRT The same added by 0.3 wt.% АО118 PSF with [Fe] = 5×10-5 wt.% The same sample after IIRT The same added by 0.3 wt.% АО118
MFI10 min (320°С), g/10 min 3.5 4.3
3.7 4.2
MFI10 min/ MFI20 min
Mz×103
1.02 1.01
Light transmittance at 425 nm, % 73.0 78.0 73.0
99.5 94.0 98.0
1.5 1.05
60.0 68.0 63.0
87.0 58.0 80.0
If an iron compound (up to 0.005 wt.%) is injected to “pure” PSF, light transmittance will be decreased by 20 – 30 units, whereas subsequent injection of SHP reduces this effect significantly. On the other hand, PSF color may be stabilized in tests simulating processing of phosphorus-containing transition metal complexes by additives.
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
165
Figure 22. UV-spectra for chloroform solutions of AO-118 (1), ferrocene (2), and their mixture (3). Differential spectra: mixture – AO-118 (4), mixture-ferrocene (5); calculated additive AO-118-ferrocene spectrum (6)
Diphenylphosphonic salt additions (cations Co, Cr, Ni, Cu) up to 0.1 wt.% stabilize PSF similar to polyalkane imide, though these effects in PSF are not so high as in case of SHP use. The simplicity of phosphite interaction (AO-118, in particular) with transition metal compounds is shown by UV-spectra of AO-118 and model substance (ferrocene), and their mixture chloroform solutions (Figure 22). At room temperature phosphite and iron-containing model interact at once, which causes a noticeable deviation of experimental UV-spectrum from calculated (additive) one. This interaction represents an example of common complex-forming function of phosphorus compounds. With respect to the type of substitutes and coordination degree, phosphorus atom or phosphoryl oxygen is electron donor. The electron lone pairs of these atoms is transferred to empty or partly filled α-orbitals of neighboring atom of metal. Phosphorus-metal complexes are strongly bound due to relatively low potentials of phosphorus compound ionization and additional linking of π-electrons because of donor and acceptor (metal) vacant α-orbital overlapping [86]. The donor-acceptor interaction is one of the main mechanisms for metal compound extraction. The extraction ability correlates with the distribution of electron density in extracting agents, including phosphorus-organic compounds [87]. Correlations between effective extraction parameters defined by thermodynamics of the donor-acceptor bond and the so-called “effective charge” at phosphorus by which electron density distribution in
166
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
molecule is described, and associated parameters of substitute electronegativity with 31P NMR chemical shift as well. Generally, dependencies of the extraction effective constant (K) logarithm are linear: lgK = A – Bf, where A and B are constants defined by the metal type and parameter f; f is the parameter characterizing electron density, for example, by the sum of electronegativity values of substitutes at phosphorus atom. There are data [87] on effective charges on phosphorus atoms in many phosphorus-containing compounds. Effective charges are determined from X-ray diffraction patterns by the energetic shift of phosphorus absorption range boundaries. Iron admixtures significantly speed up thermal oxidation of all studied heat-resistant polymers. PCA injection fully eliminates this acceleration. Therefore, PCA stabilizing effect in heat-resistant polymers may be explained by metal admixture binding. The products of “model + stabilized” system (equimolar mixture of N-phenylphthalimide and BT-5) thermal transformation were analyzed with the help of NMR-spectroscopy technique. It is shown that at 250 - 300°C the model does not transform, and the stabilizer partly degrades forming diphenylamine, phenol, phosphoric acid and its condensation products. All these compounds are not stabilizers of PI, PAI, PPA and other compounds or display much lower stabilizing action than initial BT-5. As a consequence, the stabilizing action is defined by either the initial PCA structure or intermediate products of stabilizer transformation. The occurrence of ESR signal (a singlet with ∆H = 9.1 E and g = 2.0003) allows a suggestion that stabilizer thermal transformation products are of the radical origin. Emission extinguishing in PI film is observed by fluorescence spectra at 520 – 530 nm under the effect of BT-5 additive. The paramagnetism increase as a result of degradation in stabilized samples is much lower than in non-stabilized polymers. This is reproduced both in PI and PAI. Therefore, if electron excitation is considered as the oxidation initiation, endoperoxide formation, etc., thermal activation of the imide structure transfer to the electron-excited state in stabilized samples is hindered. Thus, the investigation performed allowed the exclusion from consideration unreliazable or weakly realizable PCA effect on heat-resistant polymer cyclization and crosslinking and detection of the most probable stabilization mechanisms – admixture bonding and inhibition of radical-chain oxidation processes. Optimal PCA concentrations of 2 – 5 wt.% in PI, PPQ, and PBO and 0.5 – 1.0 wt.% in PEI, PPA, PSF, and PAI, e.g. ~0.02 – 0.05 or 0.005 – 0.01 mol/base-mol, respectively. If one considers that the rate of translational diffusion of low-molecular substances in the rigid structure of heat-resistant polymers is low and may not provide the additive transport to the oxidation focus, it may be concluded that inhibition is possible only in the additive interaction with macromolecule and changes of its reactivity. Experiments with models did not display phosphorylation, i.e. direct interaction between the additive and aromatic heterocyclic structure. In this case, apparently, a polymer-additive complex is formed, which changes the macromolecule reactivity in relation to oxygen. The complex formation may change the electron state of the whole macromolecule or a large part of it, i.e. change the reactivity of it. Clearly, conjugation blocks (refer to [1 - 11]) are present in the macrochain: PDI in PI and PAI, PPP in PPQ and CPIPQ, amide-TPA in PPA, i.e. the products characterizing chain
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
167
conjugation. Their output at thermal oxidation is decreased by PCA injection, whereas carbon oxides yields are reduced by 1.5-2 times only. Thus, basing on the totality of experimental data on PCA stabilization one may conclude that the most probable stabilization mechanisms are additive deactivation, inhibition of radical oxidation processes and deactivation of electron-excited states.
REFERENCES [1]
[2]
[3]
[4]
[5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13] [14] [15] [16]
Narkon A.L., Levantovskaya I.I., Gur’yanova V.V. et al., ‘The effect of molecularmass distribution on thermal stability of polysulfone’, Vysokomol. Soed., 1986, vol. A28(3), pp. 505 – 509. (Rus) Badikova N.D., Militskova E.A., and Andrianova N.V., ‘Technological factors for obtaining optical polysulfone’, In Coll.: Production and Processing of Plastics and Synthetic Resins, Moscow, NIITEKhim, 1974, No. 10, pp. 54 – 57. (Rus) Badikova N.D., Militskova E.A., and Zelenina E.N., ‘The effect of precipitation method on light and technical properties of polysulfone’, In Coll.: Production and Processing of Plastics and Synthetic Resins, Moscow, NIITEKhim, 1977, No. 1, pp. 22 – 25. (Rus) Badikova N.D., Militskova E.A., and Andrianova N.V., ‘The effect of various end groups on light and heat resistance of polysulfone’, Plastmassy, 1976, No. 1, pp. 72 – 73. (Rus) Semenov N.N., On Some Problems of Chemical Kinetics and Reactivity (Free Radicals and Chain Reactions), 2nd Ed., Moscow, AN SSSR, 1958, 686 p. (Rus) Emanuel N.M., Denisov E.T., and Maizus Z.K., Chain Reactions of Hydrocarbons Oxidation in the Liquid Phase, Moscow, Nauka, 1965, 375 p. (Rus) Emanuel N.M. and Buchachenko A.L., Chemical Physics of Polymer Aging and Stabilization, Moscow, Nauka, 1982, 359 p. (Rus) Shlyapnikov Yu.A., Kiryushkin S.G., and Mar’in A.P., Antioxidant Stabilization of Polymers, Moscow, Khimia, 1986, 252 p. (Rus) Dashevskaya S.S., Akutin M.S., and Shlyapnikov Yu.A., ‘High-temperature oxidation of polysulfone’, Vysokomol. Soed., 1974, vol. B16(5),pp. 353 – 356. (Rus) Energies of Chemical Bond Break, Ionization Potentials and Affinity to Electron, Moscow, Nauka, 1974, 351 p. (Rus) Denisov E.T., Oxidation and Degradation of Carbochain Polymers, Moscow, Khimia, 1990, 286 p. (Rus) Perkins M., Free Radicals, N.Y.: Wiley, 1973, 231 p. Bagdasar’yan Kh.S., The Theory of Radical Polymerization, Moscow, Nauka, 1966, 252 p. (Rus) Chamberlain N.F., The Practice of NMR Spectroscopy, with Spectra- Structure Correlation for Hydrogen – 1, N.Y.: Plenum Press, 1974, 424 р. Bazilevsky M.V. and Piskun N.I., ‘The effect of substituents in radical hydrogen detachment in methyl group’, Zh. Fiz. Khim., 1965, vol. 39, pp. 762 - 770. (Rus) Minsker K.E. and Fedoseeva G.T., Degradation and Stabilization of Polyvinylchloride, 2nd Ed., Moscow, Khimia, 1979, 272 p. (Rus)
168
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
[17] Blyumenfeld A.B., ‘The study of thermal and thermal oxidative degradation of some polyethers’, Candidate Dissertation Thesis, Moscow, 1970. (Rus) [18] Narkon A.L., ‘The study of admixture, end group and molecular-mass characteristic effects on thermal stability of polysulfone’, Candidate Dissertation Thesis, Moscow, 1984. (Rus) [19] Kirpichnikov P.A, Mukmenyova N.A., and Cherkasova O.A., ‘Efficiency and mechanism of stabilizing effect of organic phosphorous acids in polymers’, Intern. J. Polym. Mater., 1990, vol. 14, рp. 41 - 52. [20] Van Krevelen D.V., Properties and Chemical Structure of Polymers, Moscow, Khimia, 1976, 415 p. (Rus) [21] Adorova I.V., Chernova A.G., Bulgakova M.A., Pinaeva N.K., and Siling M.I., ‘Chromatographic analysis of monomers in polycondensation products of pyromellitic dianhydride and dodecamethylene diamine’, In Coll.: Production and Processing of Plastics and Synthetic Resins, Moscow, NIITEKhim, 1979, No. 2, pp. 18 – 21. (Rus) [22] Kovarskaya B.M., Blyumenfeld A.B., and Levantovskaya I.I., Thermal Stability of Heterochain Polymers, Moscow, Khimia, 1977, 263 p. (Rus) [23] Blyumenfeld A.B., Levantovskaya I.I., and Annenkova N.G., ‘Problems of thermal stability and stabilization of heterochain polymers’, In Coll.: Progress in Science and Technology, Ser. Navy Chem. Technol., vol. 20, Moscow, VINITI, 1985, pp. 143 – 211. (Rus) [24] Patent No. 976680 (USSR), ‘Polysulfone-derived composite’, Publ. Jul. 21, 1980. (Rus) [25] US Patent No. 379,615, ‘Polysulfones stabilized by phosphoric compounds’, Publ. Feb. 22, 1972. [26] UK Patent No. 1,365,503, ‘Aromatic polymers’, Publ. Sept. 04, 1974. [27] Gladyishev G.P., Ershov Yu.A., and Shustova O.A., Stabilization of Heat-Resistant Polymers, Moscow, Khimia, 1979. [28] Novotortseva T.N., ‘High-Temperature Stabilization of Polybenzoxazole’, Candidate Dissertation Thesis, Moscow, 1987. (Rus) [29] Patent No. 45-29392 (Japan), ‘PSF composition’, Publ. Aug. 25, 1970. [30] Voevodsky V.V., Physics and Chemistry of Elementary Chemical Processes, Moscow, Nauka, 1969, 414 p. (Rus) [31] Neiman M.B., Aging and Stabilization of Polymers, Moscow, Nauka, 1964, 332 p. (Rus) [32] Kuz’minsky A.S., Oxidation of Caoutchoucs and Rubbers, Moscow, Goschimizdat, 1957, 319 p. (Rus) [33] Grassi N., Chemistry of Polymer Degradation Processes, Moscow, Inostrannaya Literatura, 1959, 252 p. (Rus) [34] Madorsky S., Thermal Degradation of Organic Polymers, Moscow, Mir, 1967, 320 p. (Rus) [35] Sing K., and Dreg S., Absorption, Surface, Porosimetry, Moscow, 1984. [36] US Patent No. 3,551,200, ‘Wire insulation derived from poly-1,12-dodecamethylene1,13-tridecamethylene pyromellitimide, Publ. December 29, 1968 (cl. 117-232). [37] US Patent No. 3,714,116, Polyimide composite, Publ Aug. 30, 1970 (cl. 121-232). [38] Batsanov S.S., Electronegativity of Elements and Chemical Bonding, Novosibirsk, Izd. Sib. AN SSSR, 1962, 195 p. (Rus)
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
169
[39] Garnovsky A.D., Sandimenko A.P., Osipov O.A., and Tsinisadze G.V., Soft-Strong Interactions in Coordination Chemistry, Rostov-na-Donu, Izd. Rostov University, 1986, 257 p. (Rus) [40] Volozhin A.I., Prokopchuk N.R., Yakimtsova A.B., Krut'ko E.T., and Solntsev A.P., ‘Thermal stability of poly(4,4’-diphenyloxide)pyromellitimide of bicycle-(2,2’,1)-hept5-ene-2,3-dicarboxylic acid’, Vestsi AN BSSR, Ser. Khim. Nauk, 1988, No. 5, pp. 109 111. (Rus) [41] Bryik M.T. and Danilenko E.E., ‘Complex formation in synthesis of metal-containing polyimides’, Ukr. Khim. Zhurnal, 1988, vol. 54(4), pp. 355 - 358. (Rus) [42] Polymer Stabilization, Ed. W.L. Hewkins, N.Y.: Wiley, 1972, 201 p. [43] Osawa L., The role of metals and metal-deactivators in polymer degradation, Polym. Stab., 1988, vol. 20(3-4), рp. 203 - 236. [44] Larin G.M., Umarov B.B., Minin V.V., Rakitin Yu.V., Yusupov V.G., Parshev N.A., and Buslaev Yu.A., ‘Anti-ferromagnetic exchange by O-bond chain in binuclear copper(II) complexes’, Doklady AN SSSR, 1988, vol. 303(1), pp. 139 - 143. (Rus) [45] Kazaryan L.G., Azriel A.E., Vasil’ev V.A., Annenkova N.G., Pinaeva N.K., and Chernova A.G., “Structure and properties of polyalkanimide’, Vysokomol. Soed.,1988, vol. A30(3), pp. 644 – 647. (Rus) [46] Smirnov L.A., ‘Increasing heat and light resistance of caproic fiber with the help of polymer stabilization by metal-containing organic compounds’, Candidate Dissertation Thesis, Moscow, 1969. (Rus) [47] Korshak V.V., Chemical Structure and Temperature Characteristics of Polymers, Moscow, Nauka, 1970, 419 p. (Rus) [48] Sekacheva I.V., Solyankin I.N., Pinaeva N.K., Koshel’ G.N., Kryukova G.G., Kozlova O.S., and Smirnova O.M., ‘Synthesis and identification of salts from pyromellitic acid and 1,12-dodecamethylene diamine, Sb. Yaroslavskogo Politekhnicheskogo Instituta, 1990. (Rus) [49] Mukmeneva N.A., Akhmadulina A.G., Sabirova L.Kh., and Kirpichnikov P.A., ‘Intensification of the stabilizing efficiency of phosphoric ethers by four-valent titanium compounds during low density polyethylene oxidation’, Vysokomol. Soed., 1976, vol. B18, pp. 108 - 115. (Rus) [50] Pobedimsky D.G., Grossman G., Kondratyeva T.N., Cherkasova O.A., Scheller D., Mukmeneva N.A., and Kirpichnikov P.A., In: Proc. 4th International Symposium on Homogeneous Catalysis, Leningrad, 1984. (Rus) [51] Arbuzov B.V., Polezhaeva N.A., Vinogradova V.S., Polozova G.I., and Musina A.A., ‘Structure and properties of interaction products of benzylidene benzoyl acetate with trimethylphosphite and dimethylphosphoric acid, Izv. AN SSSR, Ser. Khim., 1974, No. 9, pp. 2071 – 2075. (Rus) [52] Pobedimsky D.G., Mukmeneva N.A., and Kirpichnikov P.A., In: Developments in Polymer Stabilization, Ed. Scott G., London.: Appl. Sci. Publ., 1980, vol. 2, 125 р. [53] Mukmeneva N.A., Minsker K.S., Kolesov S.V., and Kirpichnikov P.A., Doklady AN SSSR, 1984, vol. 274(6), pp. 1393 – 1396. (Rus) [54] Kirpichnikov P.A., Mukmeneva N.A., and Pobedimsky D.G., ‘Phosphorus-organic stabilizers of polymers – efficiency and mechanism’, Uspekhi Khimii, 1983, vol. 52(11), pp. 1831 – 1851. (Rus)
170
E. V. Kalugina, K. Z. Gumargalieva and G. E. Zaikov
[55] Mukmeneva N.A., Gol’denberg A.L., and Lazareva N.P., ‘Interaction between phosphoric acid ethers and carboxylic groups in polyethylene’, Vysokomol. Soed., 1983, vol. A25(6),pp. 1302 – 1306. (Rus) [56] Pobedimsky D.G., Kirpichnikov P.A., and Denisov E.T., ‘About reactions of phosphorus-organic inhibitors with hydroperoxide groups and polyethylene peroxide radicals’, Vysokomol. Soed., 1976, vol. A18, pp. 2650 - 2658. (Rus) [57] Hudson R., Structure and Mechanism of Reactions with Phosphorus-Organic Compounds, Moscow, Mir, 1967, 361 p. (Rus) [58] Mukmeneva N.A., Sharifulin A.Sh., Eliseeva L.A., and Iskhakov O.A., ‘Phosphorusorganic inhibitors of polymeric material combustion’, Proc. 6th All-Union Conf. Combustion of Polymeric Materials, Suzdal’, Nov. 29 – Dec. 01, 1988, Rep. Thes., Moscow, 1988, pp. 156 - 157. (Rus) [59] Ruger C., Konig T., and Schwetlick. K., ‘Phosphororganische Antioxidatien. 6. Einflus Cyclischer Phosphite auf die Radikalisch initierte Oxidation von Kolenwasserstoffen und Polymeren’, Acta Polymerica,1986.-Bd. 37(7), S. 435 - 438. [60] Schwetlick K., Konig T., Ruger C., Pionteck J., and Habicher W.D., ‘Chain-breaking antioxidant activity of phosphite ester’, Polym. Degrad. Stability, 1986, vol. 15, p. 97 108. [61] Schwetlick K., Konig T., Pionteck J., Sasse D., and Habicher W.D., ‘Organophosphorus antioxidants. 9. Inhibition of the oxidation of hydrocarbons by hindered aryl phosphites’, Polym. Degrad. Stability, 1988, vol. 22(4), pp. 357 - 373. [62] Lebedeva L.P. and Levin P.I., ‘Antioxidant efficiency of phosphites and their mixtures’, Vysokomol. Soed., 1982, vol. B24(5), pp. 379 – 383. (Rus) [63] Mukmeneva N.A., ‘Phosphorylation as the way of increasing stability of polymers’, Proc. 8th All-Union School-Seminar on Organoelement Compounds, Moscow, INEOS AN SSSR, 1984, 22 p. (Rus) [64] Kalugina E.V., ‘Thermal transformations and stabilization of some heat-resistant heterochain polymers’, Candidate Dissertation Thesis, Moscow, 1992. [65] Vdovina A.L., ‘Thermal Transformations and Stabilization of Polypyromellitimide, Polyphenylquinoxaline and Copolyimidophenyl-quinoxalines’, Candidate Dissertation Thesis, Moscow, 1988. (Rus) [66] Korshak V.V., Different Unit Composition of Polymers, Moscow, Nauka, 1977, 302 p. (Rus) [67] Kandratiev V.N. and Nikitin E.E., Chemical Processes in Gases, Moscow, Nauka, 1981, 262 p. (Rus) [68] Atlas of ESR Spectra – Spin Labels and Probes, Ed. A.L. Buchachenko, Moscow, Nauka, 1977, 159 p. (Rus) [69] Gamino G., Martinasso G., and Costa L., ‘Thermal degradation of pentaeritritol diphosphat model compound for fire retardant intumescent systems. 1. Overall thermal degradation, Polym. Degrad. Stab., 1990, vol. 27(2), рp. 285 - 269. [70] Suebsaeng T., Wilkie C.A., Burger V.T., Carter J., and Brown C.E., ‘Solid products from thermal decomposition of polyethylenterephtalate of investigation by CP/Mass, 13 C-NMR and Fourier transform IR-spectroscopy’, Eur. Polym. J., 1981, vol. 17(2), pp. 1259 - 1263. [71] Becher C.H., Troer K., and Croleva A., ‘Thermal properties P-contents PETF’, Eur. Polym. J., 1981, vol. 17(2), pp. 1259 - 1263.
Practical Stabilization of Heat Resistant Polymers
171
[72] Troer K., Grozeva A., and Borisov G., ‘Introduction of phosphorus into the PETmolecule via 1,2-dicarbomethoxyethyl phosphate’, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1981, vol. 17(1), pp. 27 - 33. [73] Wilkie C., Pettegrew J., and Brown C., ‘Pyrolysis reactions of poly(methyl methacrylate) and red phosphorus: an investigation with cross-polarization, magic angle NMR-spectroscopy’ J. Polym. Sci.: Polym. Lett. Ed., 1981, vol. 19, pp. 409 - 414. [74] Day M. and Wiles D., ‘Temperature influence on thermal degradation of fiber PETF, one fire retardant tris(2,3-dibromopropyl)-phosphate’, J. Anal. and Appl. Pyrol., 1984, No. 7, pp. 65 - 82. [75] Inagaku N., Sakurai S., and Katsuura K., ‘Affect tris(2,3-bromo-propyl) phosphate with flame retardant of polystyrene’, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1979, vol. 23, pp. 2023 - 2030. [76] Brown C., Wilkie C., Smukalla J., and Cody B., ‘Inhibition by red phosphorus of unimolecular thermal chain scission in poly(methyl methacrylate): investigation by NMR, FT-IR and laser decomposition/ Fourier transform mass spectroscopy, J. Polym. Sci.: Polym. Chem. Ed., 1986, vol. 24, pp. 1297 - 1311. [77] Day M. and Willes D., ‘Combustion and pyrolysis of poly(ethylene terephthalate). 1. The role of flame retardants in products pyrolysis’, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1981, vol. 26, pp. 3085 - 3091. [78] Kibrey A. and Warren S., Organic Chemistry of Phosphorus, Moscow, Mir, 1967, Ch. 4. (Rus) [79] Bentrude W.G., In: Free Radicals, Ed. Kochi J., N.Y.: Wiley, 1973, р. 22. [80] Ingold K. and Roberts B., Free-radical Substitution Reactions, Moscow, Mir, 1974, pp. 133 - 149. (Rus) [81] Gorestein D., Phosphorus-31 NMR- Principles and Applications, N.Y.: Academic Press, 1984, 14 р. [82] Spivack J., Pastor S., and Patrl A., Polym. St. J., 1984, рp. 247 - 257. [83] Ionin B.I., Ershov B.A., and Kol’tsov A.I., NMR-Spectroscopy in Organic Chemistry, Leningrad, Khimia, 1983, 269 p. (Rus) [84] Gordon A. and Ford R, Chemist Companion, Moscow, Mir, 1976, 541 p. (Rus) [85] Sigeru Oae, Chemistry of Sulfur Organic Compounds, Moscow, Khimia, 1975, Ch. 6. (Rus) [86] Gur’yanova E.N., Gol’dstein I.P., and Romm I.P., The Donor-Acceptor Bond, Moscow, Khimia, 1973, 338 p. (Rus) [87] Mazalov L.N. and Dyumatov V.D., Electronic Structure of Extragents, Novosibirsk, Nauka, 1984, 196 p. (Rus)
In: Polymer Reactivity ISBN 1-60021-263-8 Editors: G. E. Zaikov and B. A. Howell, pp. 173-184 © 2006 Nova Science Publishers, Inc.
Chapter 4
HETEROPHASE SUPRAMOLECULAR MODEL OF PHOTOCHEMICAL TRANSFORMATION OF NAPHTHALENE IN CELLULOSE TRIACETATE Yu. A. Mikheev and V. G. Zaikov N.M.Emanuel Institute of Biochemical Physics Russian Academy of Sciences, 4, Kosygin st., Moscow 119991, Russia
Naphthalene excitation by UV-light in glassy cellulose triacetate films induces formation of polymeric free radicals, polymer chain break and addition of naphthalene fractures to macromolecules. In the absence of oxygen, the naphthalene consumption rate increases in direct proportion to UV-light intensity, whereas the rate of polymeric chain breaks varies in proportion to quadratic intensity. The process is initiated by singly excited triplet naphthalene molecules localized in the structural matrix zones, where they are incapable of irradiative deactivation. The features of phototransformation are explained in the framework of the hetero-nanophase kinetic model of the process, taking into account the radiationless translation of triplet excitation energy to naphthalene molecules present in the zones, where sensitization is absent and only triplet state deactivation is performed. Kinetics of the photochemical naphthalene (N) transformation in evacuated glass CTA films does not comply with homogeneous reaction models. In works published over 25 years ago [1 – 3], it has been found that triplet-excited NT molecules are initiators of this process, which itself is slowed down with N concentration increase. The observed concentration effect was explained with the help of a simplified scheme, according to which chemical acts proceed with participation of NT molecules in structurally separate zones of the matrix favorable for implementation of sensitization acts. The same chemically active NT molecules are also donors of energy for unexcited N molecules, located in the matrix zones unfavorable for sensitization. Realization of the radiationless T – T translation of excitation energy between naphthalene molecules, present in heterogeneous zones of the nanostructural scale, makes this aromatic compound the process sensitizer, as well as active NT molecule extinguisher.
174
Yu. A. Mikheev and V. G. Zaikov
The study was aimed at specification and systematizing of kinetic regularities for a photochemical naphthalene transformation in glass CTA combined with the kinetics of induced degradation and modification of macromolecules and, based on this, at development of a kinetic model of the process using the ideas of supramolecular heterogeneousheterophase reactions, developed in [4, 5].
EXPERIMENTAL The polymer (CTA, M = 3.3×105, acetate number 62.5), prepared as a cotton-wool by reprecipitation, was thoroughly purifies from aromatic additives by extraction by methanol. Analytically pure naphthalene was additionally sublimated. Films 6 – 20 µm thick were prepared from polymer and naphthalene solution in methylene chloride. The solution was distributed by the silicate glass surface and the solvent evaporated. After solvent removal, the films were stratified by water and dried in vacuum during 24 hours. Film samples were placed to a quartz cuvette which allows test performance in vacuum –4 (10 – 10–6 Pa), in air and xenon under temperature-stabilized conditions. For the light source, high-pressure mercury lamp DRSh-500 was used. Naphthalene (N) dissolved in CTA films was excited by filtered light not absorbed by the polymer (ν < 33,000 cm−1, λ > 300 nm). In this spectrum region, optical density of the samples was below 0.1 that provided for uniform light absorption in the sample thickness. The phototransformation was searched for by changes in UV absorption spectra which were measured by a Specord UV-VIS instrument. UV-radiation intensity was controlled with the help of ferrioxalate technique. Relative quantum yields of naphthalene consumption (γN,0) were calculated by the initial parts of kinetic curves. Luminescence spectra of N in CTA films were recorded on a spectrofluorimeter Jobin and Ivon (France). Fluorescence decay kinetics was recorded on a pulse fluorometer with the pulse lamp flash duration of 3 ns, In the mode of photon counting with the help of a multichannel pulse analyzer Nokia (model LP-4050). The number of macromolecule breaks n was determined viscosimetrically, using methylene chloride : methanol mixture (94 : 6). The calculations were performed by the equations: [η] = 0.016 M–0.76 and n=
M0 − Mt . Mt
Heterophase Supramolecular Model of Photochemical Transformation …
M
175
Preliminarily, it was found that macromolecule polydispersity index w ≈ 1.2 is Mn practically invariable during photosensitized degradation. The number n was determined by dissolving several samples, obtained during equal times. The relative quantum yield of polymeric chain breaks (γN,0) was calculated as the ratio of the number of breaks at the reaction beginning and the initial N concentration. The technique for determination of the rate of structural-mechanical damage of the films at photosensitization of polymeric chain breaks was also used. The rate of such damage was found from the durability isotherms, characterizing polymeric films in a definite range of mechanical stress (σ, kg/mm2). The film samples (width 5 mm and length between clips 22 mm) were loaded on a device with a shaped lever which supported constant σ during the experiment, and the time period τ (s) to degradation was determined [6]. Loaded samples were UV-light radiated in a flow quartz Dewar vessel in temperature-stabilized flows of dried air or nitrogen, purified from oxygen additive.
RESULTS The change of UV absorption of CTA films containing naphthalene in concentrations 1.4, 0.1 and 2.9% by light with λ >300 nm (ν < 33,000 cm-1) at room temperature and 91°C were show. In all cases, formation of the reaction products absorbing light in the UV-region of the spectrum up to λ ~ 380 nm was observed. Isobestic points (the cross-points of spectral lines) typical of this process were preserved to high transformation stages. This indicated invariability of the composition of products accumulated during the reaction. Taking into account the features of absorption spectra changes, one may conclude about products of two types’ formation in the reaction (A and B). One (A) absorbs light relatively intensively in the range of ν = 40,000 − 27,000 cm−1. Another one (B) possesses an insignificant absorption in the range. A mixture of compounds A and B is thermally stable, because heating of CTA films with the products during 3 hours at 90°C does not change their UV absorption spectrum. However, the former product A is photolyzed by light with λ > 320 nm (ν < 31,300 cm-1), moreover, in the presence of air photodegradation proceeds at a higher rate than in vacuum. In both cases, compounds with insufficient light absorption in the range of λ > 260 nm (ν < 38,000 cm-1) are formed. It was found [1] that phototransformation products of naphthalene were not extracted by methanol from the films, whereas the primary N was easily washed out from the films even 200 µm thick. Polymer re-precipitation with photolysis products, performed after N residues removal by methanol (solvent CH2Cl2, precipitator – methanol : water = 2 : 1 mixture), indicated addition of the phototransformation products to macromolecules. The absorption spectrum shape of reaction products accumulated at various temperatures and different initial N concentrations remain practically the same in the range λ > 260 nm. The ratio of optical densities
176
D(36,100 cm -1 ) D(31,250 cm -1 )
Yu. A. Mikheev and V. G. Zaikov
= 3.5,
obtained from this spectrum, was taken for a conversion factor in composing kinetic curves of N consumption. Typical kinetic curves of N consumption and accumulation of UV-absorbing reaction products (A), obtained at sample preparation in vacuum (λ > 300 nm) at different initial N concentrations were composed. It has been found that temperature does not practically affect the rate of N consumption, but it decreases the rate of products A. The effective activation energy of their accumulation, calculated by the initial parts of kinetic curves, is negative ≈-5 kcal/mol (-21 kJ/mol). Moreover, for evacuated samples a dependence of the initial rate of N phototransformation and product A accumulation on the spectral composition of light was observed. For example, as CTA films with 0.5% naphthalene concentration are radiated through an interference light filter (wavelengths λ > 340 nm are not transmitted), the quantum yield1 of N consumption equals 0.3×10–2. At the same time, in the case of another filter used, the quantum yield increased to 1.2×10–2. It should be emphasized that the first filter transmits light not only in the region of N absorption, but also 10 times more intense long-wavelength light with λ > 340 nm, not absorbed by naphthalene and cut off by another filter. The presence of the long-wavelength IV-radiation also leads to an increase of the initial rate of product A accumulation (by 2 times, approximately). The effect of long-wavelength UV-light was proved on the samples containing 0.5% N, using two light sources (mercury lamps DRSh-500, equipped with light filters), one of which transmitted light with λ > 290 nm, and another with λ > 340 nm. The rate of N consumption at simultaneous radiation of samples in vacuum is 1.5-fold higher than that under the effect of only one light source with λ > 290 nm. Under these conditions, the rate of the product A accumulation is significantly increased. In the presence of air oxygen, the rates of photochemical N consumption and product A accumulation are noticeably decreased (by 10 times, approximately), as well as the rate of polymeric chain break accumulation [1, 2]. Hence, the effect of the long-wavelength light with λ > 340 nm is almost completely neglected. The inert gas xenon acts similar to oxygen (after preliminary evacuation, an ampoule with the film was filled with xenon to 1 atm pressure). Isotherms of mechanical degradation of the films (plotted in lgτ - σ coordinates) under photosensitization conditions in air and nitrogen were obtained. Both isotherms possess linear intersects described by the equation lgτ = lgA – ασ. Both lines possess equal coefficients α, but different coefficients A. The latter correspond to durability obtained by extrapolation of linear parts of the isotherms on the axis of ordinates. In these experiments 1/A value was taken for the rate of the structural-mechanical damage of the samples, and the relative quantum yield of the damage γd were determined [3, 6] as the 1
The quantum yield was calculated as a relation of the number of reacted N molecules and the number of light quanta, absorbed by naphthalene in the spectral region under consideration.
Heterophase Supramolecular Model of Photochemical Transformation …
177
ration 1/A[N]). Clearly the process of structural mechanical damage is significantly slowed down under the effect of air. It is common knowledge that air oxygen effectively decays fluorescence of triplet naphthalene NT in solid polymers [7]. Xenon also deactivates NT in solid solutions [8]. Thus an assumption follows that triplet-excited NT is the primary active particle in CTA films. The corresponded fact was proved in the studies of N luminescence in CTA films [2]. Characteristic time of fluorescence decay in the films was constant, equal 95 ± 5 ns in air and in vacuum in the range of naphthalene concentration 0.25 – 6.7%. The same films possessed an intense fluorescence in vacuum; however, in air it was not detected due to high rate of NT deactivation. Thus it may be concluded that photoexcited naphthalene state reacting with the polymer is the triplet one. Hence, for the current photochemical reaction the presence of quite typical feature shall be outlined. The fast is that the concentration increase of N in evacuated films from 0.2 to 2% causes equal, 6-fold decrease of initial quantum yields of N consumption (γN,0), polymeric chain breaks (γn0), and structural-mechanical damage (γd) of the films under mechanical stress. The concentration slowing down of the mentioned processes is described by the empirical equation:
γi =
const i1 . const i 2 + const i 3 [ N ]
Similar event also takes place in aerated films, where photochemical process proceeds much slower that in vacuum. At the same time, despite slowing down of the reaction with [N] increase, the characteristic time of fluorescence decay varies insignificantly: in the N concentration range of 0.025 – 0.5%, it is constant and equals q.8 s, and at concentrations 1 and 2% it is 1.66 and 1.3 s, respectively. The experimental results under consideration indicate the dual role of triplet-excited NT. While NT molecules responsible for fluorescence are fully decayed under the effect of oxygen, NT molecules responsible for sensitization of chemical acts are just partly deactivated by oxygen and xenon (the phototransformation, though significantly slowed down, yet proceeds at enough high rate). Moreover, the concentration slowing down of the photochemical process is performed without any connection to the characteristic time and naphthalene fluorescence intensity. A variation of durability of CTA films with naphthalene at different UV-radiation intensities showed that the rate of the structural-mechanical damage in air is in direct proportion to the radiation intensity. At the same time, in nitrogen (at constant coefficient α) the quadratic dependence of structural-mechanical damage on UV-radiation intensity is observed. The quadratic dependence on UV-radiation intensity was also observed for the rate process of sensitized breaks of macromolecules in evacuated unloaded films [3].
178
Yu. A. Mikheev and V. G. Zaikov
DISCUSSION Kinetic Scheme of Phototransformation Such features as the quadratic dependence of the macromolecular break rate on UVradiation intensity, the effect of addition long-wavelength light on the rates of naphthalene consumption and reaction product A accumulation in evacuated CTA films, as well as oxygen-induced disappearing of these features, for the first glance, might be associated with the fact that active photoexcited state of naphthalene occurs as a result of the second quantum of light absorption by triplet NT. This very assumption was made in [9], where the rate increase of PMMA macromolecule breaks induced by the long wavelength light, not absorbed by naphthalene. However, the mentioned reaction features in evacuated CTA films are displayed simultaneously with direct proportion of the naphthalene consumption rate and accumulation of the product A, absorbing UV-light. This fact allows an exclusion of participation of twofold excited triplet states of N. In this case, according to the authors’ point of view, the attention should be paid to secondary photochemical reactions of free radicals formed at NT interaction with CTA macromolecules. The totality of the above-enumerated regularities can be explained with the help of the heterophase kinetic scheme of the reaction, in accordance with which the concentration slowing down of the photoprocess is provided by active NT molecule decaying by unexcited N molecules. This is possible in the only case, if sensitization acts proceed in s-zones suitable for this purpose (these zones are the zones of supernanopores, the concentration of which in the polymer is low [5]), i.e. with participation of NT molecules. Simultaneously, phosphorescence acts and its decay by oxygen proceed in v-zones (the zones of incapacious nanopores [5]) unsuitable for sensitization, i.e. with participation of NvT molecules. (The part of v-nanopores in the polymer is high; they accumulate the main amount of additive molecules.) The photoprocess possesses the maximal initial rate and proceeds at room temperature to high transformation stages. This indicates quite high exchange rate of N molecules between zones. The reduced supramolecular scheme of anaerobic photoreaction includes the stages present below: 1. Naphthalene molecule exchange between v- and s-zones: Nv ↔ Ns (it is assumed that its equilibrium is not disturbed by the reaction, thus the following relationships are applicable: [Ns] = α[Nv] = [Nv] =
α [ N] ≈ αN, 1+α
[ N] ≈ N, 1+α
Heterophase Supramolecular Model of Photochemical Transformation …
179
which reflect the small part of Ns molecules: α << 1). 2. Excitation of naphthalene molecules to Tv-state and subsequent irradiative and radiationless deactivation of excited molecules: Nv + hν → NvS, NvS → Nv + hνfluoresc, NvS ~~→ NvT, NvT → Nv + hνfluoresc, NvT ~→ Nv (conversion to heat). 3. Naphthalene excitation into chemically active Ts-state: k
0 , hν Ns + hν ~~ → NsT,
where k0,hν = γTI0εN is the rate constant under the assumption of monochromatic light effect; γT is the quantum yield of T-states; I0 is the intensity of exciting monochromatic UV-light; εN is the light absorption coefficient of naphthalene. 4. Deactivation of an active state by radiationless energy transfer: k
1 Ns + NvT. NsT + Nv →
5. H atom detachment from macromolecules and formation of hydronaphthyl radical middle macroradical couple: k ′ ( PH ) = k
2 2 → {•NH + P•}s, NsT
where
6. Primary radical pair transformations: k
3 {•NH + P•}s → PNH (recombination with product B1 formation);
k
4 , hν {•NH + P•}s → {•NH + P•*}s → {•NH + R•}s + n → RNH
180
Yu. A. Mikheev and V. G. Zaikov
(photoexcitation of the middle radical Ps• and further occurrence of a macromolecule break (n), end radical Rs• and the recombination product B2; here constant k4,hν = γ4I0ε4; γ4 and ε4 are the quantum yield of breaks and light absorption coefficient of macroradical, respectively);
(long-wavelength UV-light absorption (ν’, intensity I1) by hydronaphthyl radical; subsequent disclosure of one ring in hydronaphthyl radical with formation of {=NH• + P•} radical pair and recombination transformation of this pair to unsaturated compound A1; k5,hν′ = γАI1εNH˙is the rate constant, written down in the suggestion of monochromatic light). 7. Speeding up of naphthalene consumption induced by long-wavelength UV-light (I1) may be associated with accepting of N molecules by radical pairs: k
7 {•NNH + P•}s → HNNP (A2). {=NH• + P•}s + Ns →
Applying the steady state concentration to active particles in the current scheme (and accounting for the inequality k3 > (k4,hν + k5,hν′), the following expressions can be easily deduced: naphthalene consumption rate
wN =
k 7 k 5,hν ′ d [ N] k 2 k 0,hν [ N] = , 1 + dt k 2 + k1[ N] k 3 (k 6 + k 7α [ N])
γN ~
wN ; [N]
macromolecule break rate: wn =
αk 2 k 4,hν k 0,hν [ N] (k 2 + k1[ N])k 3
~ I 02 ,
Heterophase Supramolecular Model of Photochemical Transformation …
γn ~
181
wn ; [N]
the accumulation rate of unsaturated A1 and A2 products: wA =
αk 2 k 5,hν ′ k 0,hν [ N] (k 2 + k1[ N])k 3
.
The above-shown expressions explain the effect of additional long-wavelength UV-light on N consumption rate and the rate of product A accumulation (including A1 and A2 products), as well as the presence of a quadratic dependence of the macromolecule break rate on UV-radiation intensity in the spectral region of naphthalene absorption. Therefore, the direct proportionality of initial rates wN,0 and wA,0 to I0 must be fulfilled due to large enough spectral interval between long-wavelength absorption bands of naphthalene and hydronaphthyl radicals: hν′ < hν. The presence of constant k3 in denominators of expressions for wn and wA may be responsible for low negative activation energies observed: En, EA ≈ −21 kJ/mol. The reduced scheme under consideration complies with the regularities of anaerobic phototransformation of naphthalene (the detailed scheme must take into account the fact that middle radicals with a free valence in positions C1 andC2 on glucopyranose rings participate in macromolecule break acts). It accounts for enough fast migration of initiator molecules in glassy CTA matrix. N migration restores sensitizing Ns molecules, provides for bimolecular deactivation of NsT triplets and formation of grafted naphthalene groups on macromolecules. In the presence of oxygens in the films, the latter oxidizes •NH and =NH• radicals, inhibiting formation of A and B products. It also completely decays NvT states and NsT ones incompletely, probably, because of non-equivalence of physical properties of these particles, located in different structural zones of the matrix.
The Display of Non-Equivalence of Additive Molecule Properties in Heterogeneous Nanophases In accordance with the above-considered supramolecular scheme of the photoprocess, additive compounds, occurring in heterogeneous structural zones of glassy polymer matrix, acquire unequal physical properties. This fact is clearly displayed in unequal ability of aromatic compounds to phosphoresce, if they are injected to glassy films by different methods, namely, from combined solution by volatile solvent evaporation (films 1) and by additive absorption from the vapor phase (films 2). In this connection, tests on photoexcitation of phosphorescence of naphthalene, α-naphthol and diphenyl in CTA and PMMA films, placed to the inert gas CO2, may be the demonstrative experiment [10]. For example, if UV-light, exciting aromatic compound molecules, is removed (300 < λ < 385 nm), then films 1 prepared from the combined solution of the polymer and an additive in methylene chloride display bright phosphorescence, decaying during 3 s, approximately. In
182
Yu. A. Mikheev and V. G. Zaikov
the case of naphthalene, phosphorescence is green (λmax = 495 nm, τphosphoresc. = 1.7 s); αnaphthol gives green phosphorescence, too; diphenyl gives blue light. On the contrary, the initially pure glassy films are transformed as a result of absorption of the above-mentioned compounds to films 2, which under equal conditions do not phosphoresce. Moreover, the films of both types also differ by the rates of photochemical transformation of naphthalene in air (λ > 300 nm, 22°С, N desorption level during photochemical reaction is negligibly small): the photoreaction rate in films 1 is much lower than in films 2. The mentioned results correlate with the above heterophase-kinetic model of the process. For example, phosphorescing triplets NT are observed in the films 1 only (it is assumed that they are located in incapacious nanopores and do not participate in sensitization of the photoprocess). In such aerated films, the rate of phototransformation is relatively low, but the process proceeds owing to N molecule exchange between zones. As mentioned above, in the films 2 in the absence of oxygen phosphorescence is not observed, however, in air the photoprocess rate is high. It may be suggested that absorbed N molecules in them are almost completely localized in zones with supernanopores (this suggestion is testified by the fact that the naphthalene desorption rate from films 2 is much higher than from films 1 [10]). The absence of phosphorescence in them indicates the existence of sufficient structural hindrances for naphthalene displacement to incapacious nanopore zones. At the same time, quite rapid exchange of naphthalene between zones is typical of films 1; it provides for the photoprocess proceeding (but naphthalene desorption from the zones proceeds at extremely low rate [10]). A combination of the mentioned facts indicates the effect of dissolved additive on the self-organization of polymeric chains to a supramolecular hetero-nanophase carcass-micellar system at formation of the films during volatile solvent evaporation. It may be believed that glassy films 1 differ from films 2 by more perfect (less permeable) walls of the paracrystalline carcass and, simultaneously, by higher dynamics of spongy micelle units in carcass cells [11, 12]. The nonequivalence of the rates of photosensitized reactions in heterogeneous nanophases of glassy polymers is proved in experiments with naphthalene phosphorescence decay. For example, it is shown [13] that in aerated PMMA films fluorescence of singletexcited naphthalene molecules NS can be decayed by tinuvin P, but this does not affect the rate of naphthalene dissociation. The latter is consumed in the process, the rate of which is not defined by the concentration of particles responsible for fluorescence. Under such conditions, according to definition by the authors [13], primary chemical acts are inevitable. However, in the absence of oxygen tinuvin P slows the photochemical process down in accordance with a decrease of singlet-excited naphthalene molecule concentration. Based on their results, the authors [13] have suggested that the inevitable reaction proceeds in matrix cells of a specific structure. Varying oxygen concentration in the films, the authors found that oxygen did not participate directly in the inevitable reaction act. Meanwhile, in the absence of oxygen the inevitable reaction was not observed. Transferring to terms of the considered hetero-nanophase model, one may give the following qualitative description of the mentioned facts. Similar to the case of CTA, primary chemical acts in PMMA films proceed in supernanopores, in which additive molecules spend the main time adsorbed to the walls. Adsorbed NsT molecules also sensitize chemical acts in the presence of oxygen, because they
Heterophase Supramolecular Model of Photochemical Transformation …
183
are deactivated by oxygen less effectively compared with NvT molecules (the latter are present in incapacious nanopore zones saturated with oxygen). The zones of incapacious nanopores accumulate the main amount of additive compounds and directly in them fluorescing naphthalene molecules NvS are decayed by tinuvin P. Phosphorescing NvT molecules are formed from fluorescing NvS molecules, resulting the S→T conversion of electron excitation energy, and in the presence of oxygen they are rapidly deactivated. This is the reason why deactivation of NvS molecules by tinuvin P in aerated PMMA films does not affect the rate of reaction sensitization. On the other hand, NvT molecules formed from NvS ones in the absence of oxygen possess quite long lifetime (1.7 s) and, as follows from the experiments [13], in PMMA matrix possess the ability to transmit irradiationlessly the energy of triplet excitation to naphthalene molecules, located in supernanopores. For this reason, the decay of fluorescing NvS molecules proceeding in the absence of oxygen slows photodegradation of naphthalene down. To put it differently, besides activation of Ns molecules by means of light absorption, in deaerated PMMA films an additional quite effective pathway of excitation, associated with radiationless T-T transmission of energy from incapacious nanopores to supernanopores, acts. The reaction model discussed for CTA samples does not take into account transmission of electron excitation energy in this direction; however, in general case, based on the results [13], such possibility should be taken into account.
CONCLUSION Previously, it was shown that supramolecular heterophase models of chemical transformations possess high advantages in the description of kinetic features of chain reactions of autooxidation before the traditional homogeneous model of liquid-phase oxidation of hydrocarbons [4, 5]. In this paper, the method of heterophase-kinetic modeling is used in description of a complex photochemical process of transformations sensitized by naphthalene in glassy cellulose triacetate films. The considered supramolecular model of the mentioned process quite fully reflects the presence of heterogeneous nanophases in non-crystalline polymers, which cause the dominant influence on physical and chemical properties of additive moleculaes.
REFERENCES [1] [2] [3] [4]
Guseva L.N., Mikheev Yu.A., and Toptygin D.Ya., Izv. AN SSSR, Ser. Khim., 1974, No. 9, p. 1988. (Rus) Guseva L.N., Mikheev Yu.A., and Toptygin D.Ya., Doklady AN SSSR, 1975, vol. 220(6), p. 1356. (Rus) Guseva L.N., Mikheev Yu.A., Rogova L.S., and Toptygin D.Ya., Doklady AN SSSR, 1975, vol. 224(5), p. 1077. (Rus) Mikheev Yu.A., Guseva L.N., and Zaikov G.E., Uspekhi Khimii, 1997, vol. 66(1), p. 1. (Rus)
184 [5] [6] [7] [8] [9] [10] [11] [12] [13]
Yu. A. Mikheev and V. G. Zaikov Mikheev Yu.A. and Zaikov G.E., Uspekhi Khimii, 2000, vol. 69(3), p. 249. (Rus) Guseva L.N., Mikheev Yu.A., Rogova L.S., and Toptygin D.Ya., Polym. Photochem., 1982, vol. 2(6), p. 457. Czarnecki St. and Kryszewski M., J. Polymer Sci., 1963, vol. A1(10), p. 3067. Siegel S. and Judeikis H.S., J. Chem. Phys., 1968, vol. 48(4), p. 1613. Batekha I.G., Shekk Yu.B., Kryisanov S.A., and Alfimov M.V., Doklady AN SSSR, 1971, vol. 197(3), p. 614. (Rus) Mikheev Yu.A. and Guseva L.N., Khim. Fizika, 1991, vol. 10(5), p. 724. (Rus) Mikheev Yu.A., Guseva L.N., and Zaikov G.E., Khim. Fizika, 1996, vol. 15(1), p. 7. (Rus) Mikheev Yu.A. and Guseva L.N., Russ. J. Phys. Chem., 2000, vol. 74, Suppl. 3, p. S460. Kutsenova A.V. and Karpukhin O.N., Izv. AN SSSR, Ser. Khim., 1976, No. 6, p. 1301. (Rus)
INDEX A acceptance, 104 access, 138, 140, 159 accounting, 180 accumulation, 13, 14, 21, 84, 111, 132, 176, 178, 181 accuracy, 4, 5, 6, 69 acid, 13, 104, 109, 113, 145, 148, 149, 150, 151, 162, 163, 164, 166, 169, 170 acrylonitrile, 28 activation, 19, 105, 111, 118, 119, 121, 176, 181, 183 activation energy, 19, 118, 121, 176 additives, 103, 104, 117, 118, 122, 125, 126, 127, 130, 131, 132, 133, 134, 135, 136, 137, 138, 141, 145, 147, 148, 149, 150, 154, 155, 156, 157, 159, 160, 161, 162, 164, 174 affect, viii, 13, 16, 25, 120, 128, 130, 131, 139, 176, 182, 183 agent, 9, 11, 12, 16, 17, 23, 26, 27, 124, 156 aggregation, 13 aging, 103, 104, 105, 112, 118, 133, 135, 139, 140, 141, 142, 143, 144, 159, 161 aging process, 112 alcohol, 31, 43 algorithm, 34, 40, 42, 51, 52, 59 aliphatic polymers, 107 alternative, 155 alternatives, vii, 155 amines, 131, 138 amorphous polymers, 161 anaerobic photoreaction, 178 anisotropy, 92 antioxidant, 131, 134, 137, 141, 143, 145, 149, 151, 155, 156, 158, 170 argon, 129 argument, 79 aromatic compounds, 181
aromatic heterochain polymers, 134 aromatic polyimide, 104, 145, 157 aromatic rings, 109, 112, 118, 119 assessment, 111, 118, 122, 131, 132, 138 assumptions, 120, 155 atoms, 50, 51, 108, 109, 111, 119, 132, 163, 165, 166 attacks, 118 attention, 8, 19, 21, 89, 178 autoacceleration, 9 auto-acceleration, 14 auto-acceleration, 14 autooxidation, 118, 183 availability, 134 averaging, 85
B basic raw materials, 2 beams, 1, 6, 21 behavior, 2, 103, 104, 106, 118, 121, 122, 127, 131, 132, 134, 135, 152, 153, 156, 159, 161 bending, 9, 10, 15, 24, 83 benzene, 119, 128 benzoyl peroxide, 27 Berek capacitor, 95 bimolecular deactivation, 181 binding, 166 birefringence, 89, 90, 94, 95 birefringence distribution, 90 bisphenol, 104, 118, 121, 122, 124, 157, 162 blocks, 166 body, 32, 43, 140, 142 bonding, 166 bonds, 11, 16, 84, 118, 163, 164 branching, 15, 82, 106, 113, 133, 140, 146, 158, 162 butyl methacrylate, 10
186
Index
C carbon, 51, 104, 111, 112, 114, 148, 157, 167 carbon atoms, 51 carbonyl groups, 139, 162 carboxylic groups, 130, 170 carrier, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 41, 44, 47, 52 cation, 149, 151 C-C, 84 cellulose, 173, 183 cellulose triacetate, 173, 183 chain branching, 119, 158 chain scission, 171 chemical bonds, 50 chemical interaction, 162 chemical properties, 114, 183 chemical reactions, 114, 143 chemical structures, 128, 129 chlorination, 49, 50, 51, 52, 53 chlorine, 8, 49, 50, 51, 52, 120 chlorobenzene, 122 chloroform, 165 chromatography, 122 chromium, 149 classes, 131, 137, 161 cluster, 152, 153 CO2, 103, 105, 111, 132, 138, 148, 181 coke, 121 combustion, 106, 134, 162 competition, 119, 154 competitive process, 84 complexity, 16 complications, 41 components, 2, 8, 10, 14, 16, 20, 21, 31, 58, 60, 62, 63, 66, 67, 68, 69, 73, 78, 105, 109, 159 composites, 6, 138, 140 composition, 2, 9, 11, 14, 16, 17, 25, 26, 27, 28, 41, 53, 54, 58, 61, 62, 68, 70, 73, 80, 104, 114, 118, 122, 125, 126, 127, 128, 130, 132, 140, 141, 175, 176 compounds, 9, 10, 12, 105, 108, 109, 110, 112, 117, 118, 128, 131, 132, 134, 137, 138, 139, 140, 143, 145, 146, 148, 149, 151, 155, 156, 158, 164, 165, 166, 169, 175, 181, 182, 183 computerization, 6 computing, 25 concentration, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 16, 17, 19, 20, 21, 22, 27, 28, 29, 63, 70, 73, 76, 78, 83, 120, 121, 122, 128, 130, 132, 134, 151, 155, 156, 173, 175, 176, 177, 178, 180, 182 concordance, 95 condensation, 166 conduction, 23, 24
configuration, 29, 163 conjugation, 109, 111, 112, 152, 153, 166 constant rate, 75, 157 construction, 134 consumption, 2, 12, 15, 16, 173, 174, 176, 177, 178, 180, 181 context, 113 control, 2, 5, 12, 14, 15, 16, 21, 26, 34, 37, 160 conversion, 8, 9, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 19, 24, 48, 49, 75, 158, 176, 179, 183 conversion degrees, 13, 14 cooling, 31 copolymerization reaction, 12 copolymers, 7, 9, 10, 11, 21, 27, 28, 70 copper, 134, 139, 140, 143, 147, 149, 151, 152, 153, 154, 155, 169 correlation, 14, 107, 111, 154 costs, 131 cotton, 174 criticism, vii cross-linked polymers, 15 cross-linking reaction, 12, 13 crystal polymers, 161 crystallization, 137 CTA, 173, 174, 175, 176, 177, 178, 181, 182, 183 CTA films, 173, 174, 175, 176, 177, 178 curing, 31 cyanide, 31 cycles, 109 cylinder reactor, 35, 37, 40, 54, 56
D DAIP, 8, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 21, 26, 27, 43, 48 damage, 121, 175, 176, 177 danger, 118 database, 127 decay, 174, 178, 183 decomposition, 111, 122, 151, 162, 171 deduction, 26 defects, 13, 53, 117, 155, 159 definition, 163, 182 deformation, 26, 75, 90, 92, 93 deformation distribution, 93 DEGBAC, 8, 11, 14, 15, 16, 18, 19, 21, 22, 43, 48, 49 degenerate, 12, 159 degradation, 82, 84, 103, 104, 105, 106, 111, 113, 114, 117, 118, 121, 127, 128, 129, 130, 131, 132, 133, 134, 137, 138, 140, 145, 149, 153, 156, 157, 158, 161, 162, 164, 166, 169, 170, 174, 175 degradation mechanism, 117, 121, 137
Index degradation process, 103, 111, 118, 127, 140 degradation rate, 121 degree of crystallinity, 51 dehydrochlorination, 118 delivery, vii, 42, 43, 46, 52, 53, 54, 55, 57, 68, 69, 72 demand, 26, 66 density, 2, 30, 34, 38, 40, 41, 42, 43, 48, 54, 55, 57, 62, 63, 66, 74, 76, 78, 80, 84, 125, 133, 142, 153, 165, 166 depolymerization, 27, 121 desorption, 182 detachment, 111, 112, 119, 167, 179 detection, 124, 132, 166 deviation, 1, 6, 23, 51, 141, 165 diallylisophthalate, 11, 43, 48 diaphragm, 35, 36, 37, 38 differential scanning, 12 differential scanning calorimetry, 12 diffraction, 27, 160 diffusion, vii, 4, 6, 7, 8, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 29, 30, 31, 32, 34, 35, 38, 40, 48, 75, 80, 81, 82, 159, 161, 166 diffusion copolymerization, 34, 35, 38, 81 diffusion exchange, 6, 7, 10, 12, 17, 19, 24, 27, 80 diffusion process, 4 diffusional copolymerization, 26 dimethacrylate, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 21 dimethylsulfoxide, 122 dipole moments, 31 disclosure, 180 disorder, vii dispersion, 7, 13, 53, 84, 85, 141 displacement, 5, 6, 13, 61, 66, 68, 182 disposition, 78, 111, 133 dissociation, 106, 111, 115, 182 distillation, 31 distortions, 32, 53 distribution, 1, 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 9, 12, 16, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 27, 28, 29, 33, 34, 44, 47, 49, 51, 53, 54, 56, 58, 70, 71, 72, 75, 85, 86, 87, 90, 91, 94, 95, 96, 117, 165, 167 domain, 133 dominance, 128, 162 donors, 173 double bonds, 15, 16 drying, 127, 129, 132 DSC, 12, 16 DTA curve, 121, 145 durability, 175, 176, 177 duration, 15, 26, 34, 35, 38, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 47, 50, 53, 54, 55, 56, 57, 59, 60, 72, 75, 87, 88, 89, 129, 174
187
E elaboration, 31 electric field, 7, 30 electron density distribution, 165 electron state, 166 electrons, 107, 108, 109, 165 emission, 122, 128 endurance, 146 energy consumption, 107 energy transfer, 179 engagement network, 14 enlargement, 3, 5 equality, 77, 121, 122 equilibrium, 17, 178 equipment, 25, 122, 124, 127, 128 ESR, 16, 119, 151, 152, 156, 159, 166, 170 ESR spectra, 119, 151, 152, 156, 159 ester, 12, 132, 138, 163 estimating, 23 ethanol, 44 ethers, 11, 12, 13, 28, 169, 170 evacuation, 176 evaporation, 8, 24, 181, 182 exchange diffusion, 7, 11, 12, 21, 24, 33, 36, 37, 39, 40, 53, 56, 57, 76, 78 exchange rate, 178 excitation, 107, 111, 166, 173, 179, 183 exclusion, 66, 166, 178 experimental condition, 11, 19 exploitation, 8 exposure, 28, 53, 79, 85, 87, 89, 130, 134, 139, 140, 142 expression, vii, 3, 5, 16, 26, 65, 75, 81, 88, 95 extraction, 122, 165, 174 extrapolation, 176 extrusion, 137, 146, 151
F ferromagnetic liquid, 36, 37, 38, 41, 42, 43, 45, 48, 49 fiber optics, 1 fibers, 29, 75 film thickness, 43, 49 films, 33, 44, 49, 51, 82, 83, 84, 90, 107, 133, 158, 159, 160, 161, 173, 174, 175, 176, 177, 181, 182, 183 fire retardants, 134 fish, 2 fixation, 20 flame, 161, 171
188
Index
flame retardants, 171 flexibility, 2, 11 fluid, 70, 80 fluorescence, 107, 166, 177, 182 fluorescence decay, 177 fluorine, 31 fluoroalkyl methacrylates, 49 FMA, 19 focusing, 1, 3, 4, 6, 7, 9, 11, 22, 23, 26, 27, 28, 29, 45, 47, 48, 52, 81 fractional composition, 12, 19 fractures, 173 France, 174 free radicals, 141, 173, 178
G GB-element, 90, 93, 94, 95 GB-optics, 90 gel, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 25, 31, 127, 130, 138 gel formation, 13, 15, 16, 127, 138 gel-effect, 14 gel-fraction, 11, 13, 14, 127, 130, 137 generation, 25 geometrical parameters, 109 Georgia, 1, 98, 100, 101 glass transition, 10, 23, 90 glass transition temperature, 10 glasses, 1, 11, 32, 53 glassy films, 181, 182 glassy polymers, 182 glycol, 43 GPC, 140 gradient elements, 3, 6, 7, 8, 9, 11, 19, 20, 22, 23, 25, 26, 27, 41, 49 gradient formation, 33, 34, 38, 40, 41, 42, 43, 52, 53, 54, 56, 57, 58, 100 gradient former, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 46, 47, 48, 49, 52 gradient media, 2, 8 gradient optics, 1, 49, 89, 90 gradient-carrier, 44, 45, 47, 49, 52 granules, 129, 134 graph, 44, 47, 51, 53, 56, 60, 65, 74, 85, 88 gravitation, 7 gravitational field, 6 GRIN, 1, 2, 6, 8, 9, 11, 25, 26, 27, 29, 31, 49, 58, 82, 85, 87, 89, 90, 96 groups, 4, 6, 12, 14, 83, 84, 90, 104, 105, 108, 117, 118, 119, 120, 121, 122, 124, 125, 128, 132, 151, 156, 162, 163, 167, 170, 181 growth, 25, 32, 43, 44, 55
H halogenation, 6 HALS, 138, 139, 140, 141, 142, 143, 144, 145 Hamiltonian, 108, 152 heat, 11, 103, 107, 110, 114, 117, 118, 119, 121, 134, 142, 145, 146, 147, 157, 158, 160, 161, 162, 164, 166, 167, 169, 170, 179 heat aging, 142, 146, 160 heating, 16, 31, 120, 121, 127, 129, 130, 146, 151, 154, 162, 175 heating rate, 120, 129 height, 40, 45, 46, 54, 55, 56, 59, 63, 65, 66, 67, 68, 76, 77, 79, 80, 81, 90, 92 height growth, 67 heterophase-kinetic modeling, 183 hexane, 119 homogeneity, 134 homopolymerization, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 23 homopolymers, 59, 70 hydrocarbons, 161, 170, 183 hydrogen, 51, 167 hydrogen atoms, 51 hydrolysis, 122, 162, 163 hydroperoxides, 131, 141, 145 hydroxide, 44 hydroxyl, 118, 119, 120, 121, 122 hydroxyl groups, 119, 120, 121, 122 hypothesis, 106, 154
I ideas, 3, 12, 17, 72, 174 identification, 169 identity, 40, 122, 153 immersion, 6 implementation, 173 impregnation, 31 in vitro, 118 inclusion, 25, 154 independence, 109, 121 indices, 8, 19, 43, 50, 70, 75, 137, 164 individuality, 132 induction, 34, 104, 127, 151 induction period, 34, 104, 151 industry, 26 inequality, 92, 180 inert liquid, 34, 35, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 47, 48, 49, 52, 54, 55, 56, 57 infinite, 16, 21 influence, 9, 21, 23, 26, 27, 29, 30, 41, 42, 44, 82, 84, 85, 89, 171, 183
Index information processing, 25 inhibition, 113, 131, 134, 137, 145, 155, 157, 162, 163, 166, 167 inhibitor, 113 inhomogeneity, 54, 90 inhomogeneous mechanical field, 90, 93, 94 initiation, 28, 106, 118, 119, 120, 121, 122, 128, 130, 137 initiation rates, 121 injections, 133, 134 input, 8, 23, 35, 37, 54, 71 insulation, 151, 168 intensity, 83, 85, 89, 94, 95, 151, 162, 173, 174, 177, 178, 179, 180, 181 interaction, vii, 33, 106, 113, 151, 153, 154, 156, 162, 165, 166, 169, 178 interactions, 153 interest, 26, 54, 82, 89, 103, 112 interface, 27 interphase, 26 interval, 63, 65, 181 ionization, 111, 127, 165 ionizing radiation, 82 ions, 32, 124, 127, 151 IR spectra, 162 iron, 124, 164, 165 irradiation, 82, 83, 88 IR-spectra, 132, 141, 148 IR-spectroscopy, 124, 170 isophthalic acid, 8 isotactic polypropylene, 43, 49, 89 isotherms, 175, 176 isotope, 82, 114
J Japan, 97, 99, 168 justification, 73
K kinetic constants, 121 kinetic curves, 157, 174, 176 kinetic model, 173, 174, 182 kinetic parameters, 12 kinetic regularities, 174 kinetics, 4, 12, 15, 19, 103, 104, 121, 131, 132, 133, 148, 149, 156, 157, 163, 174 knowledge, 26, 53, 84, 90, 177
189
L laminar, 62 laws, 31, 103 layering, 20 lead, 41, 73, 85, 86, 87, 88, 89 lens, 2, 3, 21, 25, 31, 32, 33, 35, 38, 44, 47, 52, 53, 54, 55, 56, 57, 78 lifetime, 183 ligands, 151, 155 light beam, 1, 3 light transmission, 9 light transmittance, 122, 127, 131, 133, 134, 137, 164 linear dependence, 23, 131 linear model, 152 links, 16 liquid monomer, 78 liquid phase, 13 liquids, 38, 54, 56, 78, 118 localization, 13, 107, 110 longitudinal elongation, 93, 94, 95 low density polyethylene, 169 low temperatures, 103, 106 low-molecular substances, 166 luminescence, 177
M macromolecules, 9, 12, 13, 90, 105, 113, 133, 154, 156, 162, 173, 174, 175, 177, 178, 179, 181 macroradicals, 106, 119 magnet, 37, 38, 39, 41, 42, 43 magnetic field, 36, 38, 39, 41, 42, 52 magnetic moment, 152, 153, 154 magnetic properties, 154 masking, 38 mass, 9, 15, 16, 50, 51, 63, 66, 67, 68, 117, 121, 124, 126, 127, 129, 130, 131, 136, 137, 138, 142, 146, 148, 149, 150, 156, 164, 167, 168, 171 mass loss, 121, 124, 126, 127, 129, 136, 137, 138, 142, 146, 148, 149, 150, 156 material degradation, 137 matrix, vii, viii, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 31, 33, 36, 41, 43, 53, 56, 76, 80, 127, 140, 154, 159, 173, 181, 182, 183 measurement, 4, 5, 6, 15 measures, 40 mechanical degradation, 176 mechanical properties, 9, 16 mechanical stress, 26, 175, 177
190
Index
media, 1, 2, 27, 33, 100 melt, 32, 62, 68, 118, 124, 128, 130, 134, 136, 137, 138, 143, 145, 146, 147, 155, 161 melt flow index, 147 melting, 32, 62, 66, 153 mercury, 48, 141, 174, 176 metal salts, 131, 137, 146 metals, 32, 122, 127, 128, 149, 150, 151, 169 methacrylic acid, 28 methanol, 174, 175 methyl groups, 118 methyl methacrylate, 25, 28, 49, 70 methylene chloride, 124, 174, 181 MFI, 122, 123, 126, 128, 129, 130, 133, 135, 137, 138, 145, 147, 149, 150 microelectronics, 26 microgels, 13 microheterogeneity, 13 migration, 107, 118, 155, 181 mixing, 76, 151, 154, 156 MMA, 8, 10, 17, 19, 21, 25, 26, 27, 31, 49 mobility, 14, 159 mode, 90, 104, 174 model system, 19, 21, 158 modeling, 21 models, 20, 107, 111, 117, 152, 156, 166, 173, 183 modernization, 1, 2, 8, 24, 26 modulus, 10 molar volume, 19 mold, 26, 71, 75, 105, 130 molecular mass, 24, 51, 117, 120, 121, 127, 140 molecular mobility, 19, 159, 161 molecular oxygen, 107 molecular refraction, 21 molecules, 11, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 106, 108, 141, 159, 173, 176, 177, 178, 179, 180, 181, 182, 183 momentum, 29 monograph, 48, 111 monomers, 2, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 19, 21, 23, 24, 25, 27, 28, 29, 32, 33, 59, 70, 75, 76, 77, 78, 79, 80, 81, 118, 122, 124, 127, 162, 168 morphology, 139, 143 Moscow, viii, 1, 95, 96, 98, 99, 100, 101, 103, 113, 114, 117, 167, 168, 169, 170, 171, 173 motion, vii, 29, 59, 60, 69, 72, 75, 159 multimedia, 26
N NaCl, 52, 122 nanophases, 182, 183
naphthalene, 173, 174, 175, 176, 177, 178, 179, 180, 181, 182, 183 network, 7, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 16, 17, 21, 82, 159 network polymers, 10, 18 nickel, 149 nitrogen, 105, 128, 130, 175, 176, 177 NMR, 14, 124, 162, 164, 166, 167, 170, 171 non-inhibited oxidation, 157 nucleating agent, 141 nuclei, 139, 163 nucleus, 163 numerical aperture, 27
O observations, 111, 142 OH-groups, 120, 121, 122, 123 oligomeric structures, 105 oligomers, 2, 6, 10, 104, 117, 128 operator, 21 optical deformation, 90 optical density, 124, 139, 174 optical fiber, 26, 31, 70, 96, 97 optical properties, 9, 16, 22, 23, 25, 38, 75, 82, 89, 100 optical systems, 2, 25, 38 optimization, 22, 23, 137, 143 organic compounds, 107, 134, 165, 169 orientation, 90, 92 outline, 137 output, 6, 13, 29, 32, 35, 37, 54, 167 oxidation, 103, 104, 105, 106, 107, 109, 111, 113, 114, 118, 120, 121, 122, 127, 131, 134, 138, 139, 140, 145, 155, 156, 157, 158, 161, 162, 163, 166, 167, 170, 183 oxidation products, 157 oxides, 104, 111, 148, 151, 157, 167 oxygen, 84, 103, 105, 106, 109, 111, 112, 127, 131, 134, 137, 138, 139, 140, 153, 154, 155, 157, 158, 159, 161, 164, 165, 166, 173, 175, 176, 177, 178, 182, 183 oxygen absorption, 103, 112, 131, 137, 138, 155, 157 oxygen absorption kinetics, 103
P PAA, 151 PAN, 28 parameter, 15, 34, 122, 147, 152, 166 particles, 13, 20, 30, 180, 181, 182 partition, 23, 62, 68, 69
Index patents, 131, 145 PCA, 131, 145, 157, 158, 159, 161, 166, 167 perfluoroalkyl methacrylates, 9 permeability, 31 permeation, 26, 27, 85 peroxide, 106, 107, 155, 170 peroxide radical, 106, 170 perspective, 157 PET, 162, 171 PETF, 171 pH, 128 phenol, 119, 128, 139, 143, 145, 150, 166 phenoxyl radicals, 131 phosphates, 132, 137, 138 phosphorescence, 178, 181, 182 phosphorescence decay, 182 phosphorus, 131, 132, 134, 143, 150, 157, 161, 163, 164, 165, 166, 170, 171 phosphorylation, 162, 166 photodegradation, 175, 183 photolysis, 175 photopolymerization, 28, 31, 70 physical aging, 134 physical properties, 82, 134, 181 physicochemical properties, 69 plasticization, 17, 118 plastics, 106 PMMA, 21, 25, 26, 28, 31, 49, 162, 178, 181, 182, 183 PMS, 49 polarimeters, 89 polarity, 163 polarization, 78, 171 pollution, 41 poly(ethylene terephthalate), 171 poly(methyl methacrylate), 171 polyamides, 114, 128, 157 polyamidoacid, 158 polycarbonate, 131 polycarbonates, 131 polycondensation, 33, 122, 156, 168 polydispersity, 175 polyheteroarylenes, 114, 145 polyimide, 151, 156 polyimides, 108, 128, 151, 157 polymer density, 15, 51 polymer materials, 26 polymer matrix, viii, 138, 181 polymer molecule, 29 polymer optical fibers, 26 polymer oxidation, 106 polymer properties, 158 polymer solubility, 106
191
polymer structure, 104, 118, 124, 157, 158, 159 polymer synthesis, 33, 124 polymeric chains, 12, 13, 84, 182 polymeric composites, 143 polymeric films, 89, 90, 95, 175 polymeric materials, viii, 1, 2, 26, 31, 85, 89, 104 polymeric matrices, 48 polymeric media, 27, 39, 51 polymeric medium, 35, 38, 84 polymerization, 7, 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20, 21, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 33, 41, 48, 58, 59, 70, 72, 75, 76, 78, 82, 162 polymers, vii, viii, 2, 7, 15, 32, 33, 43, 49, 51, 59, 70, 82, 89, 90, 101, 103, 104, 105, 106, 107, 109, 110, 114, 117, 118, 128, 129, 131, 134, 145, 151, 154, 155, 156, 157, 158, 160, 161, 162, 166, 169, 183 polyolefins, 151, 161 polypropylene, 31, 114, 151 polystyrene, 9 polyvinylchloride, 31 poor, 131 porosity, 142 power, 2, 82, 87 precipitation, 167, 174, 175 preparation, 2, 7, 9, 11, 20, 21, 24, 25, 28, 29, 32, 53, 76, 90, 176 pressure, 17, 76, 141, 162, 174, 176 prevention, 113, 156 primary antioxidants, 131 principle, 30, 36, 121 probability, 13, 14, 108, 111, 163 probe, 159 process duration, 34, 35, 39, 40, 42, 43, 49, 52, 54, 55, 56, 57 production, 2, 8, 9, 12, 22, 23, 26, 70, 81, 84, 87, 118, 122, 124, 131, 137, 151 production costs, 118 program, 62 propagation, 12 proportionality, 181 protons, 119 pulse, 174 purification, 124 PVA, 43, 44, 45, 47, 48 PVA films, 44 PVC, 121, 156 PVC dehydrochlorination, 121 PVS, 93, 94, 95 PVS film, 93, 94, 95 pyrolysis, 161, 162, 171 pyromellitic dianhydride, 156, 168
192
Index
Q quanta, 176 quantum yields, 174, 177 quantum-chemical calculations, 107 quartz, 2, 28, 53, 174, 175
R radial distribution, 28, 35, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 48, 55, 56, 57, 61, 62, 63, 68, 85 radiation, 9, 23, 24, 78, 82, 83, 84, 85, 86, 87, 88, 89, 176, 177 radical formation, 106 radical mechanism, 164 radical pairs, 180 radical polymerization, 12 radical reactions, 158, 162 radius, 2, 3, 4, 6, 17, 21, 22, 23, 24, 30, 31, 34, 35, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 46, 47, 54, 55, 56, 59, 60, 62, 63, 64, 66, 68, 70, 71, 72, 73, 74, 77, 79, 85, 86, 87, 88, 92 range, 3, 11, 15, 31, 82, 83, 84, 90, 92, 109, 121, 128, 130, 132, 137, 138, 143, 145, 146, 149, 153, 157, 166, 175, 177 raw materials, 122, 124, 127 reaction mechanism, 34 reaction rate, vii reactor center, 43, 55 reactor rotation, 40, 56 reasoning, 60 recombination, 106, 118, 164, 179, 180 redistribution, 72 reduction, 8, 38, 48, 76, 85, 88, 161 reflexes, 162 refraction gradient, 90 refraction index, 26 refractive index, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 16, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 33, 34, 35, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 44, 45, 47, 48, 49, 50, 51, 52, 53, 56, 57, 58, 59, 60, 62, 63, 64, 69, 70, 71, 72, 73, 75, 76, 78, 80, 82, 83, 84, 85, 86, 87, 88, 89, 96, 100 refractive index variation, 84 refractive indices, 7, 15, 20, 25, 27, 28, 34, 38, 47, 48, 51, 59, 62, 63, 68, 70, 90 regression, 122 regression analysis, 122 regulation, 10, 16, 34, 81, 160 relationship, 60 relationships, 178 relaxation, 14
relaxation times, 14 reproduction, 4 residual matrix, 12 residues, 105, 113, 118, 122, 127, 164, 175 resistance, 9, 11, 108, 109, 110, 114, 121, 134, 135, 151, 167, 169 resolution, 11, 162 rods, 11, 75, 96 room temperature, 165, 175, 178 rotation axes, 91, 92 rotation axis, 93 rotations, 89 rubber, 37 Russia, viii, 1, 103, 117, 173
S sacrifice, 21, 84 salts, 128, 138, 149, 150, 155, 169 sample, 4, 5, 6, 7, 16, 21, 22, 23, 26, 30, 33, 34, 35, 36, 37, 38, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 48, 52, 54, 55, 56, 57, 82, 85, 88, 89, 90, 91, 92, 93, 95, 117, 122, 123, 125, 126, 130, 132, 133, 139, 140, 141, 156, 159, 160, 161, 164, 174, 176 saturation, 49, 84, 85 scanning electron microscopy, 133 scatter, 130 scattering, 83 search, 7, 9 searching, 8, 117, 134 selecting, 22 self, vii, 17, 103, 104, 112, 149, 150, 159, 161, 182 self-organization, 182 semiconductor, 78 semi-empirical methods, 108 sensitivity, 83, 89, 104 sensitization, 173, 177, 178, 182 separation, 6, 31 series, 8, 23, 29, 73, 109, 124 shape, 6, 7, 9, 10, 11, 12, 14, 16, 17, 24, 27, 33, 37, 39, 40, 41, 42, 43, 54, 55, 63, 64, 68, 83, 85, 89, 92, 141, 142, 151, 162, 175 shear, 136 shear rates, 136 shoulders, 20 sign, 57 signals, 14, 26, 162 similarity, 103, 104 simulation, 148 skeleton, 111 sodium, 44, 45, 46, 47 sodium hydroxide, 44, 45, 46, 47 software, 152
Index solid matrix, 159 solid phase, 106, 145 solid polymers, 177 solid solutions, 177 solubility, vii solvents, 104, 106, 124 sorption, 17 sorption curves, 17 species, 128 specificity, 13, 33 Specord UV-VIS, 174 spectroscopy, 12, 14, 122, 124, 128, 166, 171 spectrum, 14, 82, 84, 107, 139, 159, 165, 174, 175, 176 speed, vii, 166 spin, 106, 152, 153, 159 stability, 24, 105, 107, 111, 118, 122, 123, 124, 125, 126, 128, 130, 133, 137, 138, 151, 156, 160, 169, 170 stabilization, 113, 114, 117, 118, 124, 131, 132, 134, 136, 137, 139, 141, 143, 145, 146, 147, 151, 154, 155, 156, 157, 158, 159, 161, 162, 164, 166, 167, 168, 169, 170 stabilizers, 131, 132, 134, 137, 138, 139, 166, 169 stages, 7, 11, 12, 13, 14, 27, 51, 103, 104, 105, 124, 130, 137, 140, 142, 157, 158, 175, 178 storage, viii strength, 11, 13, 106, 107, 119, 121, 135, 141, 142, 144, 145, 146, 164 stress, 144 stretching, 90, 91, 93, 153 structural changes, 34, 82, 86, 89 structure formation, 13, 82, 143 structuring, 12 styrene, 9, 10, 11, 14, 70 substitutes, 119, 120, 165, 166 substitution, 51, 73, 121, 124 sulfur, 150 sulfuric acid, 48 supply, 38 suppression, 137, 138 surface area, 33 surface layer, 56, 140, 142 surface structure, 139 surface tension, 37, 52 susceptibility, 151, 152, 153, 154 swelling, 6, 11, 17 symmetry, 90 synchronization, 155 synthesis, 2, 10, 11, 12, 33, 120, 124, 169 synthetic rubbers, 162 systems, 1, 2, 12, 19, 27, 34, 40, 44, 47, 48, 58, 118, 139, 141, 146, 162, 170
193
T technology, 1, 8, 11, 21, 25, 26, 54, 122 temperature, 7, 16, 17, 19, 24, 25, 26, 27, 29, 47, 53, 82, 90, 103, 104, 106, 114, 120, 127, 129, 131, 134, 137, 138, 143, 145, 146, 149, 151, 152, 153, 156, 157, 158, 161, 162, 164, 167, 174, 175, 176 tensile strength, 135 test data, 134 TGA, 120, 121, 126, 128, 129, 130, 131, 136, 148 theoretical dependencies, 17 theory, 106 thermal activation, 166 thermal aging, 106, 146, 159 thermal decomposition, 170 thermal degradation, 105, 106, 170, 171 thermal oxidation, 103, 104, 105, 106, 107, 109, 112, 114, 117, 118, 120, 121, 128, 134, 138, 139, 145, 146, 148, 155, 156, 157, 158, 160, 162, 166, 167 thermal oxidative degradation, 121, 129, 168 thermal resistance, 9 thermal stability, 104, 111, 117, 121, 122, 124, 127, 128, 129, 130, 131, 133, 134, 137, 138, 155, 156, 158, 167, 168 thermal treatment, 127, 136, 152 thermodynamics, 165 thermomechanical method, 15 thin films, 84 time, 2, 3, 7, 9, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 21, 23, 24, 26, 28, 34, 45, 46, 54, 55, 59, 61, 70, 72, 75, 76, 87, 108, 112, 131, 132, 137, 139, 140, 142, 158, 175, 176, 177, 182 tin, 134, 149 titanium, 53, 169 toluene, 119 TPA, 105, 106, 166 trademarks, 132, 134 trajectory, 1, 2 transformation, 7, 12, 13, 14, 15, 24, 33, 34, 35, 38, 39, 40, 42, 43, 44, 45, 47, 48, 56, 57, 82, 104, 106, 107, 151, 166, 173, 174, 175, 178, 180, 182 transformation degrees, 12, 13, 14 transformation product, 40, 42, 43, 44, 166 transformations, 34, 48, 49, 104, 114, 117, 132, 134, 154, 156, 158, 170, 179, 183 transition, vii, 18, 21, 25, 27, 107, 113, 118, 130, 132, 138, 140, 145, 146, 148, 149, 150, 151, 153, 154, 155, 156, 162, 164, 165 transition metal, 132, 138, 140, 145, 146, 148, 149, 151, 154, 155, 156, 162, 164, 165 transitions, 151 translation, 26, 173 transmission, 12, 25, 70, 75, 183
194
Index
transmits, 176 transparency, 7, 13 transport, 166 trapezium, 90, 91, 92 triplet excitation, 173, 183
vinyl monomers, 11, 12, 14, 31 vinylchloride, 162 viscosity, 15, 29, 121, 128, 130, 134, 136, 137, 138, 144, 145, 146, 161 volatility, 134
U UK, 168 uniform, 71, 73, 174 universality, 151 USSR, 96, 97, 98, 99, 100, 101, 152, 168 UV, 28, 29, 31, 49, 53, 82, 84, 165, 173, 174, 175, 176, 177, 178, 179, 180, 181 UV absorption spectra, 174 UV-radiation, 28, 29, 31, 49, 53, 174, 177, 178, 181
W water, vii, 48, 52, 93, 122, 124, 151, 153, 158, 163, 174, 175 water absorption, 163 wavelengths, 83, 176 wetting, 37 withdrawal, 79, 80 words, vii work, viii, 11, 13, 21
V vacuum, 84, 129, 134, 151, 152, 153, 162, 174, 175, 176, 177 valence, 109, 119, 137, 138, 146, 149, 151, 181 validity, 51 values, 2, 6, 8, 20, 21, 23, 25, 26, 31, 34, 38, 40, 46, 48, 51, 54, 55, 58, 61, 68, 70, 73, 75, 80, 82, 85, 88, 89, 90, 92, 95, 109, 112, 118, 121, 122, 130, 141, 149, 153, 154, 155, 159, 163, 166 vapor, 32, 181 variable, 9 variation, 2, 38, 44, 109, 177 vector, 88, 89 velocity, 31 vessels, 58, 60, 71, 74, 75
X xenon, 174, 176, 177 X-ray analysis, 151, 153 X-ray diffraction, 166
Y yield, 112, 157, 158, 175, 176, 179, 180
Z zinc, 150